Sony PM-0330 GSM/GPRS/EDGE/UMTS/HSPA Smartphone with WLAN, Bluetooth, RFID User Manual Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB
Sony Mobile Communications Inc GSM/GPRS/EDGE/UMTS/HSPA Smartphone with WLAN, Bluetooth, RFID Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB
Sony >
Contents
- 1. user guide all parts
- 2. user guide - all parts
user guide all parts
User guide Xperia™ ZR C5503/C5502 Contents Xperia™ ZR User guide..................................................................6 Getting started...............................................................................7 Android™ – what and why?...............................................................7 Device overview.................................................................................7 Assembly...........................................................................................8 Turning the device on and off .........................................................10 Screen lock......................................................................................10 Setup guide......................................................................................10 Accounts and services.....................................................................11 Getting to know your device........................................................12 Using the keys.................................................................................12 Battery..............................................................................................12 Using the touchscreen.....................................................................15 Using the lockscreen.......................................................................17 Home screen....................................................................................18 Accessing and using applications...................................................20 Status and notifications...................................................................23 Settings menu..................................................................................24 Typing text.......................................................................................25 Customising your device.................................................................29 Enhancing the sound output............................................................32 Memory............................................................................................32 Using a headset ..............................................................................33 Internet and messaging settings......................................................33 Controlling data usage.....................................................................34 Mobile network settings...................................................................35 Google Play™..............................................................................37 Getting started with Google Play™.................................................37 Downloading from Google Play™....................................................37 Clearing your application data.........................................................37 Permissions......................................................................................38 Installing applications not from Google Play™ ...............................38 Calling..........................................................................................39 Emergency calls...............................................................................39 Call handling....................................................................................39 Voicemail..........................................................................................41 Multiple calls....................................................................................41 Conference calls..............................................................................41 Call settings.....................................................................................42 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts ......................................................................................44 About Contacts................................................................................44 Transferring contacts to your new device.......................................44 Contacts screen overview...............................................................46 Managing your contacts..................................................................46 Communicating with your contacts.................................................48 Sharing your contacts......................................................................48 Backing up contacts........................................................................49 Messaging....................................................................................50 Using text and multimedia messaging.............................................50 Text and multimedia message options............................................51 Google Talk™ .................................................................................52 Email.............................................................................................53 Getting started with Email................................................................53 Using email......................................................................................54 Socialife™....................................................................................57 Using the Socialife™ application.....................................................57 "WALKMAN" application .............................................................58 About the "WALKMAN" application.................................................58 Transferring media files to your device ...........................................58 Using the "WALKMAN" application ................................................59 Visualiser .........................................................................................60 Getting more information about a track or artist.............................60 Using My music to organise your tracks ........................................60 Managing playlists...........................................................................62 "WALKMAN" application widget ....................................................63 Protecting your hearing....................................................................63 Music services..............................................................................64 TrackID™ technology......................................................................64 Music Unlimited™............................................................................65 About the PlayNow™ service..........................................................65 FM radio.......................................................................................67 About the FM radio..........................................................................67 Using your favourite radio channels................................................68 Sound settings.................................................................................68 Identifying radio tracks using TrackID™..........................................68 Camera.........................................................................................70 About the camera............................................................................70 Using the still camera......................................................................70 Face detection.................................................................................71 Using Smile Shutter™ to capture smiling faces..............................71 Adding the geographical position to your photos...........................72 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using still camera settings...............................................................72 Using the video camera...................................................................76 Album...........................................................................................81 About Album....................................................................................81 Mobile BRAVIA® Engine..................................................................81 Viewing photos and videos in the Pictures tab ...............................81 Viewing photos and videos in the My albums tab ..........................82 Viewing your photos on a map........................................................86 Viewing online albums.....................................................................87 Movies..........................................................................................89 About Movies...................................................................................89 Using Movies...................................................................................89 Video Unlimited™........................................................................91 About Video Unlimited™..................................................................91 Renting or buying a video................................................................91 Watching a video from Video Unlimited™.......................................92 Web browser................................................................................93 About the web browser....................................................................93 Connectivity.................................................................................94 Connecting to wireless networks.....................................................94 Sharing content with DLNA Certified™ devices..............................97 NFC..................................................................................................99 Bluetooth™ wireless technology...................................................102 Connecting your device to a computer.........................................104 Connecting your device to a TV set...............................................106 Screen mirroring............................................................................107 Scanning barcodes with the NeoReader™ application.................107 Smart Connect...............................................................................108 Synchronising data on your device............................................110 About synchronising data on your device.....................................110 Synchronising with Google™........................................................110 Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts........110 Synchronising with Facebook™....................................................111 Maps and locations....................................................................113 About location services..................................................................113 Using GPS.....................................................................................113 Google Maps™..............................................................................114 Using Google Maps™ to get directions.........................................114 Calendar and alarm clock..........................................................115 Calendar.........................................................................................115 Alarm clock....................................................................................115 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Support and maintenance..........................................................118 Updating your device.....................................................................118 Backup and restore application.....................................................119 Resetting your device....................................................................120 Locking and protecting your device..............................................121 Support application.......................................................................123 Recycling your device....................................................................123 Reference...................................................................................124 Settings overview...........................................................................124 Status and notification icons overview..........................................125 Application overview......................................................................126 Important information.................................................................128 Important information leaflet..........................................................128 Limitations to services and features..............................................128 Protecting your device from water and dust.................................128 Legal information...........................................................................130 Index...........................................................................................131 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Xperia™ ZR User guide This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Getting started Android™ – what and why? Your Xperia™ from Sony runs on the Android platform. Android devices can perform many of the same functions as a computer and you can customise them to your own needs. For example, you can add and delete applications, or enhance existing applications to improve functionality. On Google Play™ you can download a range of applications and games from a constantly growing collection. You can also integrate applications on your Android™ device with other applications and with online services that you use. For example, you can back up your contacts, access your different email accounts and calendars from one place, keep track of your appointments, and engage in social networking. Android™ devices are constantly evolving. When a new software version is available and your device supports this new software, you can update your device to get new features and the latest improvements. Your Android™ device is pre-loaded with Google™ services. To get the most out of the provided Google™ services, you should have a Google™ account and sign in to it when you first start your device. You also need to have Internet access to use many of the features in Android™. New software releases may not be compatible with all devices. Device overview Front camera lens Ear speaker Headset jack Light sensor Power key This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 6 Volume/Zoom key Camera key Strap hole Microphone 10 Notification light 11 Camera lens 12 Camera light 13 Port for charger/USB cable 14 Connector for charging dock 15 Speaker Assembly To remove the back cover • Insert a thumbnail into the gap between the back cover and the bottom side of your device, then lift up the cover. This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To insert the micro SIM card Remove the battery cover and the battery, then pull out the micro SIM card holder. Place the micro SIM card into the micro SIM card holder, with the goldcoloured contacts facing down. Push the micro SIM card and the holder back into the phone. To insert a memory card Remove the back cover and the battery. Insert the memory card into the memory card slot, with the gold-coloured contacts facing down. The memory card may not be included at purchase in all markets. To attach the back cover Place the back cover over the back of the device, then press down on the top corners to lock them into place. Moving from top to bottom, press down the sides of the cover. The clips on the inside of the cover make clicking noises as they lock into place. This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Turning the device on and off To turn on the device Press and hold down the power key until the device vibrates. If your screen goes dark, briefly press the power key to activate the screen. To unlock the screen, drag up or drag down. Enter your SIM card PIN when requested, then select OK. Wait a while for the device to start. Your SIM card PIN is initially supplied by your network operator, but you can change it later from the Settings menu. To correct a mistake made while entering your SIM card PIN, tap To turn off the device Press and hold down the power key In the options menu, tap Power off. Tap OK. until the options menu opens. It may take a while for the device to shut down. Screen lock When your device is on and left idle for a set period of time, the screen darkens to save battery power, and locks automatically. This lock prevents unwanted actions on the touchscreen when you are not using it. On the lockscreen, you can still take photos and play audio tracks. • To activate the screen Briefly press the power key To unlock the screen • Drag • To lock the screen manually When the screen is active, briefly press the power key up or drag down. Setup guide The first time you start your device, a setup guide opens to explain basic functions and help you enter essential settings. This is a good time to configure the device to 10 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. your specific needs. You can also access the setup guide later from the settings menu. To access the setup guide manually From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Setup guide. Accounts and services Sign in to your online service accounts from your device to get easy access when you're on the move. For example, you can integrate contacts from your Google™ account into your phonebook, so you have everything in one place. You can sign up to new online services from your device as well as from a computer. Google™ account Having a Google™ account is key to using a range of applications and services with your Android device. You need a Google™ account, for example, to use the Gmail™ application in your device, to chat with friends using Google Talk™, and to synchronise the calendar application on your device with your Google Calendar™. You also need a Google™ account to download applications and games, music, movies and books from Google Play™. Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account Synchronise your device with your corporate Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account. This way, you keep your work email, contacts and calendar events with you at all times. Facebook™ account Facebook™ is a social networking service that connects you with friends, family and colleagues around the world. Set up Facebook to work on your device so that you can stay in touch from anywhere. 11 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Getting to know your device Using the keys Back • Go back to the previous screen • Close the on-screen keypad, a dialog box, an options menu, or the Notification panel Home • Go to the Home screen Task • Tap to open a window showing your most recently used applications and a small apps bar Battery Charging the battery Your battery is partly charged when you buy the device. It may take a few minutes before the battery icon appears on the screen when you connect the charger cable to a power source, such as a USB port or a charger. You can still use your device while it is charging. Charging your device over a long period of time, for example, overnight, does not damage the battery or the device. The battery will start to discharge a little after it is fully charged and then charges again after a certain time when the charger is connected. This is to extend battery life and may result in the charge status showing a level below 100 percent. 12 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To charge your device Plug the charger into a power outlet. Plug one end of the USB cable into the charger (or into the USB port of a computer). Plug the other end of the cable into the micro USB port on your device, with the USB symbol facing up. The battery status LED lights up when charging starts. When the battery status LED is green, the device is fully charged. Disconnect the USB cable from your device by pulling it straight outwards. Make sure not to bend the connector when removing the cable from the device. Use the charger and USB cable provided with the device to ensure faster charging. If the battery is completely discharged, it may take a few minutes before the LED lights up after you connect the charger cable to a power source. Battery LED status Green The battery is fully charged Red The battery level is low Orange The battery is charging. The battery level is between low and full To check the battery level From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > About phone > Status > Battery level. Improving battery performance The following tips can help you improve battery performance: • • • • • • Charge your device often. This will not affect the lifetime of the battery. Downloading data from the Internet is power consuming. When you're not using the Internet, you can save power by disabling all data connections over mobile networks. This setting does not prevent your device from transmitting data over other wireless networks. Turn off Bluetooth™ and Wi-Fi® when you don't need these features. You can turn them on and off more easily by adding the Quick settings widget to your Home screen. Use the STAMINA mode and Low battery mode features to reduce battery consumption. You can select the power saving mode that best suits the way you use your device. You can also customise the settings of each power saving mode. Set your synchronisation applications (used to synchronise your email, calendar and contacts) to synchronise manually. You can also synchronise automatically, but increase the synchronisation intervals. Check the battery usage menu in your device to see which applications use the most power. Your battery consumes more power when you use video and music streaming 13 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • applications, such as YouTube™. Some applications downloaded from Google Play™ may also consume more power. Close and exit applications that you are not using. Lower the screen display brightness level. Turn off your device or activate the Airplane mode setting if you are in an area with no network coverage. Otherwise, your device repeatedly scans for available networks, and this consumes power. Use a Sony original handsfree device to listen to music. Handsfree devices demand less battery power than your device's own loudspeakers. Keep your device in standby mode whenever possible. Standby time refers to the time during your device is connected to the network and is not being used. Disable any live wallpaper. To access the battery usage menu From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management > Battery usage. • • • • • To add the Data traffic widget to your Home screen Tap and hold an empty area of your Home screen. Tap Widgets > Tools. Tap and hold the Mobile data widget, then drag it to an empty area of your Home screen. To add the Quick settings widget to your Home screen Tap and hold an empty area of your Home screen. Tap Widgets > Tools. Tap and hold the Quick settings widget, then drag it to an empty area of your Home screen. Using STAMINA mode Activate the STAMINA mode feature to pause your Wi-Fi® connection, data traffic and several power consuming applications when your screen is inactive. When STAMINA mode is active, you can still receive phone calls, and text and multimedia messages. You can also set up an applications list to allow some applications to keep running when your screen is inactive. Once the screen becomes active again, all paused functions are resumed. To activate STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to STAMINA mode, then tap Activate. To deactivate STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to STAMINA mode. To change the settings for STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. To open the settings menu, tap STAMINA mode. Add or remove applications, as desired. When you're finished, tap Done. Estimating the standby time of your device Standby time refers to the amount of time the battery can last when your device is connected to the network but is not in active use, for example, to receive or make phone calls. STAMINA mode, when activated, continuously evaluates the remaining standby time, which can vary depending on how you use your device. STAMINA mode is more effective in lengthening the standby time if you keep the screen of your 14 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. device locked. If you rarely lock the screen, you may not see much improvement in battery performance. When you use your device for the first time, the estimated standby time may not be accurate since there is no previous usage history to estimate from. To view the estimated standby time From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Using Low battery mode You can activate the Low battery mode feature when the battery level is low. This feature helps you to adjust the settings for screen brightness, data traffic and the vibrate function so that you can reduce battery consumption. To activate Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to Low battery mode, then tap Activate. To deactivate Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to Low battery mode. To change the settings for Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. To open the settings menu, tap Low battery mode. Adjust the settings as desired. When you're finished, tap . Using the touchscreen A protective plastic sheet is already attached to the screen of your device when you buy it. You should peel off this sheet before using the touchscreen. Otherwise, the touchscreen might not function properly. When your device is on and left idle for a set period of time, the screen darkens to save battery power, and locks automatically. This lock prevents unwanted actions on the touchscreen when you are not using it. You can also set personal locks to protect your subscription and make sure only you can access content on your device. The device screen is made from glass. Do not touch the screen if the glass is cracked or shattered. Avoid trying to repair a damaged screen yourself. Glass screens are sensitive to drops and mechanical shocks. Cases of negligent care are not covered by the Sony warranty service. • To open or highlight an item Tap the item. Marking options Marked checkbox Unmarked checkbox Marked list option Unmarked list option 15 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To mark or unmark options Tap the relevant checkbox or list option. Zooming The zoom options available depend on the application you are using. To zoom • Place two fingers on the screen at once and pinch them together (to zoom out) or spread them apart (to zoom in). When you use two fingers on the screen to zoom, it is only possible to zoom if both fingers are within the zoomable area. If you, for example, want to zoom in on a photo, make sure that both fingers are within the photo frame area. Scrolling Scroll by moving your finger up or down on the screen. On some web pages you can also scroll to the sides. Dragging or flicking will not activate anything on the screen. To scroll • Drag or flick your finger in the direction you want to scroll on the screen. To scroll more quickly, flick your finger in the direction you want to go on the screen. 16 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To flick • To scroll more quickly, flick your finger in the direction you want to go on the screen. You can wait for the scrolling movement to stop by itself, or you can stop it immediately by tapping the screen. Sensors Your device has sensors that detect both light and proximity. The light sensor detects the ambient light level and adjusts the brightness of the screen accordingly. The proximity sensor turns the touch screen off during voice calls when your ear is close to the screen. This prevents you from unintentionally activating other functions on your device when you are engaged in a call. Using the lockscreen On the lockscreen, you can play tracks, take photos and record videos without unlocking the screen. To take a photo from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . To activate the camera controls, drag to the left across the screen. Tap . To play an audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . To display the music player controls, drag to the right across the screen. Tap . To pause an audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key When the music player controls appear, tap . 17 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To change the currently playing audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . When the music player controls appear, tap or . Home screen The Home screen is your gateway to the main features on your device. You can customise your Home screen with widgets, shortcuts, folders, themes, wallpaper and other items. The Home screen extends beyond the regular screen display width, so you need to flick left or right to view content in all of the Home screen's panes. shows which part of the Home screen you are in. You can set a pane as the main Home screen pane, and add or delete panes. The items in the bar at the bottom of the screen are always available for quick access. • To go to the Home screen Press . • To browse the Home screen Flick right or left. To set a pane as the main Home screen pane Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse to the pane that you want to set as your main Home screen pane, then tap . To add a pane to your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse the panes, then tap . 18 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete a pane from your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse to the pane that you want to delete, then tap . Widgets Widgets are small applications that you can use directly on your Home screen. For example, the “WALKMAN” widget allows you to start playing music directly. Some widgets are resizable, so you can expand them to view more content or shrink them to save space on your Home screen. To add a widget to the Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates, then tap Widgets. Find and tap the widget that you want to add. To resize a widget Touch and hold a widget until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then release the widget. If the widget can be resized, for example, the Calendar widget, then a highlighted frame and resizing dots appear. Drag the dots inward or outward to shrink or expand the widget. To confirm the new size of the widget, tap anywhere on the Home screen. Rearranging your Home screen Customise the appearance of your Home screen and change the features that you can access from it. Change the screen background, move items around, create folders, and add shortcuts and widgets. Customisation options When you touch and hold an empty area of your Home screen, the following customisation options appear: Add widgets to your Home screen. Add applications and shortcuts. Set a wallpaper for your Home screen. Set a background theme. • To view customisation options from the Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates and customisation options appear at the bottom of the screen. To add a shortcut to your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Apps > Shortcuts. Select a shortcut. You can add an application shortcut directly from the Application screen by touching and holding the application. • To move an item on the Home screen Touch and hold the item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the new location. • To delete an item from the Home screen Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to . 19 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 • To create a folder on the Home screen Touch and hold an application icon or a shortcut until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag and drop it on top of another application icon or shortcut. Enter a name for the folder and tap Done. To add items to a folder on the Home screen Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the folder. To rename a folder on the Home screen Tap the folder to open it. Tap the folder's title bar to show the Folder name field. Enter the new folder name and tap Done. Changing the background of your Home screen Adapt the Home screen to your own style using wallpapers and different themes. To change your Home screen wallpaper Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Wallpapers and select an option. To set a theme for your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Themes, then select a theme. When you change a theme, the background also changes in some applications. Accessing and using applications Open applications from shortcuts on your Home screen or from the Application screen. Application screen The Application screen, which you open from your Home screen, contains the applications that come pre-installed on your device as well as the applications you download. The Application screen extends beyond the regular screen width, so you need to flick left and right to view all content. To open the Application screen • From your Home screen, tap • To browse the Application screen From the Application screen, flick right or left. 20 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a shortcut to an application on the Home screen From your Home screen, tap . Touch and hold an application icon until the screen vibrates, then drag the icon to the top of the screen. The Home screen opens. Drag the icon to the desired location on the Home screen, then release your finger. To share an application from your Application screen From your Home screen, tap . Tap , then tap Share. All applications which can be shared are indicated by Tap the application that you want to share, then select an option and confirm, if necessary. A link to a download of the application is sent to the people you have selected. Opening and closing applications • To open an application From your Home screen or the Application screen, tap the application. • To close an application Press . to exit, while other applications may Some applications are paused when you press continue to run in the background. In the first case, the next time you open the application, you can continue where you left off. Remember that some applications may cause data connection charges when they are running in the background, for example, social networking services. Recently used applications window You can switch between recently used applications from this window. You can also open small apps. • To open the recently used applications window Press . The recently used applications window appears on the right of the screen. Using small apps From the recently used applications window, you can get quick access to several small apps at any time using the small apps bar. A small app only takes up a small area of your screen. So you can interact with a small app and another application at the same time on the same screen. • To open the small apps bar Press . The small apps bar appears at the bottom of the screen. To open a small app To make the small apps bar appear, press Tap the small app that you want to open. A small app window appears. • To close a small app Tap on the small app window. 21 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To move a small app When the small app is open, touch and hold the top left corner of the small app, then move it to the desired location. • To minimise a small app When the small app is open, touch and hold the top left corner of the small app, then drag it to the right edge or to the bottom edge of the screen. To rearrange your small apps To make the small apps bar appear, press . Touch and hold a small app and drag it to the desired position in the small apps bar. To remove a small app from the small apps bar To make the small apps bar appear, press . Touch and hold a small app icon and drag it away from the small apps bar. To restore a previously removed small app To make the small apps bar appear, press . Tap > Installed small apps. Select the small app that you want to restore. To download a small app To make the small apps bar appear, press . Tap > . Find a small app that you want to download, then follow the instructions to complete the installation. Application menu You can open a menu at any time when you are using an application. The menu will look different depending on which application you are using. • To open a menu in an application While using the application, press . A menu is not available in all applications. Rearranging your Application screen Move the applications around on the Application screen according to your preferences. To arrange applications on the Application screen From your Home screen, tap to go to the Application screen. Tap the drop-down list on the top left of the screen and select an option. To move an application on the Application screen Open the Application screen. Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the new location. You can only move your applications when Own order is selected. To uninstall an application from the Application screen From your Home screen, tap . Tap , then tap Uninstall. All uninstallable applications are indicated by Tap the application that you want to uninstall, then tap Uninstall. 22 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Status and notifications The status bar at the top of your screen shows what's going on in your device. To the left you get notifications when there is something new or ongoing. For example, new message and calendar notifications appear here. The right side shows the signal strength, battery status, and other information. The status bar allows you to adjust basic settings on your device, for example, Wi-Fi®, Bluetooth™, data traffic, and sound. You can also open the settings menu from the Notification panel to change other settings. A notification light also gives you battery status information and some notifications. For example, a flashing blue light means there is a new message or a missed call. The notification light may not work when the battery level is low. Checking notifications and ongoing activities You can drag down the status bar to open the Notification panel and get more information. For example, you can use the panel to open a new message or view a calendar event. You can also open some applications that run in the background, such as the music player. To open the Notification panel • Drag the status bar downwards. 23 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To close the Notification panel • Drag the tab at the bottom of the Notification panel upwards. • To open a running application from the Notification panel Tap the icon for the running application to open it. • To dismiss a notification from the Notification panel Place your finger on a notification and flick left or right. • To clear the Notification panel From the Notification panel, tap Clear. Setting your device from the Notification panel You can open the settings menu from the Notification panel to adjust basic device settings. For example, you can turn on Wi-Fi®. To open the device settings menu from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To adjust sound settings from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To control the Bluetooth™ function from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To control the Wi-Fi® function from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To enable or disable data traffic from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . Settings menu View and change settings for your device from the Settings menu. 24 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To access your device settings From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings. You can also drag the status bar downwards on the Home screen and tap device settings. to access your Typing text You can select from a number of keyboards and input methods to type text containing letters, numbers and other characters. On-screen keyboard Tap the keys of the on-screen QWERTY keyboard to enter text conveniently. Some applications open the on-screen keyboard automatically. You can also open this keyboard by touching a text field. Using the on-screen keyboard 1 Change the character case and turn on the caps lock. For some languages, this key is used to access extra characters in the language. 2 Close the on-screen keyboard view. Note that this icon does not appear in portrait mode. 3 Display numbers and symbols. 4 Personalise your keyboard. This key disappears after the keyboard is personalised. 5 Enter a space. 6 Enter a carriage return or confirm text input. 7 Delete a character before the cursor. All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual device. • To display the on-screen keyboard to enter text Tap a text entry field. • To hide the on-screen keyboard When the on-screen keyboard is open, tap To personalise the on-screen keyboard Open the on-screen keyboard, then tap . Follow the instructions to personalise your on-screen keyboard, for example, mark the Smiley key checkbox. If you don't mark the Smiley key checkbox when you personalise the on-screen keyboard, the smiley icon will not appear. 25 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To use the on-screen keyboard in landscape orientation When you enter text, turn the device sideways. For the keyboard to support this feature, landscape mode must be supported by the application you are using, and your screen orientation settings must be set to automatic. To enter text using the on-screen keyboard To enter a character visible on the keyboard, tap the character. To enter a character variant, touch and hold a regular keyboard character to get a list of available options, then select from the list. For example, to enter "é", touch and hold "e" until other options appear, then, while keeping your finger pressed on the keyboard, drag to and select "é". • To shift between upper-case and lower-case letters Before you enter a letter, tap to switch to upper-case • To turn on the caps lock Before you type a word, touch and hold or until , or vice versa. appears. • To enter numbers or symbols When you enter text, tap . A keyboard with numbers and symbols appears. to view more options. Tap To enter common punctuation marks When you finish entering a word, tap the space bar. Select a punctuation mark from the candidate bar. The selected mark is inserted before the space. To quickly enter a full stop, tap the space bar twice when you finish entering a word. • To delete characters Tap to place the cursor after the character you want to delete, then tap • To enter a carriage return When you enter text, tap to enter a carriage return. To select text Enter some text, then double-tap the text. The word you tap gets highlighted by tabs on both sides. Drag the tabs left or right to select more text. To edit text in landscape orientation Enter some text, then double-tap the entered text. Select the text you want to work with, then tap Edit... and select an option. To paste text from the clipboard, double-tap the text field to make Paste appear, then tap Paste. To edit text in portrait orientation Enter some text, then double-tap the entered text to make the application bar appear. Select the text you want to edit, then use the application bar to make your desired changes. To paste text from the clipboard, double-tap the text field to make Paste appear, then tap Paste. 26 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Application bar Close the application bar Select all text Cut text Copy text Paste text only appears when you have text stored on the clipboard. Using the Gesture input function to write words You can input text by sliding your finger from letter to letter on the on-screen keyboard. Gesture input is only available when you use the on-screen keyboard. To enter text using the Gesture input function When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard, slide your finger from letter to letter to trace the word you want to write. Lift up your finger when you’ve finished entering a word. A word is suggested based on the letters you have traced. If necessary, select the correct word in the candidate bar. To view more options, scroll right or left in the word candidate bar. If you once to delete the entire word. Then try cannot find the desired word, tap again to trace the word using the Gesture input function, or tap each letter to enter the word. If the Space between gestures setting is activated, trace the next word that you want to enter. If not, tap the space bar and then trace the next word you want to enter. To enter joined compound words when the Space between gestures setting is activated, you may need to slide to enter the first part of the word, then tap each letter to enter the rest of the word. To change the Gesture input settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard, tap . Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Text input settings. Mark or unmark the Gesture input checkbox. If you want to automatically add a space between gestures without having to tap the space bar each time, mark the Space between gestures checkbox. Phonepad The Phonepad is similar to a standard 12-key telephone keypad. It gives you predictive text and multi-tap input options. You can activate the Phonepad text input method via the keyboard settings. The Phonepad is only available in portrait orientation. 27 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using the Phonepad Choose a text input option Change the character case and turn on the caps lock Display numbers Display symbols and smileys Enter a space Enter a carriage return or confirm text input Delete a character before the cursor All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual device. To open the Phonepad for the first time Tap a text entry field, then tap . Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Keyboard appearance > Keyboard layout. Select the Phonepad. The Phonepad can only be used in portrait mode. • • • To enter text using the Phonepad When appears in the Phonepad, tap each character key only once, even if the letter you want is not the first letter on the key. Tap the word that appears or tap to view more word suggestions and select a word from the list. When appears in the Phonepad, tap the on-screen key for the character you want to enter. Keep pressing this key until the desired character is selected. Then do the same for the next character you want to enter, and so on. To enter numbers using the Phonepad When the Phonepad is open, tap . A Phonepad with numbers appears. To insert symbols and smileys using the Phonepad When the Phonepad is open, tap . A grid with symbols and smileys appears. Scroll up or down to view more options. Tap a symbol or smiley to select it. Keyboard and Phonepad settings You can select settings for the on-screen keyboard and the Phonepad, such as writing language and automatic correction. 28 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To access the on-screen keyboard and Phonepad settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. or To add a writing language for text input or When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Languages > Writing languages and mark the relevant checkboxes. Tap OK to confirm. Text input settings When entering text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, you can access a text input settings menu that helps you set options for text prediction, automatic spacing and quick fixes. For example, you can decide how word options are presented and how words get corrected as you type. You can also set the text input application to remember new words that you write. To change the text input settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings > Text input settings and select the relevant settings. or Entering text using voice input When you enter text, you can use the voice input function instead of typing the words. Just speak the words that you want to enter. Voice input is an experimental technology from Google™, and is available for a number of languages and regions. To enable voice input When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings . Mark the Google voice typing key checkbox. to save your settings. A microphone icon appears on your onPress screen keyboard or Phonepad. or To enter text using voice input Open the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad. If is available, tap it. If not, touch and hold the input language key, for example, When appears, speak to enter text. When you're finished, tap again. The suggested text appears. Edit the text manually if necessary. Customising your device You can adjust several device settings to suit your own needs. For example, you can change the language, add a personal ringtone, or change the screen brightness. Adjusting the volume You can adjust the ringtone volume for incoming calls and notifications as well as for music and video playback. • To adjust the ring volume with the volume key Press the volume key up or down. • To adjust the media playing volume with the volume key When playing music or watching video, press the volume key up or down. 29 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Adjusting the sound settings You can adjust several sound settings. For example, you can set your device to silent mode so that it doesn't ring when you're in a meeting. • To set your device to vibrate mode Press the volume key down until appears in the status bar. You can also press and hold down the power key to set your device to vibrate mode. in the menu that opens To set your device to silent mode Press the volume key down until the device vibrates and appears in the status bar. Press the volume key down again. appears in the status bar. You can also press and hold down the power key to set your device to silent mode. and then tap and then tap in the menu that opens To set your device to vibrate and ring mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Vibrate when ringing checkbox. Time and date You can change the time and date on your device. To set the date manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic date & time checkbox, if it is marked. Tap Set date. Adjust the date by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. To set the time manually From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic date & time checkbox if it is marked. Tap Set time. Scroll up or down to adjust the hour and minute. If applicable, scroll up to change am to pm, or vice versa. Tap Done. To set the time zone From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic time zone checkbox, if it is marked. Tap Select time zone. Select an option. Ringtone settings To set a ringtone From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound > Phone ringtone. Select a ringtone. Tap Done. 30 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To enable touch tones From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Dial pad touch tones and Touch sounds checkboxes. To select the notification sound From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound > Default notification. Select the sound to be played when notifications arrive. Tap Done. Screen settings To adjust the screen brightness From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display > Brightness. Drag the slider to adjust the brightness. Tap OK. The brightness level affects your battery performance. For tips on how to improve battery performance, see Improving battery performance. To set the screen to vibrate From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Vibrate on touch checkbox. The screen now vibrates when you tap soft keys and certain applications. To adjust the idle time before the screen turns off From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display > Sleep. Select an option. To turn off the screen quickly, briefly press the power key To keep the screen active while your device is charging From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Developer options. Mark the Stay awake checkbox. Language settings You can select a default language for your device and change it again at a later time. To change the language From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Language & input > Language. Select an option. Tap OK. If you select the wrong language and cannot read the menu texts, find and tap . Then select the text beside and select the first entry in the menu that opens. You can then select the language you want. Airplane mode In Airplane mode, the network and radio transceivers are turned off to prevent disturbance to sensitive equipment. However, you can still play games, listen to music, watch videos and other content, as long as all this content is saved on your 31 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. memory card or internal storage. You can also be notified by alarms, if alarms are activated. Turning on Airplane mode reduces battery consumption. To turn on Airplane mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Mark the Airplane mode checkbox. You can also press and hold down the power key menu that opens. and then select Airplane mode in the Enhancing the sound output You can enhance the sound output that comes from the speakers in your device using features such as Clear Phase™ and xLOUD™ technology. Using Clear Phase™ technology Use Clear Phase™ technology from Sony to automatically adjust the sound quality coming from your device's internal speakers and get a cleaner, more natural sound. To enhance the speaker sound quality using Clear Phase™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Clear Phase™ checkbox. The activation of the Clear Phase™ feature has no effect on voice communication applications. For example, there is no change in the voice call sound quality. Using xLOUD™ technology Use xLOUD™ audio filter technology from Sony to enhance the speaker volume without sacrificing quality. Get a more dynamic sound as you listen to your favourite songs. To enhance the speaker volume using xLOUD™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the xLOUD™ checkbox. The activation of the xLOUD™ feature has no effect on voice communication applications. For example, there is no change in the voice call sound quality. Memory You can save content to your device's internal storage and to a memory card. Memory card Your device supports a microSD™ memory card, which is used for storing content. This type of card can also be used as a portable memory card with other compatible devices. You may have to purchase a memory card separately. Formatting the memory card You can format the memory card in your device, for example, to free up memory. This means that you erase all data on the card. All content on the memory card gets erased when you format it. Make sure you make backups of everything you want to save before formatting the memory card. To back up your content, 32 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. you can copy it to your computer. For more information, refer to the chapter Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. Using a headset Use the accessories provided with your device, or other compatible accessories, for optimal performance. To use a headset Connect the headset to your device. To answer a call, press the call handling key. To end the call, press the call handling key. If a headset is not included with the device, you may purchase one separately. If you are listening to music, the music stops when you answer a call and resumes after you end the call. Internet and messaging settings To send text and multimedia messages and to access the Internet, you must have a mobile data connection and the correct settings. There are different ways to get these settings: • • • For most mobile networks and operators, Internet and messaging settings come preinstalled on your device. You can then start using the Internet and send messages right away. In some cases you will get the option to download Internet and messaging settings the first time you turn on your device. It is also possible to download these settings later from the Settings menu. You can manually add and change Internet and network settings on your device at any time. Contact your network operator for detailed information about Internet and messaging settings. To download Internet and messaging settings From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Internet settings. Tap Accept. To reset the default Internet settings From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Access Point Names. Tap . Tap Reset to default. Access Point Names (APNs) An APN is used to establish data connections between your device and the Internet. The APN defines which type of IP address to use, which security methods to invoke, and which fixed-end connections to use. Checking the APN is useful when you 33 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. cannot access the Internet, have no data connection, or cannot send or receive multimedia messages. To view the current APN From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Tap Access Point Names. If you have several available connections, the active network connection is indicated by a marked button. To add Internet settings manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Access Point Names. Tap . Tap New APN. Tap Name and enter the name of the network profile that you want to create. Tap APN and enter the access point name. Enter all other information required by your network operator. Tap , then tap Save. Usage info For quality purposes, Sony collects anonymous bug reports and statistics regarding your device. None of the information gathered includes personal data. To allow the sending of usage info From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Usage info settings. Mark the Send usage info checkbox if it is not already marked. Tap Agree to allow the sending of usage information. Controlling data usage Keep track of and control the amount of data transferred to and from your device during a given period. For example, you can set data usage warnings and limits for your device to avoid additional charges. You can also limit the amount of data used by individual applications. Adjusting data usage settings can help you keep greater control over data usage but cannot guarantee the prevention of additional charges. To access data usage settings From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To turn data traffic on or off From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To turn data traffic on or off, tap the on-off switch beside Mobile data accordingly. You can also turn data traffic on or off by marking or unmarking the Mobile data traffic checkbox under Settings > More… > Mobile networks. To set a data usage warning Make sure that you have turned on data traffic. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To set the warning level, drag the lines to the desired values. You receive a warning notification when the amount of data traffic approaches the level you set. 34 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set a data usage limit Make sure that you have turned on data traffic. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. Mark the Set mobile data limit checkbox if it is not marked, then tap OK. To set the data usage limit, drag the lines to the desired values. Once your data usage reaches the set limit, data traffic on your device will be turned off automatically. To control the data usage of individual applications From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. Find and tap the desired application. Make the necessary adjustments to change the data usage limit, restrict background data, or restrict all data traffic for the application. To access more specific settings for the application, tap View app settings and make the desired changes. Specific settings for an application may not always be accessible. The performance of individual applications may be affected if you change the related data usage settings. Mobile network settings Your device automatically switches between mobile networks depending on what mobile networks are available in different areas. You can also manually set your device to use a particular mobile network mode, for example, WCDMA or GSM. To select a network mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Tap Network Mode. Select a network mode. To select another network manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Network operators. Tap Search mode > Manual. Select a network. If you select a network manually, your device will not search for other networks, even if you move out of range of the manually selected network. To activate automatic network selection From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Network operators. When a pop-up window appears, tap Search mode. Tap Automatic. Turning off data traffic You can disable all data connections over mobile networks to avoid any unwanted data downloads and synchronisations. Contact your network operator if you need detailed information about your subscription plan and data traffic charges. When data traffic is turned off, you can still use Wi-Fi® and Bluetooth™ connections. You can also send and receive multimedia messages. 35 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn off all data traffic From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Unmark the Mobile data traffic checkbox. Data roaming Some network operators allow mobile data connections via mobile networks when you are outside of your home network (roaming). Note that data transmission charges may apply. Contact your network operator for more information. Applications may sometimes use the Internet connection in your home network without any notification, for example, when sending search and synchronisation requests. Additional charges may apply when such Internet connections are established while you are roaming. Consult your network operator for more information. To activate data roaming From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Mark the Data roaming checkbox. You can’t activate data roaming when data connections have been deactivated. 36 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Play™ Getting started with Google Play™ Open Google Play™ and enter a world of applications and games. You can browse these applications and games through different categories. You can also rate an application or game and send feedback on it. To use Google Play™, you need to have a Google™ account. See To set up a Google™ account on your device on page 54. Google Play™ may not be available in all countries or regions To open Google Play™ From the Home screen, tap Find and tap Play Store. Downloading from Google Play™ You can download all kinds of applications from Google Play™, including free applications. Before you download applications Before you start downloading from Google Play™, make sure that you have a working Internet connection. Also, remember that you might incur data traffic charges when you download content to your device. Contact your operator for more information. To download a free application In Google Play™, find an item you wish to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details, and follow the instructions to complete the installation. To download a paid application In Google Play™, find an item you wish to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details, and follow the instructions to complete your purchase. To open a downloaded application In Google Play™, press , then tap My Apps. Tap the downloaded application. You can also access downloaded applications from the Application screen. Clearing your application data You may sometimes need to clear data for an application. This might happen if, for example, the application memory becomes full, or you want to clear high scores for a game. You might also want to erase incoming email, text and multimedia messages in some applications. 37 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To clear all cache for an application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Tap the application for which you want to clear all cache. Tap Clear cache. It is not possible to clear the cache for some applications. To delete an installed application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Select the application that you want to delete. Tap Uninstall. It is not possible to delete some preinstalled applications. Permissions Some applications may need to access data, settings and various functions on your device in order to work properly. If so, then they need the relevant permissions from you. For example, a navigation application needs permissions to send and receive data traffic, and access your location. Some applications might misuse their permissions by stealing or deleting data, or by reporting your location. Make sure you only install and give permissions to applications you trust. To view permissions of an application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Tap the desired application. Scroll down to view the relevant details under Permissions. Installing applications not from Google Play™ Installing applications of unknown or unreliable origin can damage your device. By default, your device is set to block such installations. However, you can change this setting and allow installations from unknown sources. Sony does not warrant or guarantee the performance of any third-party applications or content transferred via download or other interface to your device. Similarly, Sony is not responsible for any damage or reduced performance of your device attributable to the transfer of thirdparty content. Only use content from reliable sources. Contact the content provider if you have any questions or concerns. To allow the installation of applications not from Google Play™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security. Mark the Unknown sources checkbox. Tap OK. 38 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Calling Emergency calls Your device supports international emergency numbers, for example, 112 or 911. You can normally use these numbers to make emergency calls in any country, with or without the SIM card inserted if you are within range of a network. To make an emergency call From your Home screen, tap . Find and Tap Phone. Enter the emergency number and tap Call. To delete a number, tap You can make emergency calls when no SIM card is inserted or when outgoing calls are barred. To make an emergency call while the SIM card is locked Tap Emergency call. Enter the emergency number and tap Call. To delete a number, tap Call handling You can make a call by manually dialling a phone number, by tapping a number saved in your contact list, or by tapping the phone number in your call log view. You can also use the smart dial feature to quickly find numbers from your contact list and call logs. To dial a phone number From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap . If the call log appears, tap to enter the dialpad view. Enter the phone number and tap . To delete a digit entered by mistake, tap To make a call using smart dial From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Use the dialpad to enter letters or numbers that correspond to the contact you want to call. As you enter each letter or number, a list of possible matches appears. Tap the contact you want to call. • To end a call Tap End call. To make an international call From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Touch and hold 0 until a “+” sign appears. Enter the country code, area code (without the first 0) and phone number, then tap Call. 39 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To answer a call • Drag • To decline a call Drag to the left across the screen. • To reject a second call When you hear repeated beeps during a call, tap • To change the ear speaker volume during a call Press the volume key up or down. • To turn on the loudspeaker during a call Tap . • To mute the microphone during a call Tap . • To activate the screen during a call Briefly press . To enter numbers during a call During the call, tap Dialpad. A keypad appears. Tap the numbers you want to enter. • To mute the ringtone for an incoming call When you receive the call, press the volume key. to the right across the screen. Recent calls In the call log, you can view missed To view your missed calls When you have missed a call, downwards. Tap Missed call. and dialled calls. appears in the status bar. Drag the status bar To call a number from your call log From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone.The call log view appears on the upper part of the screen. To call a number directly, tap the number. To edit a number before calling, touch and hold the number, then tap Edit number before call. You can also call a number by tapping , received > Call back. To add a number from the call log to your contacts From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone.The call log view appears on the upper part of the screen. Touch and hold the number, then tap Add to Contacts. Tap the desired contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact details and tap Done. 40 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Voicemail If your subscription includes a voicemail service, callers can leave voice messages for you when you can't answer calls. Your voicemail service number is normally saved on your SIM card. If not, you can get the number from your service provider and enter it manually. To enter your voicemail number From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Voicemail >Voicemail settings > Voicemail number. Enter your voicemail number. Tap OK. To call your voicemail service From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Touch and hold 1. Multiple calls If you have activated call waiting, you can handle multiple calls at the same time. When it is activated, you will be notified by a beep if you receive another call. To activate or deactivate call waiting From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Additional settings. To activate or deactivate call waiting, tap Call waiting. • To answer a second call and put the ongoing call on hold When you hear repeated beeps during a call, tap . To make a second call During an ongoing call, tap Dialpad. Enter the number of the recipient and tap Call. The first call is put on hold. The same procedure applies to subsequent calls. • To switch between multiple calls To switch to another call and put the current call on hold, tap • To end the ongoing call and return to the next call on hold Tap End call. Conference calls With a conference or multiparty call, you can have a joint conversation with two or more persons. For details on the number of participants you can add to a conference call, contact your network operator. To make a conference call During an ongoing call, tap Dialpad. Dial the number of the second participant and tap Call. After the second participant answers, the first participant is put on hold. to add the second participant to the conference call. Tap Repeat steps 1 to 3 to add more call participants. 41 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To have a private conversation with a conference call participant During an ongoing conference call, tap {0} participants. Tap the telephone number of the participant with whom you want to talk privately. To end the private conversation and return to the conference call, tap . To release a participant from a conference call During an ongoing conference call, tap the button showing the number of participants. For example, tap 3 participants if there are three participants. Tap next to the participant you want to release. • To end a conference call During the conference call, tap End conference call. Call settings Barring calls You can bar all or certain categories of incoming and outgoing calls. When you use call barring for the first time, you need to enter your PUK (Personal Unblocking Key) and then a new password to activate the call barring function. To bar incoming or outgoing calls From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call barring. Select an option. Enter the password and tap Enable. Rejecting a call with a message You can reject a call with a predefined message. When you reject a call with such a message, the message is automatically sent to the caller and saved on your device. Six messages are predefined on your device. You can select from these predefined messages, which can also be edited if necessary. • • To reject a call with a predefined message Drag Reject with message upward, then select a message. To reject a second call with a predefined message When you hear repeated beeps during a call, drag Reject with message upward, then select a message. To edit the message used to reject a call From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Reject call with message. Tap the message you want to edit, then make the necessary changes. When you're done, tap OK. Forwarding calls You can forward calls, for example, to another phone number, or to an answering service. To forward calls From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call forwarding. Select an option. Enter the number you want to forward the calls to, then tap Enable. 42 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn off call forwarding From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call forwarding. Select an option, then tap Disable. Showing or hiding your phone number You can select to show or hide your phone number on call recipients' devices when you call them. To show or hide your phone number From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Additional settings > Caller ID. Fixed Dialling Numbers If you have received a PIN2 code from your service provider, you can use a list of Fixed Dialling Numbers (FDN) to restrict outgoing calls. To enable or disable fixed dialling From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Fixed dialling numbers. Tap Activate fixed dialling or Deactivate fixed dialling. Enter your PIN2 and tap OK. To access the list of accepted call recipients From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Fixed dialling numbers > Fixed dialling numbers. 43 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts About Contacts Use the Contacts application to store and manage all your numbers, email addresses, and other contact data in one place. Just tap on a contact to see all communications with that contact in one easy overview. You can add new contacts in your device and synchronise them with contacts saved in your Google™ account, Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account, or other accounts that support synchronisation. The Contacts application automatically creates new entries and also helps you match data such as email addresses with existing entries. Transferring contacts to your new device There are several ways to transfer contacts to your new device. Select a transfer method that best suits your situation. Transferring contacts using a PC You can use a PC to transfer contacts from several device brands, including iPhone, Samsung, HTC and Nokia. You need: • • • • • An Internet-connected PC running Windows® A USB cable for your old device A USB cable for your new Android™ device Your old device Your new Android™ device Using the PC Companion program to transfer contacts If you are transferring contacts using a PC, use the PC Companion program. It's free, and the installation files are already saved on your new device. PC Companion also offers a range of other features, including help to update your device software. To install PC Companion New device: Turn on your new Android™ device and connect it to a PC using a USB cable. New device: Tap Install to install PC Companion on the PC. Computer: If a popup window appears to notify you about available PC software, select Run Startme.exe. Computer: Click Install to start the installation and then follow the instructions to complete the installation. To transfer contacts to your new device using PC Companion Make sure that PC Companion is installed on your PC. Open the PC Companion program on the PC, then click Contacts Setup and follow the instructions to transfer your contacts. Transferring contacts using an Apple® Mac® computer For detailed instructions on how to use an Apple Mac computer to transfer contacts from your old device, go to Transfer your contacts. Transferring contacts using synchronisation accounts Your device works with popular online synchronisation accounts such as Google Sync™, Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync®or Facebook™. If you have synced the contacts in your old device or your computer with an online account, you can transfer 44 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. your contacts to your new device using that account. For more detailed information about synchronisation, see Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts on page 110. To synchronise contacts on your device with a synchronisation account From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap , then tap Settings > Accounts & sync. If you have already set up a synchronisation account and you want to sync with that account, tap the account, then tap , and tap Sync now. Transferring contacts from a SIM card To import contacts from a SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Import contacts > SIM card. If you have set up a synchronisation account, you can choose to add the SIM card contacts under that account. Or you can choose to only use these contacts on your device. Select your desired option. To import an individual contact, find and tap the contact. To import all contacts, tap Import all. Transferring contacts from a memory card To import contacts from a memory card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Import contacts > SD card. If you have set up a synchronisation account, you can add the imported memory card contacts under that account. Or you can choose to only use the imported contacts on your device. Select your desired option. If you have more than one vCard file on the SD card, a list appears showing different batches of contacts saved on your device, with the corresponding dates for when they were created. Select the batch that you want to import. Receiving contacts from other devices To receive contact data sent using Bluetooth™ technology Make sure you have the Bluetooth™ function turned on and your device set to visible. If not, then you cannot receive data from other devices. When you are asked to confirm whether you want to receive the file, tap Accept. Drag down the Notification panel and tap the file you received to import the contact data. To receive contacts sent using a messaging service When you receive a new text message, multimedia message, or email message, open the message. The received contact data appears as a vCard attachment. Tap, or touch and hold the vCard file to open a menu so you can save the contact data. 45 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts screen overview Shortcut tabs Tap a contact to view its details Alphabetical index for browsing contacts Tap a contact thumbnail to access the quick contact menu Search for contacts Create a contact Open more options Managing your contacts You can create, edit and synchronise your contacts in a few simple steps. You can select contacts saved in different accounts and manage how you display them on your device. If you synchronise your contacts with more than one account, you can join contacts on your device to avoid duplicates. Some synchronisation services, for example, some social networking services, do not allow you to edit contact details. • To view your contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Your contacts are listed here. To select which contacts to display in the Contacts application From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Filter. In the list that appears, mark and unmark the desired options. If you have synchronised your contacts with a synchronisation account, that account appears in the list. To further expand the list of options, tap the account. When you are finished, tap OK. 46 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To add a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap . If you have synchronised your contacts with one or more accounts, select the account to which you want to add this contact, or tap Phone contact if you only want to use this contact on your device. Enter or select the desired information for the contact. When you are finished, tap Done. If you add a plus sign and the country code before a contact's phone number, you do not have to edit the number again when you make calls from other countries. To edit a contact From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to edit, then tap . Edit the desired information. When you are finished, tap Done. To associate a picture with a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to edit, then tap . Tap and select the desired method for adding the contact picture. When you have added the picture, tap Done. You can also add a picture to a contact directly from the Album application. To view your communication with a contact From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to view. To view your communication with the contact for different media, tap or flick through the filter items at the bottom of the screen. To delete contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Touch and hold the contact you want to delete. To delete all contacts, press , then tap Mark several. Tap the downwards arrow to open the drop down menu, then select Mark all. Tap , then tap OK. To edit contact information about yourself From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap Myself, then tap . Enter the new information or make the changes you want. When you are done, tap Done. Avoiding duplicate entries in the Contacts application If you synchronise your contacts with a new account or import contact information in other ways, you could end up with duplicate entries in the Contacts application. If this happens, you can join such duplicates to create a single entry. And if you join entries by mistake, you can separate them again later. To link contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to link with another contact. Press , then tap Link contact. Tap the contact whose information you want to join with the first contact, then tap OK to confirm. The information from the first contact is merged with the second contact, and the first contact is no longer displayed in the Contacts list. 47 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To separate linked contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the linked contact you want to edit, then tap Tap Unlink contact. Tap OK. Favourites You can mark contacts as favourites so that you can get quick access to them from the Contacts application. To mark or unmark a contact as a favourite From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to add to or remove from your favourites. Tap . To view your favourite contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap Tap . Groups You can assign contacts to groups to get quicker access to them from within the Contacts application. To assign a contact to a group In the Contacts application, tap the contact that you want to assign to a group. Tap , then tap the bar directly under Assign to group. Mark the checkboxes for the groups to which you want to add the contact, then tap Done. Tap Done. Communicating with your contacts To search for a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap and enter the first few letters of the contact name in the Search contacts field. All contacts beginning with those letters appear. The quick contact menu Tap a contact's thumbnail to view quick communication options for a particular contact. Options include calling the contact, sending a text or multimedia message, and starting a chat using the Google Talk™ application. For an application to appear as an option in the quick contact menu, you may need to set up the application in your device and be logged in to the application. For example, you need to start the Gmail™ application and enter your login details before you can use Gmail™ from the quick contact menu. Sharing your contacts To send your business card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap Myself. Press , then tap Send contact > OK. Select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. 48 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To send a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact whose details you want to send. Press , then tap Send contact > OK. Select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. To send several contacts at once From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Mark several. Mark the contacts you want to send, or select all if you want to send all contacts. Tap , then select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. Backing up contacts You can use a memory card, a SIM card or an online synchronisation tool such as Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® to back up contacts. To export all contacts to a memory card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Back up contacts > Memory Card. Tap OK. To export contacts to a SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Back up contacts > SIM card. Mark the contacts you want to export, or tap Mark all if you want to export all your contacts. Tap Back up. Select Add contacts if you want to add the contacts to existing contacts on your SIM card, or select Replace all contacts if you want to replace the existing contacts on your SIM card. When you export contacts to a SIM card, not all information may get exported. This is due to memory limitations on SIM cards. 49 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Messaging Using text and multimedia messaging You can send and receive text messages from your device using SMS (Short Message Service). If your subscription includes MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service), you can also send and receive messages that contain media files, for example, pictures and videos. The number of characters you can send in a single text message varies depending on the operator and the language you use. If you exceed the character limit, then all your single messages are linked together and sent as one message. You are charged for each single text message you send. When you view your messages, they appear as conversations, which means that all messages to and from a particular person are grouped together. To send multimedia messages, you need the correct MMS settings on your device. See Internet and messaging settings. To create and send a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap . Tap , then select the desired recipients from the Contacts list. If the recipient is not listed as a contact, enter the contact's number manually and tap . When you are finished adding recipients, tap Done. Tap Write message and enter your message text. If you want to add a media file, tap and select an option. To send the message, tap Send. If you exit a message before sending, it gets saved as a draft. The conversation gets tagged with the word Draft:. To read a received message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the desired conversation. If the message is not yet downloaded, tap and hold the message, then tap Download message. appears there. Just drag down the You can also open messages from the status bar when bar and tap the message. To reply to a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation containing the message. Enter your reply and tap Send. To forward a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the conversation containing the message you want to forward. Touch and hold the message you want to forward, then tap Forward message. Tap , then select a recipient from the Contacts list. If the recipient is not listed as a contact, enter the contact's number manually and tap . When you are finished adding recipients, tap Done. Edit the message, if necessary, and tap Send. In step 4, you can also tap To and enter the recipient's phone number manually. To delete a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation containing the message you want to delete. Touch and hold the message you want to delete, then tap Delete message > Delete. 50 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete conversations From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Delete conversations. Mark the checkboxes for the conversations that you want to delete, then tap > Delete. To save a sender's number From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap > Save. Select an existing contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact information and tap Done. To call a message sender From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap a conversation. Tap the recipient name or number at the top of the screen, then select the recipient name or number from the list that appears. If the recipient is saved in your contacts, tap the phone number that you want to call. If you have not saved the recipient in your contacts, tap . To save a file contained in a message you receive From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the conversation you want to open. If the message has not been downloaded yet, tap and hold the message, then tap Download message. Touch and hold the file you want to save, then select the desired option. To star a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation you want to open. In the message you want to star, tap . To unstar a message, tap . To view starred messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Starred messages. All starred messages appear in a list. To search for messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Search. Enter your search keywords, then tap the confirm key. Text and multimedia message options To change your message notification settings From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Settings. To set a notification sound, tap Notification tone and select an option. For other notification settings, check or uncheck the relevant checkboxes. To change the delivery report settings for outgoing messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Settings. Tap Delivery report to activate or deactivate delivery reports. To view messages saved on the SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Settings > SIM messages. 51 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Talk™ The Google Talk™ application lets you chat with your friends using text, voice and video. To start Google Talk™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Talk. To reply to an instant message with Google Talk™ appears in the status bar. When someone contacts you on Google Talk™, Drag the status bar downwards, then tap the message and begin to chat. 52 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Email Getting started with Email You can handle several email accounts at the same time using the Email application, including corporate Microsoft Exchange Active Sync accounts. Emails you receive to your Gmail™ account can be accessed on your device from both the Email and the Gmail™ applications. Using email accounts To set up an email account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Follow the instructions that appear on the screen to complete the setup. For some email services, you may need to contact your email service provider for information on detailed settings for the email account. To set an email account as your default account From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account you want to use as the default account for composing and sending emails. Mark the Default account checkbox. The inbox of the default account appears every time you open the email application. If you only have one email account, this account is automatically the default account. To add an extra email account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen, then tap Add account. Enter the email address and password, then tap Next. If the settings for the email account cannot be downloaded automatically, complete the setup manually. When prompted, enter a name for your email account so that it is easily identifiable. The same name shows in the emails you send from this account. When you are finished, tap Next. To remove an email account from your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account you want to remove. Tap Delete account > OK. Gmail™ and other Google™ services If you have a Google™ account, you can use the Gmail™ application on your device to read, write and organise email messages. After you set up your Google™ account to work on your device, you can also chat to friends using the Google Talk™ application, synchronise your calendar application with your Google Calendar™, and download applications and games from Google Play™. The services and features described in this chapter may not be supported in all countries or regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 53 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set up a Google™ account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Add account > Google. Follow the registration wizard to create a Google™ account, or sign in if you already have an account. You can also sign in to or create a Google™ account from the setup guide the first time you start your device. Or you can go online and create an account at www.google.com/accounts. To open the Gmail™ application From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Gmail . Using email To create and send an email message Make sure that you have set up an email account. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to use. Tap , then tap To and start typing the recipient's name or email address, or and select one or more recipients from your Contacts list. tap Enter the email subject and message text, then tap . To receive email messages From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. To download new messages, tap . If you have set up a corporate email account, you can set the check frequency to Automatic (Push). To read your email messages From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. In the email inbox, scroll up or down and tap the email you want to read. To use the email preview pane From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap and select the account you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. Hold your device horizontally. The email preview pane appears. Scroll up or down in the email inbox and tap the email you want to read. The email opens in the preview pane. To view more information about the email, tap the downward arrow next to the sender's name. In the body text field, pinch two fingers together, or spread them apart, to zoom out or in. To view the email in fullscreen format, tap the split bar (located between the email list and email body) accordingly. In fullscreen format, use the leftward and rightward arrows to read your previous or next message. To return to the inbox view, tap the split bar accordingly. Before using the preview pane, activate it in the preview pane settings. To hide the preview pane, hold your device vertically, or change the preview pane settings. 54 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To change email preview pane settings From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Tap General > Preview pane, then select an option. To view an email message attachment From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Find and tap the email message containing the attachment that you want to view. Emails with attachments are indicated by . After the email message opens, tap , then tap View. To save a sender's email address to your contacts From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Find and tap a message in your email inbox. Tap the name of the sender, then tap OK. Select an existing contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact information, if desired, then tap Done. To reply to an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to reply to, then tap Tap Reply or Reply all. Enter your reply, then tap . To forward an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to forward, then tap . Tap Forward. to select a Tap To and enter the recipient's email address manually, or tap recipient from your contacts. Enter your message text, then tap . To delete an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to delete, then tap . Tap Yes. To sort your emails From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. Press , then tap Sort. Select a sorting option. To search for emails From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to search. Tap . Enter your search text, then tap Go on your keyboard. The search result appears in a list sorted by date. Tap the email that you want to open. To change search options, tap and select a different option. 55 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view all folders for one email account From your Home screen, tap . Then find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen and select the account you want to check, then tap again and select Show all folders to view all the folders in this account. To change the inbox check frequency From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account for which you want to change the inbox check frequency. Tap Inbox check frequency and select an option. To set an Out of Office auto-reply in an Exchange Active Sync account From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the EAS (Exchange Active Sync) account for which you want to set an Out of Office auto-reply. Tap Out of office. Tap beside Out of office so that changes to . If needed, mark the Set time range checkbox and set the time range for the auto reply. Enter your Out of Office message in the body text field. Tap OK to confirm. 56 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Socialife™ Using the Socialife™ application Use the Socialife™ application from Sony to get your favourite news, videos and social networking feeds in one place. The Socialife™ home screen gives a clear overview of friends’ Facebook and Twitter activity, plus news feeds that you have subscribed to. It colour-codes and sizes articles for easy reading, adding photos and cropping images of your friends’ faces to illustrate each story. The Socialife™ application is not available in all markets. To open the Socialife™ application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap . 57 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. "WALKMAN" application About the "WALKMAN" application Get the most out of your "WALKMAN" application. Listen to and organise music and audio books that you have transferred to your device from a computer, or purchased and downloaded from online stores. To make content easily available to the "WALKMAN" application, you can use the Media Go™ application. Media Go™ helps transfer music content between a computer and your device. For more information, see Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. "WALKMAN" application overview Browse your music Search all tracks saved on your device Tap the infinite button to find related information online and plug-ins on Google Play™ Album art (if available) Go to the next track in the current play queue, or fast forward Total time length of the track Elapsed time of current track Progress indicator – drag the indicator or tap along the line to fast forward or rewind Play/Pause button 10 Go to the previous track in the current play queue, or rewind Transferring media files to your device Before using the "WALKMAN" application, it's a good idea to transfer all your favourite media content from a computer to your device and then play or view this content on your device. Media content can include music, photos and videos. The easiest way to transfer files is with a USB cable. After you connect your device and the computer using the USB cable, you can use the file manager application on the computer or the Media Go™ application to transfer the files. 58 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using the "WALKMAN" application To play audio content From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . In My music, select a music category and browse to the track that you want to open. Tap a track to play it. You might not be able to play copyright-protected items. Please verify that you have necessary rights in material that you intend to share. • • To change tracks When a track is playing, tap or . When a track is playing, swipe the album art left or right. • To pause a track Tap . • To fast forward and rewind music Touch and hold or . You can also drag the progress indicator marker right or left. • To adjust the audio volume Press the volume key. To improve the sound quality using the equaliser When the "WALKMAN" application is open, tap . Tap Settings > Sound enhancements. To adjust the sound manually, drag the frequency band buttons up or down. To adjust the sound automatically, tap and select a style. To turn on the surround sound feature When the "WALKMAN" application is open, tap . Tap Settings > Sound enhancements > Settings > Surround sound (VPT). Select a setting, then tap OK to confirm. To view the current play queue While a track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Play queue. • To minimise the "WALKMAN" application When the "WALKMAN" application is playing, tap to go to the previous to go to the Home screen. The "WALKMAN" application screen, or tap stays playing in the background. To open the "WALKMAN" application when it is playing in the background While a track is playing in the background, drag the status bar downwards to open the Notification panel. Tap the track title to open the "WALKMAN" application. Alternatively, you can press and then select the "WALKMAN" application. To delete a track In My music, browse to the track that you want to delete. Touch and hold the track title, then tap Delete. You can also delete albums this way. 59 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To send a track In My music, when browsing your tracks , touch and hold a track title. Tap Send. Select an application from the list, and follow the on-screen instructions. You can also send albums and playlists in the same way. To "Like" a track on Facebook™ While the track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap the album art. Tap to show that you "Like" the track on Facebook™. If desired, add a comment in the comments field. Tap Share to send the track to Facebook™. If the track is received successfully, you will get a confirmation message from Facebook™. Visualiser The Visualiser adds visual effects to your music tracks as you play them. The effects for each track are based on the characteristics of the music. They change, for example, in response to changes in the music’s loudness, rhythm and frequency level. You can also change the background theme. To turn on the Visualiser In the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Visualiser. Tap to switch to full screen view. To change the background theme In the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Visualiser. Tap > Theme and select a theme. Getting more information about a track or artist In the "WALKMAN" application, you can get more information about the artist that you are listening to by tapping the infinite button The infinite button • • • • • • also gives you access to related content such as: Music videos on YouTube™ Artist info on Wikipedia Lyrics on Google Karaoke videos on YouTube™ Extension searches on the web Content from the PlayNow™ service The accuracy of search results may vary. • To get more information about an artist or track When a track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap Using My music to organise your tracks Tap the My music tab in the "WALKMAN" application to get an overview of all the tracks that are available from your device. In My music, you can manage your albums and playlists, create shortcuts, and arrange your music by mood and tempo. 60 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Overview of My music Go back to the current track Picture of the currently playing artist (if available) Browse your music by artist Categorise your music using SensMe™ channels Manage and edit your music using Music Unlimited™ Browse your favourite playlists Collect links to music and related content that you and friends have shared using online services Browse all playlists Browse audio by track 10 Browse by album To add a shortcut to a track In My music, tap , , or , then browse to the track for which you want to create a shortcut. Touch and hold the track title. Tap Add as shortcut. The shortcut now appears in the My music main view. • To rearrange shortcuts In My music, touch and hold a shortcut until it magnifies and your device vibrates, then drag the item to a new location. • To delete a shortcut In My music, touch and hold a shortcut until it magnifies and your device vibrates, then drag the item to . You can only delete shortcuts that you create yourself. To update your music with the latest information In My music, tap . Tap Download music info > Start. Your device searches online and downloads the latest available album art and track information for your music. The SensMe™ channels application is activated when you download music information. 61 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Categorising your music using SensMe™ channels The SensMe™ channels application helps you arrange your music by mood and tempo. SensMe™ groups all your tracks into several categories, or channels, so you can select music that matches your mood or suits the time of day. • To enable the SensMe™ channels application In My music, tap , then tap Download music info. This application requires a mobile or Wi-Fi® network connection. Using the Friends' music function to share music The Friends’ music function collects links to music and music-related content that you and your friends have shared using Facebook™. To manage music from your friends In My music, tap Friends' music > Recent. Tap an item to open it, then work on it as desired. Tap to show that you "Like" the track on Facebook™. If desired, add a comment in the comments field. To view your shared music In My music, tap Friends' music > My shares. Scroll to an item you want to open, then tap it. All comments about the item, if any, are displayed. Playing music in random order You can play tracks in playlists in random order. A playlist can be, for example, a playlist you have created yourself or an album. To play tracks in random order In My music, tap and navigate to an album, or tap and browse to a playlist. to turn on Shuffle mode. Tap the album art, then tap • To turn off shuffle mode When tracks are playing in random order, tap the album art > Managing playlists In My music, you can create your own playlists from the music that is saved on your device. In addition, you can install the Media Go™ application on a computer and use it to copy playlists from the computer to your device. To create your own playlists In the WALKMAN player, tap the MY MUSIC tab. Tap Playlists. In the menu that opens, tap Create new playlist. Enter a name for the playlist and tap OK. Select your music and tap the Save icon at the top right of the screen. To add tracks to a playlist In My music, when browsing your tracks, touch and hold the name of the artist or the title of the album or track that you want to add. Tap Add to playlist. Tap the name of the playlist to which you want to add the artist, album or track. The artist, album or track is added to the playlist. 62 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To play your own playlists In My music, tap . Under Playlists, tap a playlist. Tap a track to play it. To remove a track from a playlist In a playlist, touch and hold the title of the track you want to delete. Tap Delete from playlist from the list that appears. To delete a playlist In My music, then select Playlists. Touch and hold the playlist you want to delete. Tap Delete. Tap Delete again to confirm. You cannot delete default playlists. "WALKMAN" application widget The "WALKMAN" application widget is a miniature application that gives you direct access to the "WALKMAN" application from your Home screen. You need to add this widget to your Home screen before you can use it. To add the "WALKMAN" application widget to your Home screen Tap an empty area on your Home screen, then tap Widgets. Find and tap WALKMAN. Protecting your hearing Listening to the "WALKMAN" application or other media players at excessive volume or for a prolonged period of time can damage your hearing, even when the volume is at a moderate level. To alert you to such risks, a volume level warning appears when the volume is too high, and after the "WALKMAN" application is used for over 20 hours. • To turn off the volume level warning appears, tap OK to dismiss the warning. When Every time you restart your device, the media volume is automatically set to a moderate level. 63 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Music services TrackID™ technology Identifying music using TrackID™ technology Use the TrackID™ music recognition service to identify a music track you hear playing in your surroundings. Just record a short sample of the song and you’ll get artist, title and album info within seconds. You can purchase tracks identified by TrackID™ and you can view TrackID™ charts to see what TrackID™ users around the globe are searching for. For best results, use TrackID™ technology in a quiet area. The TrackID™ application and the TrackID™ service are not supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. To open the TrackID™ application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap TrackID™. You can also use the TrackID™ widget to open the TrackID™ application. To search for track information using TrackID™ Open the TrackID™ application, then hold your device towards the music source. Tap . If the track is recognised by the TrackID™ service, the results appear on the screen. To return to the TrackID™ start screen, press To view TrackID™ charts Open the TrackID™ application, then tap Charts. The first time you view a chart, it is set to your own region. To see charts of the most popular searches in other regions, tap > Regions. Select a country or region. Using TrackID™ technology results Track information appears when the TrackID™ application recognises a track. You can select to purchase the track or share it using email, SMS or a social networking service. You can also get more information about the track's artist. To buy a track recognised by the TrackID™ application After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Download. Follow the instructions on your device to complete your purchase. You can also select a track to buy by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. The track purchase feature may not be supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. To share a track After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Share, then select a sharing method. Follow the instructions on your device to complete the procedure. You can also select a track to share by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. 64 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To view the artist information for a track After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Artist info. You can also view the artist information for a track by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. To delete a track from the track history Open the TrackID™ application, then tap History. Tap a track title, then tap Delete. Tap Yes to confirm. Music Unlimited™ Using Music Unlimited™ Music Unlimited™ is a subscription-based service that offers access to millions of songs over a mobile network or Wi-Fi® connection. You can manage and edit your personal music library in the cloud from a variety of devices, or sync your playlists and music using a PC that runs the Windows® operating system. Go to www.sonyentertainmentnetwork.com for more information. Music Unlimited™ might not be available in all countries or regions. To open Music Unlimited™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . About the PlayNow™ service You can use the PlayNow™ service to download applications, music, games, ringtones and wallpapers. The PlayNow™ service offers both free and non-free downloads. Note that payment options for non-free applications may vary per country. The PlayNow™ service is not available in all countries. Before you download content Before you download, make sure that you have an Internet connection. Also, you may need to have a memory card inserted in your device to download content. When you download content to your device, you might be charged for the amount of data transferred. Contact your operator for information about data transfer rates in your country. To start PlayNow™ From the Home screen, tap Find and tap . Downloading from the PlayNow™ service Download a range of content from the PlayNow™ service direct to your device. Choose from a variety of applications, games, music, ringtones and other content. Note that payment options for non-free applications may vary per country. 65 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To download a PlayNow item to your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap PlayNow™. Find an item you want to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details. Click “Buy now!” to start the purchase process. After your purchase has been validated, you can start to download your content. 66 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. FM radio About the FM radio The FM radio in your device works like any FM radio. For example, you can browse and listen to FM radio stations and save them as favourites. You must connect a wired headset or headphones to your device before you can use the radio. This is because the headset or headphones act as an antenna. After one of these devices is connected, you can then switch the radio sound to the speaker, if desired. When you open the FM radio, available channels appear automatically. If a channel has RDS information, it appears a few seconds after you start listening to the channel. To start the FM radio Connect a headset or a set of headphones to your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap FM radio . The available channels appear as you scroll through the frequency band. When you start the FM radio, available channels appear automatically. If a channel has RDS information, it appears a few seconds after you start listening to the channel. • To move between radio channels Flick your finger up or down along the frequency band. To select the radio region When the radio is open, press . Tap Set radio region. Select an option. To adjust the visualizer When the radio is open, tap . Tap Visualiser. Select an option. FM radio overview Radio on/off button View menu options Move up the frequency band to search for a channel A saved favourite channel Move down the frequency band to search for a channel Tuning dial 67 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 7 Save or remove a channel as a favourite Tuned frequency Using your favourite radio channels You can save the radio channels you most frequently listen to as favourites. By using favourites you can quickly return to a radio channel. To save a channel as a favourite When the radio is open, navigate to the channel that you want to save as a favourite. Tap . Enter a name and select a colour for the channel, then press Save. To remove a channel as a favourite When the radio is open, navigate to the channel that you want to remove. Tap , then tap Delete. Making a new search for radio channels If you have moved to a new location or the reception has improved in your current location, you can start a new scan for radio channels. Any favourites you have saved are not affected by a new scan. To start a new search for radio channels When the radio is open, press . Tap Search for channels. The radio scans the whole frequency band, and all available channels are displayed. Sound settings Switching the radio sound between devices You can listen to the radio through a wired headset or through wired headphones. Once either device is connected, you can switch the sound to the speaker, if desired. To switch the radio sound to the speaker When the radio is open, press . Tap Play in speaker. To switch the sound back to the wired headset or headphones, press and tap Play in headphones. Switching between mono and stereo sound mode You can listen to your FM radio in either mono or stereo mode. In some situations, switching to mono mode can reduce noise and improve sound quality. To switch between mono and stereo sound mode When the radio is open, press . Tap Enable stereo sound. To listen to the radio in mono sound mode again, press and tap Force mono sound. Identifying radio tracks using TrackID™ Use TrackID™ technology to identify music tracks as they play on your device's FM radio. 68 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To identify a song on the FM radio using TrackID™ While the song is playing on your device's FM radio, tap TrackID™. A progress indicator appears while the TrackID™ application samples the song. If successful, you are presented with a track result or a list of possible tracks. to return to the FM Radio. Press The TrackID™ application and the TrackID™ service are not supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 69 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Camera About the camera The camera in your device is equipped with the highly sensitive Exmor R sensor, which helps you capture sharp photos and videos even in low lighting conditions. From the camera, you can, for example, send your photos and videos to friends as messages, or upload them to a web service. Your device also has a front camera, which is useful for self-portraits. Camera controls overview Zoom in or out Main camera screen Camera key – Activate the camera/Take photos/Record videos View photos and videos Take photos or record video clips Go back a step or exit the camera Switch between front and main camera Camera setting icons Front camera • To open the camera When the screen is active, press and hold down the camera key. • To close the camera Press from the main camera screen. Using the still camera There are three ways to take photos with the still camera. You can press the camera key, tap the on-screen camera button, or touch a spot on the screen. To take a photo using the camera key Activate the camera. Press the camera key fully down. 70 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To take a photo by tapping the on-screen camera button Activate the camera. Point the camera towards the subject. Tap the on-screen camera button . The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. To take a self-portrait using the front camera Activate the camera. Tap the icon on the top left of the screen, then find and select Front camera. To take the photo, press the camera key. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. • To use the zoom function When the camera is open, press the volume key up or down to zoom in or out. To use the still camera flash When the camera is open, tap . Tap Flash, and select your desired flash setting. Take the photo. To view your photos and videos Open the camera, then tap a thumbnail at the top right of the screen to open a photo or video. Flick left or right to view your photos and videos. Videos are identified by . To delete a photo Open the photo that you want to delete. Tap an empty area of the screen to make Tap . Tap OK to confirm. appear. Face detection You can use face detection to bring an off-centre face into focus. The camera automatically detects up to five faces, indicated by white frames. A yellow frame shows which face has been selected for focus. Focus is set to the face closest to the camera. You can also tap one of the frames to select which face should be in focus. To turn on face detection Activate the camera. Tap the icon on the top left of the screen, then select Normal. To display all settings, tap . Tap Focus mode > Face detection. To take a photo using face detection When the camera is open and Face detection turned on, point the camera at your subject. Up to five faces can be detected, and each detected face is framed. Press the camera key halfway down. A yellow frame shows which face is in focus. To take the photo, press the camera key fully down. Using Smile Shutter™ to capture smiling faces Use Smile Shutter™ technology to photograph a face just as it smiles. The camera detects up to five faces and selects one face for smile detection and auto focus. When the selected face smiles, the camera automatically takes a photo. 71 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn on Smile Shutter™ Activate the camera. To display all settings, tap . Tap Smile Shutter and select a smile level. To take a photo using Smile Shutter™ When the camera is open and Smile Shutter is turned on, point the camera at your subject. The camera selects which face to focus on. The face selected appears inside a green frame and the photo is taken automatically. If no smile is detected, press the camera key to take the photo manually. Adding the geographical position to your photos Turn on geotagging to add the approximate geographical location (a geotag) to photos when you take them. The geographical location is determined either by wireless networks (mobile or Wi-Fi® networks) or GPS technology. When appears on the camera screen, geotagging is turned on but the geographical position has not been found. When appears, geotagging is turned on and the geographical location is available, so your photo can get geotagged. When neither of these two symbols appears, geotagging is turned off. To turn on geotagging Activate the camera. Tap , then tap Geotagging > On. Tap OK to agree to enable GPS and/or wireless networks. Check the options that you want to select under Location services. to return to the camera screen. After you confirm your settings, press If appears on the camera screen, your location is available and your photo can get geotagged. If not, check your GPS and/or wireless network connection. Using still camera settings To adjust the still camera settings Activate the camera. To display all settings, tap . Select the setting that you want to adjust, then edit as desired. To customise the still camera settings panel When the camera is open, tap to display all settings. Touch and hold the setting you want to move and drag it to the desired position. If you drag the setting outside of the settings panel, the change is cancelled. Still camera settings overview Superior auto Optimise your settings to suit any scene. Burst Use the Burst speed shooting mode to capture several photos in quick succession by keeping your finger pressed on the shutter button. You can choose between three burst speeds, which come with different resolution levels, that is, different picture sizes. Normal Front camera Select the front camera if you want to take self-portrait photos. 72 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Picture effect Apply effects to photos. Scene selection Use a pre-programmed scene type to quickly set the camera for common situations. Sweep Panorama Use this setting to take wide-angle, panoramic photos. Just press the camera key and move the camera steadily from one side to the other. Resolution Choose between several picture sizes and aspect ratios before taking a photo. A photo with a higher resolution requires more memory. 13 MP 4:3 13 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 13MP is available in the following conditions: select Normal capturing mode and HDR is off; select Scene mode except in Backlight Correction HDR mode. 12 MP 4:3 12 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 12MP is maximum resoluted in Superior Auto mode. 9 MP 16:9 9 megapixel picture size with 16:9 aspect ratio. A high resolution widescreen format. Has a higher resolution than full HD. Suitable for photos you want to view on widescreen displays. 5MP 4:3 5 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 2MP 16:9 2 megapixel picture size with 16:9 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on widescreen displays. VGA VGA format with 4:3 aspect ratio. 640x480 pixels. 12 MP is the maximum resolution available when photos are taken using Superior auto mode; when HDR is turned on in Normal mode; or when Scenes (Backlight correction HDR mode) mode is selected. The 13 MP resolution is only available when Normal capturing mode is selected and HDR is turned off, and when Scenes mode is selected (except in Backlight correction HDR mode). Flash Use the flash to take photos when lighting conditions are poor or when there is a backlight. Auto The camera automatically determines if the lighting conditions require the use of a flash. Fill flash Use this setting when the background is brighter than the subject. This removes unwanted dark shadows. Off The flash is turned off. Sometimes photo quality can be better without the flash, even if lighting conditions are poor. Taking a good photo without using the flash requires a steady hand. Use the self-timer to avoid blurred photos. Red-eye reduction Reduces the red colour of eyes when taking a photo. Self-timer With the self-timer you can take a photo without holding the device. Use this function to take self-portraits, or group photos where everyone can be in the photo. You can also use the self-timer to avoid shaking the camera when taking photos. 73 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. On (10 s.) Set a 10-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the photo is taken. On (2 s.) Set a 2-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the photo is taken. Off The photo is taken as soon as you tap the camera screen. Smile Shutter™ Use the smile shutter function to determine what kind of smile the camera reacts to before taking a photo. Quick launch Use Quick launch settings to launch the camera from the lock screen. If the device is in sleep mode of camera, press the camera key. Launch and capture By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first photo is captured immediately after the camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (still camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the still camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch and record video By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first video is shot immediately after the camera video camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (video camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the video camera is launched from sleep mode. Off Focus mode The focus function controls which part of a photo should be sharp. When continuous autofocus is on, the camera keeps adjusting focus so that the area within the yellow focus frame stays sharp. Single auto focus The camera automatically focuses on the selected subject. Continuous autofocus is on. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Multi auto focus The focus is automatically set on several areas of the image. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Continuous autofocus is off. Face detection The camera automatically detects up to five human faces, indicated by frames on the screen. The camera automatically focuses on the nearest face. You can also select which face to focus on by tapping it on the screen. When you tap the camera screen, a blue frame shows which face is selected and in focus. Face detection cannot be used for all scene types. Continuous autofocus is on. Touch focus Touch a specific area on the camera screen to set the area of focus. Continuous autofocus is off. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Object tracking When you select an object by touching it in the viewfinder, the camera tracks it for you. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Exposure value 74 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Determine the amount of light in the photo you want to take. A higher value indicates an increased amount of light. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. HDR Use the HDR (High Dynamic Range) setting to take a photo against strong back light or in conditions where the contrast is sharp. HDR compensates for the loss of detail and produces a picture that is representative of both dark and bright areas. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. White balance The white balance setting adjusts the colour balance according to the lighting conditions. Auto Adjusts the colour balance automatically to suit the lighting conditions. Incandescent Adjusts the colour balance for warm lighting conditions, such as under light bulbs. Fluorescent Adjusts the colour balance for fluorescent lighting. Daylight Adjusts the colour balance for sunny outdoor conditions. Cloudy Adjusts the colour balance for a cloudy sky. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. ISO You can reduce image blurring caused by dark conditions or moving subjects by increasing the ISO sensitivity. Auto Sets the ISO sensitivity automatically. 100 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 100. 200 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 200. 400 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 400. 800 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 800. 1600 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 1600. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Metering This function automatically determines a well-balanced exposure by measuring the amount of light striking the image you want to capture. Centre Adjusts the exposure to the centre of the image. Average Calculates the exposure based on the amount of light striking the whole image. 75 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Spot Adjusts the exposure in a very small part of the image that you want to capture. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Image stabiliser When taking a photo, it can be difficult to hold the device steady. The stabiliser helps you by compensating for small movements of the hand. Geotagging Tag photos with details of where you took them. On When geotagging is turned on, the approximate geographical location is added to photos when you take them. To use geotagging, you must enable location features from the Settings menu. For geotags to be added to a photo, the location must be determined before you take the photo. Your location is determined when appears on the camera screen. When your device is searching for your position, appears. Off When geotagging is turned off, you cannot view the location where you took a photo. Auto upload Automatically upload updates to photos to a pre-selected social networking service (SNS). Touch capture Identify a particular focus area by touching the camera screen with your finger. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. This setting is only available when focus mode is set to touch focus. On Off Shutter sound Choose to turn on or turn off the shutter sound when you record a video. Data storage You can choose to save your data either to a removable SD card or to your device's internal storage. Internal storage Photos or videos are saved on the device memory. SD card Photos or videos are saved on the SD card. Using the video camera To record a video using the camera key Activate the camera. To start recording a video, press the camera key. To stop recording, press the camera key again. Shoot your videos in landscape orientation to get the best results. 76 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To record a video by tapping the screen Activate the camera. Point the camera towards the subject. Tap to start recording. Tap to stop recording. Shoot your videos in landscape orientation to get the best results. To play recorded videos Activate the camera. Tap the thumbnails at the top right of the screen. Flick left or right to browse all photo and video files. Videos are identified by Tap to play a video. To stop playing the video, tap or . To delete a recorded video Browse to the video that you want to delete. Tap an empty area of the screen to make appear. Tap . Tap OK to confirm. Using video camera settings To adjust the video camera settings Activate the camera. Tap one of the settings icons on the screen. To display all settings, tap . Select the setting that want to adjust, then make your changes. To customise the video camera settings panel When the video camera is open, tap to display all settings. Touch and hold the setting that you want to move, then drag it to the desired position. If you drag the setting outside of the settings panel, the change is cancelled. Video camera settings overview Scenes The Scenes feature helps you to quickly set up the camera for common situations using pre-programmed scenes. The camera determines a number of settings for you to fit the selected scene, ensuring the best possible video. Off The Scenes feature is off and you can shoot videos manually. Soft snap Use for shooting videos against soft backgrounds. Landscape Use for videos of landscapes. The camera focuses on distant objects. Night When turned on, light sensitivity is increased. Use in poorly lit environments. Videos of fast-moving objects may get blurred. Hold your hand steady, or use a support. Turn off night mode when lighting conditions are good, to improve the video quality. Beach Use in bright environments to avoid overexposed videos. Snow Use in bright environments to avoid overexposed videos. Sports 77 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Use for videos of fast-moving objects. Short exposure time minimises motion blurring. Party Use for indoor videos in poorly lit environments. This scene picks up indoor background lighting or candlelight. Videos of fast-moving objects may get blurred. Hold your hand steady, or use a support. Video resolution Adjust the video resolution for different formats. 1920×1080(16:9) Full HD (Full High Definition) format with 16:9 aspect ratio. 1920×1080 pixels. 1280×720(16:9) HD (High Definition) format with 16:9 aspect ratio. 1280×720 pixels. 640×480(4:3) VGA format with 4:3 aspect ratio. 640x480 pixels. 176×144(11:9) Record videos suitable for sending in multimedia messages. The recording time of this video format is limited to fit in a multimedia message. Photo light Use the light to record videos when lighting conditions are poor or when there is a backlight. On Off Sometimes the video quality can be better without a light, even if lighting conditions are poor. Self-timer With the self-timer you can record a video without holding the device. Use it to record group videos where everyone can be in the video. You can also use the self-timer to avoid shaking the camera when recording videos. On (10 s.) Set a 10-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the video begins to record. On (2 s.) Set a 2-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the video begins to record. Off The video begins to record as soon as you tap the camera screen. Quick launch Use Quick launch settings to launch the camera from the lock screen. If the device is in sleep mode of camera, press the camera key. Launch and capture By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first photo is captured immediately after the camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (still camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the still camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch and record video By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first video is shot immediately after the camera video camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (video camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the video camera is launched from sleep mode. Off 78 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Focus mode The focus setting controls which part of a video should be sharp. When continuous autofocus is on, the camera keeps adjusting focus so that the area within the white focus frame stays sharp. Single auto focus The camera automatically focuses on the selected subject. Continuous autofocus is on. Face detection The camera automatically detects up to five human faces, indicated by frames on the screen. The camera automatically focuses on the nearest face. You can also select which face to focus on by tapping it on the screen. When you tap the camera screen, a yellow frame shows which face is selected and in focus. Face detection cannot be used for all scene types. Continuous autofocus is on. Object tracking When you select an object by touching it in the viewfinder, the camera tracks it for you. Exposure value This setting allows you to determine the amount of light in the image you capture. A higher value indicates an increased amount of light. White balance The white balance setting adjusts the colour balance according to the lighting conditions. Auto Adjust the colour balance automatically to the lighting conditions. Incandescent Adjusts the colour balance for warm lighting conditions, such as under light bulbs. Fluorescent Adjust the colour balance for fluorescent lighting. Daylight Adjust the colour balance for sunny outdoor conditions. Cloudy Adjust the colour balance for a cloudy sky. Metering This function automatically determines a well-balanced exposure by measuring the amount of light striking the image that you want to capture. Centre Adjust the exposure to the centre of the image. Average Calculate the exposure based on the amount of light striking the whole image. Spot Adjust the exposure in a very small part of the image that you want to capture. Geotagging Tag photos with details of where you took them. On When geotagging is turned on, the approximate geographical location is added to photos when you take them. To use geotagging, you must enable location features from the Settings menu. For geotags to be added to a photo, the location must be determined before you take the photo. Your location is determined when appears on the camera screen. When your device is searching for your position, appears. Off When geotagging is turned off, you cannot view the location where you took a photo. 79 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Microphone Select whether to pick up the surrounding sound when recording videos. Touch capture Identify a particular focus area by touching the camera screen with your finger. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. This setting is only available when focus mode is set to touch focus. On Off Shutter sound Choose to turn on or turn off the shutter sound when you record a video. Data storage You can choose to save your data either to a removable SD card or to your device's internal storage. Internal storage Photos or videos are saved on the device memory. SD card Photos or videos are saved on the SD card. 80 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Album About Album Use Album to view photos and play videos that you’ve taken with your camera, or to view similar content that you've saved to your device. You can add geotags to your photos and videos, and then view them on a world map. In Album, you can also view photos and videos that you've uploaded to an online service, for example, to a Picasa™ web album or to Facebook™. From Album, you can share your favourite photos and videos with friends via Bluetooth™ wireless technology, email, messaging and various online services. You can also perform basic editing tasks on photos and set them as wallpaper or contact pictures. For more information, see Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. Album tab overview • • The following tabs are available in Album: Pictures – view all photos and videos saved on your device. My albums – view your online albums, and your geotagged photos and video clips on a world map . To open Album From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Album. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. Mobile BRAVIA® Engine Sony's Mobile BRAVIA® Engine technology improves the viewing quality of photos and videos after you take them, giving you clearer, sharper and more natural images. Mobile BRAVIA Engine is turned on by default, but you can turn it off if you want to reduce battery consumption. To turn on Mobile BRAVIA® Engine From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display. Mark the Mobile BRAVIA Engine 2 checkbox if it is not marked. Viewing photos and videos in the Pictures tab In the Pictures tab in Album, you can view your photos and videos in thumbnails in a grid view. 81 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Overview of Pictures tab Grid view of photos and videos. View menu options. Scroll up or down to view content. Tap a photo or video to view it. The date and number of items in the group below. To view photos and videos in grid view From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album. All photos and videos are displayed in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. • To change the size of the thumbnails in Album When viewing thumbnails of photos and videos in Album, spread two fingers apart to zoom in, or pinch two fingers together to zoom out. To work with batches of photos or videos in Album When viewing thumbnails of photos and videos in Album, tap , then tap Select items. Tap the items you want to work with. Selected items are indicated by a blue frame. Use the tools in the toolbar at the top of the screen to work with your selected items. To activate selection mode, you can also touch and hold an item until its frame turns blue. Then you can tap other items to select them. Viewing photos and videos in the My albums tab The following tiles are available in My albums: • • Camera albums – view all photos and videos taken with your device’s camera. Internal memory – view all photos and videos saved to your device's internal storage. 82 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • My SD card – view all photos and videos saved to a removable memory card in your device. Overview of My albums tab View photos and videos using the PlayMemories online service. View photos and videos on Facebook™. View photos and videos in Picasa™. View your photos on a map. View all photos and videos saved to your device's internal storage. View all photos and videos saved to the removable memory card. View your photos in globe mode. View all photos and videos taken with your device’s camera. To view content in list view in the Camera albums tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Camera albums. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. To view content in list view in the Internal memory tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Internal memory. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. 83 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view content in list view in the My SD card tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > My SD card. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. Working with photos in Album You can edit photos in Album. For example, you can crop photos, associate them with contacts, or use them as wallpaper. • • To zoom a photo When you are viewing a photo, double-tap the screen to zoom in. Double-tap again to zoom out. When you are viewing a photo, spread two fingers apart to zoom in, or pinch two fingers together to zoom out. To watch a slideshow of your photos When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Slideshow to start playing all the photos in an album. Tap a photo to end the slideshow. To watch a slideshow of your photos with music When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > SensMe™ slideshow. Select the music and theme that you want to use for the slideshow, then tap . The Album application analyses your photos and uses SensMe™ music data to play a slideshow. To pause playing, tap the screen to display the controls, then tap . For more information about SensMe™, see Categorising your music using SensMe™ channels on page 62. To rotate a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap Select Rotate left or Rotate right. The photo is saved in the new orientation. To crop a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Edit photo > Crop. To adjust the crop frame, touch and hold the edge of the crop frame. When the squares at the edges disappear, drag inward or outward to resize the frame. To resize all sides of the crop frame at the same time, touch and hold one of the four corners to make the squares at the edges disappear, then drag the corner accordingly. To move the crop frame to another area of the photo, touch and hold inside the frame, then drag it to the desired position. To save a copy of the photo as you cropped it, tap Save. The original uncropped version remains on your device. To use a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Use as. Select an option from the list that appears. Follow the relevant steps to use the photo. 84 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To edit a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Edit photo. To share a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap In the menu that opens, tap the application that you want to use to share the photo, then follow the steps to send it. To add a geotag to a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to open the map screen. Find and tap the desired location to put the photo on the map. To adjust the location of the photo, tap the location on the map to where you want to move the photo. When you are finished, tap OK to save the geotag and return to the photo viewer. When a photo is geotagged, to view the photo on a map. appears along with location information. You can tap this icon To delete a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap Tap OK. Working with videos in Album Use Album to watch videos that you’ve taken with the camera, downloaded, or copied to your device. You can also share your videos with friends, for example, by uploading them to online services. To play a video Open the Pictures tab or the My albums tab in Album. Using grid view or list view, locate the video that you want to open. Tap the video to play it. If the playback controls are not displayed, tap the screen to display them. To hide the controls, tap the screen again. To pause a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap . To fast forward and rewind a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Drag the progress bar marker left to rewind, or right to fast forward. • To adjust the volume of a video Press the volume key. To share a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Share. In the menu that opens, tap the application that you want to use to share the selected video, then follow the relevant steps to send it. You might not be able to copy, send or transfer copyright-protected items. Also, some items may not send if the file size is too large. 85 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete a video In Album, find the video you want to delete. Touch and hold the video to activate selection mode. The frame of the video thumbnail turns blue when it is selected. Tap , then tap OK. Viewing your photos on a map If you enable location detection when taking photos, you can use the information gathered at a later stage. For example, you can view your photos on a map and show friends and family where you were when you took the photo. Adding location information is also referred to as geotagging. When you enable location detection, you can select to use either GPS satellites or wireless networks, or both, to find your position. Overview of Maps tile Search a location on the map. View menu options. A group of photos and/or videos geotagged with the same location. Double tap to zoom in. Pinch to zoom out. Drag to view different parts of the map. Thumbnails of the selected group of photos and/or videos. Tap an item to view it in full screen. To enable location detection From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Location services. Mark the GPS satellites and/or Google's location service checkboxes. To view geotagged photos on a map in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Maps. Tap a photo to view it in full screen. If several photos were taken at the same location, only one of them appears on the map. The total number of photos appears in the top right corner, for example, . To view these photos, tap the cover photo and then tap one of the thumbnails at the bottom of the screen. When viewing a geotagged photo in the photo viewer, you can touch the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the photo on the map. 86 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view geotagged photos on a globe in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Globe. Tap a photo to view it in full screen. If several photos were taken at the same location, only one of them appears on the map. The total number of photos appears in the top right corner, for example, . To view these photos, tap the cover photo and then tap one of the thumbnails at the bottom of the screen. When viewing a geotagged photo from the camera application, you can touch the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the photo on the map. To add a geotag when viewing the map in Album When viewing the map in Album, tap , then tap Add geotag. Find and tap the photo to which you want to add the geotag. Tap the desired location on the map to set the geotag, then tap OK. To edit the geotag of a photo in Album When viewing a photo on the map in Album, touch and hold the photo until its frame turns blue. Drag the photo to the new location. You can also tap the desired location on the map instead of dragging. • To change the map view in Album When viewing the map in Album, tap , then select Classic view, Globe view or Satellite view. Viewing online albums In Album, view the photos and videos that you and your friends have uploaded to online services, such as Picasa™ and Facebook™. You can view comments from your friends and add your own comments as well. Overview of online services Active online service. Name of online album. Number of items in the online album. Refresh. View menu options. 87 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 • To view photos from online services in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums. Tap the desired online service. Tap Connect. All available online albums that you have uploaded to the service are displayed. Tap any album to view its content, then tap a photo in the album. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. To view and add comments to online album content When viewing a photo from an online album, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the comments. To view more comments, scroll down the screen. To add your own comments, enter your comments at the bottom of the screen, then tap Post. To "Like" a photo or video on Facebook™ While viewing a photo or video from one of your Facebook™ albums, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to show that you "Like" the item on Facebook™. 88 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Movies About Movies Use the Movies application to play movies and other video content that you’ve saved on your device. The Movies application also helps you get poster art, plot summaries, genre info and director details for each movie. You can also play your movies on other devices that are connected to the same network. Videos taken with your device's camera are displayed in the Album application, not in the Movies application. Overview of Movies All video categories available on your device. Browse all movies. Browse content on other connected DLNA Certified™ devices. Browse all TV shows. Manage video content from Video Unlimited™. View menu options. Video Unlimited™ may not be available in all countries or regions. Using Movies To play a video in Movies From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to play. Tap the video you want to select, then tap to play it. To display or hide the controls, tap the screen. To pause playing, tap . To rewind, drag the progress bar marker left. To fast forward, drag the progress bar marker right. 89 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To play a video in full screen When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap . To play the video in its original size, tap To share a video When a video saved under Movies or TV shows is playing, tap , then tap Share. Tap the application that you want to use to share the selected video, then follow the relevant steps to send it. To get movie information manually Make sure that your device has an active data connection. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Tap , then make sure that the Get video details checkbox is marked. Open the Movies or TV shows tab and browse to the thumbnail of a file that you want to get information about. Touch and hold the thumbnail for the video, then tap Search for info. In the search field, enter keywords for the video, then tap the confirm key on the keyboard. All matches are displayed in a list. Select a search result, then tap Done. The download of the information begins. You also get information about newly added videos automatically when the Movies application is opened and the Get video details checkbox is marked. Data transmission charges may apply. If the downloaded information is not correct, tap keywords. and search again using different To clear information about a video From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to edit. Touch and hold the video thumbnail, then tap Clear info. To play a video on an external device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies > . Tap Throw, then select a device from the list. Select the video that you want to play. To change the sound settings while a video is playing While a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap , then tap Sound settings. Mark the checkboxes for the sound settings that you want to activate. When you're finished, tap OK. To delete a video From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to delete. Touch and hold the video thumbnail, then tap Delete from the list that appears. Tap Delete again to confirm. 90 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Video Unlimited™ About Video Unlimited™ Use the Video Unlimited™ service to rent and purchase videos that you can view not only on your Android device, but also on a PC, PlayStation® Portable (PSP®) or PlayStation® 3. Select your pick from the latest Hollywood releases, action movies, comedies, classics, and a range of other categories. Video Unlimited™ might not be available in all countries or regions. To open Video Unlimited™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . Video Unlimited™ menu overview View your account information Search for a video View the download status for all your items View and change settings for your account, purchases, and downloads Add the current video to a wish list Delete all items in your wish list Delete the video you're currently viewing from the wish list Share information about the current video via a social network, email, Bluetooth or other method View legal information The Video Unlimited™ menu is dynamic, which means that all options are not always available. For example, the option to delete all items in your wish list is only available when you are viewing the list. • To open the Video Unlimited™ menu Open Video Unlimited, then tap . Creating a Video Unlimited™ account You need to create a Video Unlimited™ account if you want to buy or rent movies through the Video Unlimited™ service. Exploring the Video Unlimited™ selection Browse videos by category, or enter text to search for a particular item. You can also choose to preview videos you're interested in. Renting or buying a video When you rent a video, you have a fixed amount of time in which to view it. This time period varies from market to market. You can also choose to download a purchased video to most Sony™ devices that are connected to your Video Unlimited™ account. Video Unlimited™ notifications overview When you buy or rent videos, the following notifications may appear: 91 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Downloading of video is completed Downloading has failed. You need to check that, for example, your device is connected to a Wi-Fi® network, and that you have enough free space on your memory card. Downloading of video is ongoing Downloading is paused Confirmation of successful purchase Rental countdown period has started Watching a video from Video Unlimited™ You can watch your rented or purchased videos on most Sony™ device that are connected to your Video Unlimited™ account. Video menu overview When you watch a video from Video Unlimited™, you can open a menu to get the following options: Delete the current video View information about the current video Change the audio language Change the language of subtitles, or remove subtitles 92 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Web browser About the web browser The Google Chrome™ web browser for Android™ devices comes pre-installed in most markets. Go to http://support.google.com/chrome and click the "Chrome for Mobile" link to get more detailed information about how to use this web browser. Google Chrome™ is not available in all markets. To open the web browser From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . 93 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Connectivity Connecting to wireless networks You can access the Internet wirelessly from your device using Wi-Fi® technology. This way you can browse the web and share media files over the same Wi-Fi® network with other DLNA Certified™ devices, for example, TVs and computers. If your company or organisation has a virtual private network (VPN), you can connect to this network using your device. You can use a VPN to access intranets and other internal services at your company. Before using Wi-Fi® To browse the Internet using a Wi-Fi® connection, you need to search for and connect to an available Wi-Fi® network and then open the Internet browser. The signal strength of the Wi-Fi® network may differ depending on your device's location. Move closer to the Wi-Fi® access point to increase the signal strength. To turn on Wi-Fi® From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Drag the slider beside Wi-Fi® to the right to turn on the Wi-Fi® function. It may take a few seconds before Wi-Fi® is enabled. To connect to a Wi-Fi® network From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Make sure that the Wi-Fi® function is on. Tap Wi-Fi . Available Wi-Fi® networks are displayed. The available networks may be open and secured networks are or secured. Open networks are indicated by indicated by next to the Wi-Fi® network name. Tap a Wi-Fi® network to connect to it. If you are trying to connect to a secure is displayed in the status bar network, you are asked to enter a password. once you are connected. Your device remembers Wi-Fi® networks you connect to. The next time you come within reach of a previously connected Wi-Fi® network, your device automatically connects to it. In some locations, open Wi-Fi® networks require you to log in to a web page before you can get access to the network. Contact the relevant Wi-Fi® network administrator for more information. To connect to another Wi-Fi® network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Detected Wi-Fi® networks are displayed. Tap another Wi-Fi® network to connect to it. To scan for Wi-Fi® networks manually From your Home screen, tap to go to the Application screen. Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press , then tap Scan. Your device now scans for all available Wi-Fi® networks. To connect to a Wi-Fi® network, tap the network name from the list of available networks. 94 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To add a Wi-Fi® network manually Make sure that Wi-Fi® is turned on. From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi . Tap . Enter the Network SSID for the network. Tap the Security field to select a security type. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. The Wi-Fi® network name may be indicated as SSID, ESSID or Access Point. Contact your Wi-Fi® network administrator to get the Network SSID and password. Advanced Wi-Fi® settings Wi-Fi® network status When you are connected to a Wi-Fi® network or when there are Wi-Fi® networks available in your vicinity, it is possible to see the status of these Wi-Fi® networks. You can also enable your device to notify you whenever an open Wi-Fi® network is detected. To enable Wi-Fi® network notifications Turn on Wi-Fi®, if it is not already on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press . Tap Advanced. Mark the Network notification checkbox. To view detailed information about a connected Wi-Fi® network From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Tap the Wi-Fi® network that you are currently connected to. Detailed network information is displayed. Wi-Fi® sleep policy By adding a Wi-Fi® sleep policy, you can specify when to switch from Wi-Fi® to mobile data. If you are not connected to a Wi-Fi® network, your device uses a mobile data connection to access the Internet (if you have set up and enabled a mobile data connection on your device). To add a Wi-Fi® sleep policy From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press . Tap Advanced. Tap Keep Wi-Fi on during sleep. Select an option. Sharing your mobile data connection You can share your device's mobile data connection with a single computer using a USB cable. This process is called USB tethering. You can also share your device's data connection with up to eight other devices at once, by turning your device into a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot. When your device is sharing its data connection, the following icons may appear in the status bar or in the Notification panel: USB tethering is active 95 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Portable Wi-Fi® hotspot is active To share your data connection using a USB cable Deactivate all USB cable connections to your device. Using the USB cable that came with your device, connect your device to a computer. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Mark the USB tethering checkbox. To stop sharing your data connection, unmark the USB tethering checkbox or disconnect the USB cable. You cannot share your device's data connection and SD card over a USB cable at the same time. You may need to prepare your computer to establish a network connection via USB cable. Go to www.android.com/tether to get the most current information. To use your device as a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings > Set up Wi-Fi hotspot. Enter the Network SSID for the network. Tap the Security field to select a security type. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. Mark the Portable Wi-Fi hotspot checkbox. Your device starts broadcasting its Wi-Fi network name (SSID). Up to eight computers or other devices can now connect to this network. Unmark the Portable Wi-Fi hotspot checkbox when you want to stop sharing your data connection via Wi-Fi®. To rename or secure your portable hotspot From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings > Set up Wi-Fi hotspot. Enter the Network SSID for the network. To select a security type, tap the Security field. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. Virtual private networks (VPNs) Use your device to connect to virtual private networks (VPNs), which allow you to access resources inside a secured local network from outside the actual network. For example, VPN connections are commonly used by corporations and educational institutions for users who need to access intranets and other internal services when they are outside of the internal network, for example, when they are travelling. VPN connections can be set up in many ways, depending on the network. Some networks may require you to transfer and install a security certificate in your device. For detailed information on how to set up a connection to your virtual private network, please contact the network administrator of your company or organisation. To add a virtual private network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > VPN. Tap Add VPN profile. Select the type of VPN to add. Enter your VPN settings. Tap Save. 96 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To connect to a virtual private network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > VPN. In the list of available networks, tap the VPN that you want to connect to. Enter the required information. Tap Connect. To disconnect from a virtual private network Drag the status bar downwards. Tap the notification for the VPN connection to turn it off. Sharing content with DLNA Certified™ devices You can view or play media content saved to your device on other devices such as, for example, a TV, or a computer. Such devices must be DLNA Certified™ by the Digital Living Network Alliance and all devices must be connected to the same WiFi® network in order for content to be shared. You can also view or play content from other DLNA Certified™ devices on your device. After you set up the sharing of content between devices, you can, for example, listen to music files stored on your home computer from your device, or view photos taken with your device's camera on a large-screen TV. Playing files from DLNA Certified™ devices on your device When you play files from another DLNA Certified™ device on your device, this other device acts as a server. In other words, it shares content over a network. The server device must have its content sharing function enabled and give access permission to your device. It also must be connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. To play a shared track on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap WALKMAN. Tap My music to open the music library. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select the track that you want to play. The track starts playing automatically. To play a shared video on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies > Devices. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select the video that you want to play. To view a shared photo on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums. All your available online albums and connected devices are displayed. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select a photo to view it. Preparing to play content from your device on DLNA Certified™ devices Before you can view or play media files from your device on other DLNA Certified™ devices, you must set up file sharing on your device. The devices that you share content with are called client devices. For example, a TV, computer or tablet can act 97 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. as client devices. Your device works as a media server when it makes content available to client devices. When you set up file sharing on your device, you must also give access permission to client devices. After you do so, such devices appear as registered devices. Devices that are waiting for access permission are listed as pending devices. To set up file sharing with other DLNA Certified™ devices Connect your device to a Wi-Fi® network. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. To turn on the Share content function, drag the slider. appears in the status bar. Your device can now work as a media server. Connect your computer or other devices to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. A notification appears in the status bar of your device. Open the notification and set the relevant access permissions for other devices. The instructions described above may differ depending on the client devices used. Refer to your client device User guide for more information. If the device cannot connect, check that your Wi-Fi® network is working. You can also access the Media server menu under Settings > More… > Media server settings. If you close the Media server view, file sharing function function stays running in the background. To stop sharing files with other DLNA Certified™ devices From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Drag the slider to turn off the Share content function. To set access permissions for a pending device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Pending devices list. Select an access permission level. To change the name of a registered device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Registered devices list, then select Change name. Enter a new name for the device. To change the access level of a registered device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Registered devices list. Tap Change access level and select an option. To get help about sharing content with other DLNA Certified™ devices From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Tap . 98 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Playing files on a Digital Media Renderer device Using DLNA™ technology, you can push media content saved on your device to another device connected to the same Wi-Fi® network. The other device must be able to function as a Digital Media Renderer (DMR) device, which means that it can render, or play, content received from your device. A DMR device can be, for example, a TV with DLNA function, or a PC running Windows® 7 or higher. The settings for enabling the Digital Media Renderer may vary depending on the device used. Refer to the user guide for the respective device for more detailed information. To view photos or videos from your device on a DMR device Make sure that you have correctly set up the DMR device and that it is connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album. Browse to and open the file that you want to view. Tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap and select a DMR device to share your content with. The selected files start playing in chronological order on the device that you select. To disconnect from the DMR device, tap and select My phone. The file stops playing on the DMR device but continues playing on your device. You can also share a video from the Movies application on your device by tapping the video and then tapping . To play a music track from your device on a DMR device Make sure that you have correctly set up the DMR device and that it is connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap WALKMAN. Tap My music to open the music library. Select a music category and browse to the track that you want to share, then tap the track. Tap and select a DMR device to share your content with. The track plays automatically on the device that you select. To disconnect from the DMR device, tap and select My phone. The track stops playing on the DMR device but continues playing on your device. NFC Use Near Field Communications (NFC) to share data with other devices, such as a video, photo, web page address, music file or contact. You can also use NFC to scan tags that give you more information about a product or service as well as tags that activate certain functions on your device. NFC is a wireless technology with a maximum range of one centimetre, so the devices sharing data must be held close to each other. Before you can use NFC, you must first turn on the NFC function, and the device's screen must be active. NFC may not be available in all countries and/or regions. To turn on the NFC function From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Mark the NFC checkbox. 99 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. NFC detection area The location of the NFC detection area is not the same on all devices. When sharing data with another device using NFC, refer to the User guide of the other device for more information. To share a contact with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To view contacts, go to your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas of each device touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the contact appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the contact information is displayed on the screen of the receiving device and is also saved on the receiving device. To share a music file with another device using NFC Make sure that both your device and the receiving device have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To open the "WALKMAN" application, tap , then find and tap . Tap the My music tab to open the music library. Select a music category and browse to the track you want to share. Tap the track to play it. You can then tap to pause the track. The transfer works whether the track is playing or paused. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas of each device touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the track appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the music file plays immediately on the receiving device. At the same time, the file is saved on the receiving device. You might not be able to copy, send or transfer copyright-protected items. 100 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To share a photo or video with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To view photos and videos in your device, go to your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Album. Tap the photo or video that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the photo or video appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the photo or video is displayed on the screen of the receiving device. At the same time, the item is saved on the receiving device. You can also use NFC to share a video from the Movies application. To share a web address with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. From your Home screen, tap . To open the web browser, find and tap . Load the web page that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the web page appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the web page is displayed on the screen of the receiving device. Scanning NFC tags Your device can scan various kinds of NFC tags. For example, it can scan embedded tags on a poster, on a billboard advertisement, or beside a product in a retail store. You can receive additional information, such as a web address. To scan an NFC tag Make sure that your device has the NFC function turned on and that the screen is active. Place your device over the tag so that the NFC detection area touches it. Your device scans the tag and displays the content collected. Tap the content of the tag to open it. To open the tag, tap it. Paying for items with your device You can use the Operator wallet application on your device to pay for items in stores that support NFC payment methods. Just tap your device on specially enabled electronic payment pads to pay for your purchases. Payments are backed by a credit or debit card, or by prepaid cards or vouchers. Your payment information is stored in the payment application, so you don’t need to enter it every time. To use Operator wallet, your SIM card must have a secure element embedded. Contact your network operator for more details. Google Wallet™ Use the Google Wallet™ application to pay for goods at checkouts. If there is a supported NFC terminal at the checkout, you can just tap your device on the terminal to pay. Google Wallet™ stores details of your credit and debit cards as well as details of coupons and other special offers. Most major credit card types are supported. Security features include a PIN, encrypted storage and the ability to remotely disable a lost wallet. 101 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Operator wallet The Operator wallet application lets you access a variety of services provided by your network operator, such as the option to pay for items in underground trains and stores. Contact your network operator for more information about such services. To select a wallet for use on your device Make sure that the NFC function is on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Tap Wallet and select an option. Connecting to an NFC compatible device You can connect your device to other NFC compatible devices produced by Sony, such as a speaker or a headphone. When establishing this kind of connection, refer to the User guide of the compatible device for more information. You may need to have Wi-Fi® or Bluetooth™ activated on both devices for the connection to work. Bluetooth™ wireless technology Use the Bluetooth™ function to send files to other Bluetooth™ compatible devices, or to connect to handsfree accessories. Turn on the Bluetooth™ function in your device and create wireless connections to other Bluetooth™ compatible devices such as computers, handsfree accessories, and phones. Bluetooth™ connections work better within 10 metres (33 feet), with no solid objects in between. In some cases you have to manually pair your device with other Bluetooth™ devices. Interoperability and compatibility among Bluetooth™ devices can vary. To turn on the Bluetooth™ function and make your device visible From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap the on-off switch beside Bluetooth to turn on the Bluetooth™ function. Tap Bluetooth. Your device and a list of available Bluetooth™ devices appear. Tap your device name to make your device visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. To adjust your device's visibility time to other Bluetooth™ devices From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Visibility timeout. Select an option. Naming your device You can give your device a name. This name is shown to other devices after you have turned on the Bluetooth™ function and your device is set to visible. To give your device a name Make sure that the Bluetooth™ function is turned on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Rename phone. Enter a name for your device. Tap Rename. 102 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Pairing with another Bluetooth™ device When you pair your device with another device, you can, for example, connect your device to a Bluetooth™ headset or a Bluetooth™ car kit and use these other devices to make and receive calls. Once you have paired your device with a Bluetooth™ device, your device will remember this pairing. When pairing your device with a Bluetooth™ device, you may need to enter a passcode. Your device will automatically try the generic passcode 0000. If this does not work, refer to the user guide for your Bluetooth™ device to get the device passcode. You do not need to re-enter the passcode the next time you connect to a paired Bluetooth™ device. Some Bluetooth™ devices, for example, most Bluetooth™ headsets, require you to both pair and connect with the other device. You can pair your device with several Bluetooth™ devices, but you can only connect to one Bluetooth™ profile at the same time. To pair your device with another Bluetooth™ device Make sure that the device you want to pair your device with has the Bluetooth™ function activated and is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. All available Bluetooth™ devices appear in a list. Tap the Bluetooth™ device that you want to pair with your device. Enter a passcode, if required, or confirm the same passcode on both devices. Your device and the Bluetooth™ device are now paired. To connect your device to another Bluetooth™ device If you are connecting to a Bluetooth device that requires you to first pair your device before connecting, follow the relevant steps to pair your device with that device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Tap the Bluetooth™ device to which you want to connect your device. To unpair a Bluetooth™ device From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Under Paired devices, tap beside the name of the device that you want to unpair. Tap Unpair. Sending and receiving items using Bluetooth™ technology Share items with other Bluetooth™ compatible devices such as phones or computers. You can send and receive several kinds of items using the Bluetooth™ function, such as: • • • • Photos and videos Music and other audio files Contacts Web pages 103 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 10 To send items using Bluetooth™ Receiving device: Make sure the Bluetooth™ function is turned on and that the device is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. Sending device: Open the application which contains the item that you want to send, and scroll to the item. Depending on the application and the item you want to send, you may need to, for example, touch and hold the item, open the item or press . Other ways to send an item may exist. Select Share or Send. Select Bluetooth. Turn on Bluetooth™, if you are asked to do so. Tap the name of the receiving device. Receiving device: If asked, accept the connection. Sending device: If asked, confirm the transfer to the receiving device. Receiving device: Accept the incoming item. To receive items using Bluetooth™ Make sure that the Bluetooth™ function is on and is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. The sending device now starts sending data to your device. If prompted, enter the same passcode on both devices, or confirm the suggested passcode. When you are notified of an incoming file to your device, drag the status bar downwards and tap the notification to accept the file transfer. Tap Accept to start the file transfer. To view the progress of the transfer, drag the status bar downwards. To open a received item, drag the status bar downwards and tap the relevant notification. To view files you have received using Bluetooth™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Show received files. Connecting your device to a computer Connect your device to a computer and start transferring pictures, music and other file types. The easiest ways to connect are using a USB cable or Bluetooth wireless technology. When you connect your device to the computer using a USB cable, you are prompted to install the PC Companion application on your computer. PC Companion helps you access additional computer applications to transfer and organise media files, update your device, synchronise device content, and more. You might not be able to transfer some copyright-protected material between your device and a computer. Transferring and handling content using a USB cable Use a USB cable connection between a computer and your device for easy transfer and management of your files. Once the two devices are connected, you can drag and drop content between your device and the computer, or between your device's internal storage and SD card, using the computer's file explorer. If you're transferring music, video, pictures or other media files to your device, it's best to use the Media Go™ application on your computer. Media Go™ converts media files so that you can use them on your device. 104 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To transfer content between your device and computer using a USB cable Using a USB cable, connect your device to a computer. Internal storage & SD card connected appears in the status bar on the screen of your device. Computer: Open Microsoft® Windows® Explorer from the desktop and wait until your device's internal storage and your SD card appear as external disks in Microsoft® Windows® Explorer. Computer: Drag and drop the desired files between your device and the computer. To transfer content between internal storage and an SD card via USB Using a USB cable, connect your device to a computer. Internal storage & SD card connected appears in the status bar on the screen of your device. Computer: Open Microsoft® Windows® Explorer from the desktop and wait until your device's internal storage and your SD card appear as external disks in Microsoft® Windows® Explorer. Computer: Drag and drop the desired files between the device's internal storage and the SD card. To transfer files directly from internal storage to an SD card in the device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Storage > Transfer data to SD card. Mark the file types you want to transfer to the SD card. Tap Transfer. The direct transfer method means that a USB cable connection to a computer is not necessary. Transferring files using Media transfer mode via Wi-Fi® You can transfer files between your device and other MTP compatible devices, such as a computer, using a Wi-Fi® connection. Before connecting, you first need to pair the two devices. If you're transferring music, video, pictures or other media files between your device and a computer, it's best to use the Media Go™ application on the computer. Media Go™ converts media files so that you can use them on your device. In order to use this feature, you need a Wi-Fi® enabled device that supports Media transfer, for example, a computer running Microsoft® Windows Vista® or Windows® 7. To pair your device wirelessly with a computer using Media transfer mode Make sure Media transfer mode is enabled on your device. It is normally enabled by default. Connect your device to the computer using a USB cable. Computer: Once the name of your device appears on the screen, click Network configuration and follow the instructions to pair the computer. When you are finished pairing, disconnect the USB cable from both devices. The above instructions only work if Windows® 7 is installed on your computer and the computer is connected to a Wi-Fi® Access Point via a network cable. To connect paired devices wirelessly in Media transfer mode Make sure Media transfer mode is enabled on your device. It is normally enabled by default. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to connect to under Trusted devices. Tap Connect. Make sure the Wi-Fi® function is turned on. 105 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 4 To disconnect a wirelessly paired device in Media transfer mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to disconnect from under Trusted devices. Tap Disconnect. To remove a pairing with another device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to remove. Tap Forget. PC Companion PC Companion is a computer application that gives you access to additional features and services which help you transfer music, video and pictures to and from your device. You can also use PC Companion to update your device and get the latest software version available. The installation files for PC Companion are saved on your device and the installation is launched from the device when you connect it to a computer via USB cable. You need an internet connected computer running one of the following operating systems to use the PC Companion application: • • • Microsoft® Windows® 7 Microsoft® Windows Vista® Microsoft® Windows® XP (Service Pack 3 or higher) To start PC Companion Make sure that PC Companion is installed on your PC. Open the PC Companion application on the PC, then click Start to open one of the features that you want to use. Media Go™ The Media Go™ computer application helps you transfer and manage media content in your device and computer. You can install and access Media Go™ from within the PC Companion application. You need one of these operating systems to use the Media Go™ application: • • • Microsoft® Windows® 7 Microsoft® Windows Vista® Microsoft® Windows® XP, Service Pack 3 or higher To transfer content using the Media Go™ application Connect your device to a computer using a supported USB cable. Device: In the status bar, Internal storage connected appears. Computer: Open the PC Companion application on the PC first. In PC Companion, click Media Go to start the Media Go™ application. In some cases, you may have to wait for Media Go™ to install. Using Media Go™, drag and drop files between your computer and device. Connecting your device to a TV set Connect your device to a TV set and start viewing content saved in your device on a larger screen. When you connect your device to the TV set, the TV launcher application opens. This application helps you to play media files from your device on TVs and other devices. You may have to purchase an MHL cable separately. 106 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view content from your device on a TV which supports MHL input Connect your device to the TV using an MHL cable. appears in your device's status bar after a connection is established. The TV launcher application starts automatically. Follow the instructions to view your media files on the TV. To view content from your device on a TV which supports HDMI™ input Connect your device to an MHL-HDMI adaptor, and connect the adaptor to a USB power supply. Connect the adaptor to a TV using a HDMI™ cable. appears in your device's status bar after a connection is established. The TV launcher application starts automatically. Follow the instructions to view your media files on the TV. To view help about using the TV remote control While your device is connected to the TV set, drag the status bar downwards to open the Notification panel. Tap MHL connected. You can also press the yellow button on the TV remote control to open the Notification panel. • To disconnect your device from the TV set Disconnect the MHL™ cable or the MHL-HDMI adaptor from your device. Screen mirroring Use Screen mirroring to show the screen of your device on a TV or other large display without using a cable connection. Wi-Fi Direct™ technology creates a wireless connection between the two devices, so you can sit back and enjoy your favourite photos from the comfort of your couch. You can also use this feature to listen to music from your phone via the TV's speakers. Your TV must support screen mirroring based on Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Miracast™ for the functionality described above to work. If your TV does not support screen mirroring, you need to purchase a wireless display adapter separately. When using screen mirroring, the image quality may sometimes be negatively impacted if there is interference from other Wi-Fi® networks. To mirror the screen of your device on a TV screen Follow the instructions in the User guide for your TV to turn on the screen mirroring function. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Screen mirroring. Tap Turn on Screen mirroring and select a device. When using screen mirroring, do not cover the Wi-Fi antenna area of your device. Scanning barcodes with the NeoReader™ application About scanning with the NeoReader™ application Use your device as a barcode scanner to find out more about items you scan. For example, you see a coat in a magazine ad and want to find the nearest retail outlet to buy it. If the ad contains a readable barcode, the NeoReader™ application uses this code to access mobile web content, such as a web page with more product information or a map of nearby outlets. NeoReader™ supports most standard barcode types. 107 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To start the NeoReader™ application From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap NeoReader™. To scan a barcode When the NeoReader™ application is open, hold your device over the barcode until the complete barcode is visible in the viewfinder. Your device automatically scans the barcode, and vibrates when the barcode is recognised. To enter a barcode manually When the NeoReader™ application is open, tap Enter the numbers of the barcode in the text field, then tap GO!. NeoReader™ application menu overview The following menu options are available in the NeoReader™ application: Tap to open more options Enter the barcode numbers manually. This option can be used if your camera has difficulty reading the barcode View a list of previously scanned barcodes View information about the NeoReader™ application. Read more about different barcode types, and about how to use NeoReader™ Select your personal settings, such as language or country. This information is used to personalise barcode content. Also, you can select preferences for how you use the NeoReader™ application Send a text message to invite a friend to download the NeoReader™ application Smart Connect About Smart Connect Use the Smart Connect application to set what happens in your device when you connect or disconnect an accessory. You can also use it to set a specific action or a group of actions to launch on your device at certain times of the day. For example, when you connect your headset or headphones, you can set an event so that the following actions are launched on your device: • • • Between 7am and 9am, when you commute to work, the WALKMAN player starts, and the web browser opens the morning paper. The ring volume is set to vibrate. Between office hours, a conference call app opens on your device. On the way back from work, the FM radio starts, and a notes app with your shopping list opens. To start the Smart Connect application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Smart Connect. 108 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a Smart Connect event Start the Smart Connection application. If you are opening Smart Connect for the first time, tap OK to close the introduction screen. On the Events tab, tap . Give the event a name, then tap Create. Under When, add either an accessory or a time interval, or both. Under Do this, add what you want to happen in your device. Under At the end, add what you want to happen when you disconnect the accessory or when the time interval comes to an end. If both these conditions are set, the actions start either when you disconnect the accessory, or when the time interval comes to an end. To save the event, press . To add a Bluetooth™ accessory, you have to first pair it with your device. To edit a Smart Connect event Start the Smart Connection application. On the Events tab, tap an event. If the event is switched off, tap . Adjust the settings as desired. To save the event, press . To delete an incorrect entry, touch and hold the entry and then tap Delete. 109 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Synchronising data on your device About synchronising data on your device You can sync contacts, email, calendar events, and other information with your device from multiple email accounts, synchronisation services and other kinds of accounts, depending on the applications installed on your device. Synchronising your device with other information sources is an easy and practical way to stay up to date. Synchronising with Google™ Synchronise your device with different Google™ services to keep your information up to date, regardless of which device you're using your Google™ account from. For example, you can synchronise your contacts, Gmail™, calendar and web browser data. To set up a Google™ account for synchronisation From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Google. Follow the registration wizard to create a Google™ account, or sign in if you already have an account. Mark the Back up & restore checkbox if you want to back up data to your Google™ account, then tap Next. Tap your newly created Google™ account, then tap the items you that want to synchronise. To synchronise manually with your Google™ account From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise. Press , then tap Sync now. To synchronise an application with a Google™ account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise with. A list appears of applications that can be synchronised with the Google account. Tap the application that you want to synchronise with the selected Google account. To synchronise the web browser data From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise with, then tap Sync Browser. To remove a Google™ account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to remove from the accounts list. Press , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts Access your corporate email messages, calendar appointments and contacts directly from your device. View and manage them just as easily as you would from a 110 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. computer. After setup, you can find your information in the Email, Calendar and Contacts applications. For you to access the functionality described above, your corporate information must be stored on a Microsoft® Exchange server. To set up corporate email, calendar and contacts From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Exchange ActiveSync. Enter your corporate email address and password. Tap Next. Your device begins to retrieve your account information. If a failure occurs, contact your corporate network administrator for more information. Tap OK to allow your corporate server to control your device. Select what data you want to sync with your device, such as contacts and calendar entries. If desired, activate the device administrator to allow your corporate server to control certain security features on your device. For example, you can allow your corporate server to set password rules and set storage encryption. When the setup is done, enter a name for the corporate account. To edit the setup of corporate email, calendar and contacts From your Home screen, tap . Tap Email, then tap . Tap Settings and select a corporate account. Change the desired settings. To set a synchronisation interval for a corporate account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Email, then tap . Tap Settings and select a corporate account. Tap Inbox check frequency and select an interval option. To remove a corporate account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Exchange ActiveSync, then select the corporate account. Tap , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. Synchronising with Facebook™ There are two ways to use Facebook™ on your device. You can use the standard Facebook application to access your online Facebook account, or you can synchronise your Facebook account with your device and share content between Facebook™ and a range of other applications. For example, you can share music in the "WALKMAN" application on your device via Facebook. To synchronise your device with Facebook, you must first set up an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account — a solution developed by Sony to enable easy integration. To set up an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Xperia™ with Facebook. Follow the on-screen instructions to sign in to your Facebook™ account, or create a new account. To synchronise manually with an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Xperia™ with Facebook. Select the account that you want to synchronise. Press , then tap Sync now. 111 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To remove an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account When you remove an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account from your device, the associated online Facebook account is not deleted and you can still access it from a computer. From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Xperia™ with Facebook. Select the account that you want to remove. Press , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. 112 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Maps and locations About location services Use your device to find out where you are. There are two methods: GPS and wireless networks. Enable the wireless networks option if you only need your approximate location, and want it fast. If you want a more exact position, and have a clear view of the sky, enable the GPS option. In situations where the wireless network connection is weak, you should enable both options to ensure that your location is found. Sony does not warrant the accuracy of any location services including but not limited to navigational services. Using GPS Your device has a global positioning system (GPS) receiver that uses satellite signals to calculate your location. When you use features that require the GPS receiver to find your location, make sure you have a clear view of the sky. To enable GPS From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Location services. Mark the GPS satellites checkbox. Getting the best performance The first time you use the GPS it can take 5 to 10 minutes for your location to be found. To help the search, make sure you have a clear view of the sky. Stand still and don't cover the GPS antenna (the highlighted area in the image). The GPS signals can pass through clouds and plastic, but not through most solid objects such as buildings and mountains. If your location isn't found after a few minutes, move to another location. 113 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Maps™ Track your current location, view real-time traffic situations and receive detailed directions to your destination. Before taking trips, you can download and save maps to your memory card to avoid high roaming costs. The Google Maps™ application requires the use of an Internet connection. You may incur data connection charges when you connect to the Internet from your device. Contact your network operator for more information. The Google Maps™ application may not be available in every market, country or region. To use Google Maps™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Maps. If you want to use Google Maps™, you have to enable one of the location methods available under Settings > Location services. • To learn more about Google Maps™ When you use Google Maps™, tap , then tap Help. Viewing your friends’ locations with Google Latitude™ Join Google Latitude™ to view your friends’ locations on maps and share your location and other information with them. Using Google Maps™ to get directions Use the Google Maps™ application to get directions when you travel by foot, public transportation, or car. You can add a shortcut to a destination on your Home screen to get quick directions from wherever you are. When you view a map, you make an Internet connection, and data is transferred to your device. So it's a good idea to download and save maps to your device before you take a trip. This way, you can avoid high roaming costs. Sony does not warrant the accuracy of any directional services. Using the Navigation application Use the Navigation application in your device to get turn-by-turn instructions on how to get places. The directions are both spoken and displayed on the screen. The Navigation application may not be available in every market. To start Navigation From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Navigation. 114 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Calendar and alarm clock Calendar Your device has a calendar application for managing your time schedule. If you have a Google™ account, you can also synchronise the calendar application on your device with your web calendar. To set the calendar view From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Calendar. Tap Month, Week or Day to select an option. To view multiple calendars From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Calendar. Press , then tap My calendars. Select the calendars you want to view. To create a calendar event From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Tap . Enter the name, time, location and description for the event. Select a reminder for the event. To add a new reminder for the event, tap If desired, tap More and select another option under Repetition. Tap Done. When the appointment time approaches, your device plays a short sound to remind you. Also, appears in the status bar. To view a calendar event From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Tap the event you want to view. To change the calendar settings From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Press , then tap Settings. Tap the setting you want to change, then edit as desired. Alarm clock Use your device as an alarm clock and select any sound saved on your device as your alarm signal. The alarm does not sound if your device is turned off. But it does sound when the device is set to silent mode. To open the alarm clock From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Alarm & clock. To set a new alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap Add alarm. Tap Time and adjust the time by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. If desired, edit other alarm settings. Tap Done. 115 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To edit an existing alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Time and adjust the time by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. If desired, edit other alarm settings. Tap Done. The alarm time format displayed is the same as the format you select for your general time settings, for example, 12-hour or 24-hour. To deactivate an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap next to the alarm you want to deactivate. To activate an existing alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap next to the alarm you want to activate. To delete an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Touch and hold the alarm you want to delete. Tap Delete alarm, then tap Yes. To set the ringtone for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings and unmark the Style settings checkbox. Tap Alarm sound and select an option. Tap Done, then tap Done. To set a recurring alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Repeat. Mark the checkboxes for the desired days, then tap OK. Tap Done. To set the title for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then tap the Alarm text field and enter a name for the alarm. Tap Done. To activate the vibrate function for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then mark the Vibrate checkbox. Tap Done. 116 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set alarms to sound when the device is in silent mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock, then tap to select an alarm. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then mark the Alarm in silent mode checkbox. Tap Done. • To snooze an alarm when it sounds Tap Snooze - min. • To turn off an alarm when it sounds Slide to the right. 117 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Support and maintenance Updating your device Update your device to the most recent software version to get optimal performance and the latest enhancements. You can use the Update center application on your device to run a wireless update or you can use the PC Companion application on a computer to run an update using a USB cable connection. If you update wirelessly, then you can use either a mobile network or a Wi-Fi® network connection. Just make sure you back up and save all data stored on your device before you update. When you run an update using the Update center application, a data connection is established and related charges may be incurred. Also, the availability of updates over a mobile network depends on your operator. Contact your network operator for more information. Updating your device wirelessly Use the Update center application to update your device wirelessly. You can download software updates manually, or you can allow Update service to update your device automatically whenever downloads become available. When the automatic update feature is activated, a notification appears in the status bar every time an update becomes available. To download software updates manually from Update center From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Select the desired application or system update and tap Download, or tap Update all to download all application updates. Application updates launch automatically after download. With system updates, wait for your device to restart, then install the update manually. You may incur data connection charges when downloading updates over mobile networks. To activate automatic software updates using the Update Center application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Press , then tap Settings. Mark the Allow automatic downloads checkbox, then tap Agree. Updates are now downloaded automatically as soon as they become available. You may incur data connection charges when downloading updates over mobile networks. To install system updates From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Select a system update you want to install, then tap Install. Updating your device using a USB cable connection Some updates are not available for wireless download. Notifications appear in the status bar to inform you of such updates. To download and run the updates, you need a USB cable and a computer running the PC Companion application. You can install PC Companion on the computer using installation files saved on your device, or you can download the application directly from PC Companion. 118 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To download the PC Companion application from your device Connect your device to a computer using a USB cable. When prompted, follow the instructions in your device to launch the installation of PC Companion on the computer. PC Companion can also be downloaded from PC Companion. To download software updates using a USB cable connection Install the PC Companion application on the computer you are using, if it is not already installed. Connect your device to the computer using a USB cable. Computer: Launch the PC Companion application. After a few moments, PC Companion detects your device and searches for new software for it. Device: When notifications appear in the status bar, follow the on-screen instructions to carry out the relevant software updates. To update your device using an Apple® Mac® computer Install Sony™ Bridge for Mac application on the Apple® Mac® computer you are using, if it is not already installed. Using a USB cable, connect your device to the Apple® Mac® computer. Computer: Launch Sony™ Bridge for Mac application. After a few moments, Sony™ Bridge for Mac application detects your device and searches for new software for it. Computer: If a new software update is detected, a popup window appears. Follow the on-screen instructions to carry out the relevant software updates. Sony™ Bridge for Mac application is downloadable from Bridge for mac. Backup and restore application Use the Backup and restore application to make backups of content to a memory card or a USB storage device. Such backups can be used to restore your content and some settings in cases where your data gets lost or deleted. Types of content you can back up Use the Backup and restore application to back up the following types of data: • • • • • • • Bookmarks Call log Contacts Applications downloaded from Google Play™ Multimedia messages System settings (such as alarms, ringer volume, and language settings) Text messages You do not need to back up music files and photos or videos taken with the camera. They are backed up automatically to the device's memory card. You may incur additional data transmission charges when you restore applications from Google Play™. Preparing to use the Backup and restore application Before backing up your content, you can select the backup destination and the types of data that you want to back up. To select the backup destination From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up. Tap the bar under Where to store data. Select the destination to which you want to back up your content. 119 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To select the data types to back up From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up. Select the data types that you want to back up. To back up content From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up, then tap Back up now. Restoring backed up content using the Backup and restore application When you restore backed up content, you must select a backup record to restore from. If you have backed up content several times, you may have several backup records. After you select a backup record, you can then select which types of data to restore. To restore content from a backup record From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Restore. Select the record that you want to restore from, then tap Restore now. Remember that any changes you make to your data and settings after you create a backup will get deleted during a restore procedure. Managing backup records You can delete or rename records of the backups that you make using the Backup & restore function. To rename a backup record From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Press , then tap Manage backup records. Select the backup record that you want to rename. Tap . Enter a new name and tap Rename. To delete backup records From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Press , then tap Manage backup records. Select the backup record that you want to delete, or tap all records. Tap > Delete. if you want to delete Resetting your device About resetting your device You can reset your device to its original settings, with or without deleting all of your personal data. It is possible to reset your device to the state it was in before you first turned it on. But before you perform a reset, make sure to back up any important data saved on your device. 120 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To perform a factory data reset To avoid permanent damage to your device, do not restart your device while a reset procedure is underway. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Backup & reset. Tap Factory data reset. If you also want to erase data such as pictures and music, which is saved to your device's internal storage, mark the Erase internal storage checkbox. Tap Reset phone. To confirm, tap Erase everything. Locking and protecting your device IMEI number Every device has a unique IMEI (International Mobile Equipment Identity) number. You should keep a copy of this number. If your device is stolen, your network provider can use your IMEI number to stop the device from accessing the network in your country. To view your IMEI number • • Turn off your phone, then remove the battery cover and battery to view your IMEI number. Open the phone dialer on your device and enter *#06#*. To view your IMEI number in the device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > About phone > Status. Scroll to IMEI to view the IMEI number. Setting a screen lock There are several ways to lock the screen on your device. For example, you can use the Face Unlock feature, which uses a picture of your face to unlock the screen. You can also set a screen unlock pattern, a number-based PIN lock, or a text-based password. It is very important that you remember your screen unlock pattern, PIN or password. If you forget this information, it may not be possible to restore important data such as contacts and messages. Refer to Sony customer support for more information. 121 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set a screen lock From your Home screen, tap Select an option. > Settings > Security > Screen lock. To set up the Face Unlock feature From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Tap Face Unlock, then follow the instructions in your device to capture your face. After your face is successfully captured, tap Continue. Select a backup lock method and follow the instructions in the device to complete the setup. The Face Unlock feature is less secure than a screen lock pattern, PIN, or password. Someone who looks similar to you could unlock your device. For best results, capture your face in an indoor area that is well lit but not too bright, and hold the device at eye level. To unlock the screen using the Face Unlock feature Activate the screen. Look at your device from the same angle you used to capture your Face Unlock photo. If the Face Unlock feature fails to recognise your face, you need to draw the backup pattern or enter the PIN to unlock the screen. To disable the Face Unlock protection From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw your backup screen unlock pattern or enter your PIN. Tap Swipe. To create a screen unlock pattern From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security > Screen lock > Pattern. Follow the instructions in your device. You are asked to select a security question that will be used to unlock the device if you forget your screen unlock pattern. To unlock the screen using a screen unlock pattern Activate the screen. Draw your screen unlock pattern. If the unlock pattern you draw on the screen is rejected five times in a row, you can select to either wait 30 seconds and then try again, or to answer the security question you have selected. To change the screen unlock pattern From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw your screen unlock pattern. Tap Pattern. Follow the instructions in your device. To disable the screen unlock pattern From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw the screen unlock pattern. Tap Swipe. 122 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a screen unlock PIN From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock > PIN. Enter a numeric PIN. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap Continue. Re-enter and confirm your PIN. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap OK. To disable the screen unlock PIN From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Enter your PIN, then tap Next. Tap Swipe. To create a screen lock password From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock > Password. Enter a password. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap Continue. Re-enter and confirm your password. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap OK. To disable the screen unlock password From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Enter your password and tap Continue. Tap Swipe. Support application To access the support application From your Application screen, find and tap Find and tap the required support item. Recycling your device Got an old device lying around the house? Why not recycle it? By doing so, you will help us reuse its materials and components, and you’ll protect the environment, too! Find out more about the recycling options in your region at blogs.sonymobile.com/ about-us/sustainability/commitment/overview/. 123 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Reference Settings overview Get to know the settings in your device so that you can personalise them to your own requirements. Wi-Fi Turn Wi-Fi® on or off, scan for available Wi-Fi® networks, or add a Wi-Fi® network. Bluetooth Turn Bluetooth™ on or off, search for available Bluetooth™ devices, and make your device visible or invisible to other Bluetooth™ devices. Data usage Turn the mobile data traffic on or off, and keep track of your data usage details over a specified period of time. More… Turn Airplane mode on or off, configure settings for VPN and mobile networks, and enable your device to share its mobile data connection as a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot, or via USB tethering or Bluetooth™ tethering. You can also enable or disable the NFC function. Call settings Manage and configure settings for fixed dialing numbers, voicemail and Internet calls. Sound Configure how your device rings, vibrates, or alerts you when you receive communications. You can also use these settings to set the volume level for music, video, games or other media with audio, and to make related adjustments. Display Enable the screen to switch orientation when you rotate your device. You can also set the brightness, font size, wallpaper and screen timeout. Storage Check out the available space on the internal storage and on the SD card. You can also erase the SD card, or unmount it for safe removal. Power management Turn the power saving modes on or off. You can also view your battery status and see how different applications consume battery power. Apps Manage running applications, downloaded applications and applications on the SD card. Xperia™ Access a range of settings tailored to your Xperia device, for example, USB connection mode, Internet, screen mirroring, security, and Throw settings. Location services Enable or disable access to your location information. Security Protect your device by setting up different locks and passwords. You can also allow the installation of applications not from Google Play™. Language & input Select the device language, adjust text input options, add words to the personal dictionary and configure speech settings. Backup & reset Back up your data and reset your device. Setup guide Get help setting up your device. Add account Add an account on your device, for example, an email account or a Google™ account. 124 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Date & time Set the time and date, or choose the network-provided values. Select your preferred date and hour format. Accessibility Enable your installed accessibility services and adjust related settings. Developer options Set options for application development. For example, you can display CPU usage on the Home screen or set your device to enter debug mode when USB connections are active. About phone View information about your device, such as the model number and signal strength. You can also update your software to the latest version. Status and notification icons overview Status icons The following status icons may appear on your screen: Signal strength No signal Roaming GPRS is available EDGE is available NFC is activated 3G is available Sending and downloading GPRS data Sending and downloading EDGE data Sending and downloading 3G data Battery status The battery is charging GPS is activated Airplane mode is activated The Bluetooth™ function is activated The SIM card is not inserted The microphone is muted The speakerphone is on Silent mode Vibrate mode An alarm is set Synchronisation is ongoing Problem with sign-in or synchronisation A Wi-Fi® connection is enabled and wireless networks are available 125 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Notification icons The following notification icons may appear on your screen: New email message New text message or multimedia message New voicemail An upcoming calendar event A song is playing The device is connected to a computer via a USB cable Warning message Error message Missed call Call ongoing Call on hold Call forwarding on Software updates available Downloading data Uploading data More (undisplayed) notifications Application overview Use the Alarm and clock application to set various kinds of alarms. Use your web browser to navigate and view web pages, manage bookmarks, and manage text and images. Use the Calculator application to perform basic calculations. Use the Calendar application to keep track of your events and manage your appointments. Use the camera to take photos and record video clips. Use the Contact application to manage phone numbers, email address and other information related to your contacts. Access your downloaded applications. Use the Email application to send and receive emails through both private and corporate accounts. Use the Facebook application to engage in social networking with friends, family members and colleagues around the world. Browse and listen to FM radio stations. Use the Album application to view and to work with your photos and videos. Use the Gmail™ application to read, write and organise email messages. Search for information in your device and on the web. 126 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. View your current location, find other locations, and calculate routes using Google Maps™. Go to Google Play™ to download free and paid applications for your device. Use the Messaging application to send and receive text and multimedia messages. Use the Movies application to play videos in your device, and share videos with your friends or on other devices using DLNA™. Use the "WALKMAN" application to organise and play music, audio books and podcasts. Navigate your way using spoken, turn-by-turn instructions. View news stories and weather forecasts. Make phone calls by dialling the number manually or by using the smart dial function. Search for places, for example, restaurants and cafés. Use the Video Unlimited™ application to rent and purchase videos. Use the subscription-based Music Unlimited™ application to access millions of songs over a mobile data connection or Wi-Fi® connection. Optimise settings to suit your own requirements. Use the Google Talk™ application to chat with friends online. Identify music tracks that you hear playing in your surroundings, and get artist, album and other info. Use the Help application to access user support in the device. For example, you can access a User guide, troubleshooting information, plus tips and tricks. Use YouTube™ to share and view videos from around the world. Download and install new applications and updates. Some applications are not supported all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 127 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Important information Important information leaflet Before you use your device, please read the Important information leaflet provided in the Setup guide in your device or in the box. To access the setup guide manually From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Setup guide. Limitations to services and features Some of the services and features described in this User guide are not supported in all countries/regions or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. Without limitation, this applies to the GSM International Emergency Number, 112. Please contact your network operator or service provider to determine availability of any specific service or feature and whether additional access or usage fees apply. Use of certain features and applications described in this guide may require access to the Internet. You may incur data connection charges when you connect to the Internet from your device. Contact your wireless service provider for more information. Protecting your device from water and dust In order for your device to be waterproof, the covers for the micro USB port and the headset jack must be firmly closed. Also, make sure that the battery cover is attached correctly. Avoid exposing your device to environments with excessive dust or moisture. Normal wear and tear along with damage to your device can reduce its ability to resist dust or moisture. You can use the device in the following fresh (non-saline) water conditions: Swimming pool Diving Shooting photos and videos You should only use the device in water depths of 1.5 metres or less. Do not use your device in the following conditions: Sand/mud Salt water Other liquid chemicals Water can sometimes cause unintended touch actions on the screen. So it is recommended to activate the Touch Block function before using the device in water. You may need to first download the Touch Block application by using the Update center application in your device. 128 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Your smartphone is waterproof and dust resistant in compliance with the Ingress Protection ratings IP5X, IPX5 and IPX8 (see details below). Always firmly attach all covers to ensure the water and dust resistance of the device. If liquid is detected inside the device, for example, underneath one of the covers or on the battery, your warranty will be void. Never submerge your device in salt water or let the micro USB port or headset jack come in contact with salt water. Also, never expose the device to any liquid chemicals, or to moist environments with extreme high or low temperatures. The waterproof ability of the micro USB port and the headset jack is not guaranteed in all environments or conditions. After using the device in water, dry off the areas around the micro USB port cover and the headset jack cover. If the speaker or microphone get wet, dry these areas and wait for three hours before using them again. You can, however, use other features in the device that do not utilise the speaker or microphone. All compatible accessories, including batteries, chargers, handsfree devices and micro USB cables, are not waterproof and dust resistant on their own. Your warranty does not cover damage or defects caused by abuse or improper use of your device. If you have any further questions about the use of your products, refer to our Customer support service for help. IP (Ingress Protection) rating Your device has an IP rating, which means it has undergone certified tests to measure its resistance levels to both dust and water. The first digit in the two-digit IP rating indicates the level of protection against solid objects, including dust. The second digit indicates how resistant the device is to water. The higher the numbers, the higher the respective protection. Your smartphone is waterproof and dust resistant in compliance with the Ingress Protection ratings IP5X, IPX5 and IPX8 (see details below). These ratings mean that your device is dust resistant and is protected against low pressure water stream as well as against the effects of submersion for 30 minutes in fresh (non-saline) water up to 1.5 metres deep. You can therefore use the device in dusty environments, when your fingers are wet, and in extreme weather conditions, for example, when it’s snowing or raining, or when humidity levels are high. You can also use the device in fresh water conditions (for example, in a swimming pool) to take underwater photos or shoot underwater videos using the Camera key. See the table below for more details. Resistance to solid objects and dust Resistance to water IP0X. No special protection IPX0. No special protection IP1X. Protected against solid objects > 50 mm in diameter IPX1. Protected against dripping water IP2X. Protected against solid objects > 12.5 mm in diameter IPX2. Protected against dripping water when tilted up to 15 degrees from normal position IP3X. Protected against solid objects > 2.5 mm in diameter IPX3. Protected against spraying water IP4X. Protected against solid objects > 1 mm in diameter IPX4. Protected against splashing water IP5X. Protected against dust; limited ingress (no harmful deposit) IPX5. Protected against water jet spray IP6X. Dust tight IPX6. Protected against heavy jet spray IPX7. Protected against the effects of immersion IPX8. Protected against submersion The IPX5 and IPX8 ratings are based on tests lasting 30 minutes in water depths of 1.5 metres. Go to www.sonymobile.com/testresults for more information. 129 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Legal information Sony C5503/C5502 This User guide is published by Sony Mobile Communications AB or its local affiliated company, without any warranty. Improvements and changes to this User guide necessitated by typographical errors, inaccuracies of current information, or improvements to programs and/or equipment, may be made by Sony Mobile Communications AB at any time and without notice. Such changes will, however, be incorporated into new editions of this User guide. ©Sony Mobile Communications AB, 2013. All rights reserved. Your mobile phone has the capability to download, store and forward additional content, for example, ringtones. The use of such content may be restricted or prohibited by rights of third parties, including but not limited to restriction under applicable copyright laws. You, and not Sony, are entirely responsible for additional content that you download to or forward from your mobile phone. Prior to your use of any additional content, please verify that your intended use is properly licensed or is otherwise authorized. Sony does not guarantee the accuracy, integrity or quality of any additional content or any other third party content. Under no circumstances will Sony be liable in any way for your improper use of additional content or other third party content. This User guide may reference services or applications provided by third parties. Use of such programming or services may require separate registration with the third party provider and may be subject to additional terms of use. For applications accessed on or through a third-party website, please review such websites’ terms of use and applicable privacy policy in advance. Sony does not warrant or guarantee the availability or performance of any third-party websites or offered services. Remove the battery to see regulatory information such as the CE mark. All product and company names mentioned herein are the trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. All other trademarks are property of their respective owners. Visit www.sonymobile.com for more information. All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual phone. This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from Microsoft. Content owners use Windows Media digital rights management technology (WMDRM) to protect their intellectual property, including copyrights. This device uses WMDRM software to access WMDRM-protected content. If the WMDRM software fails to protect the content, content owners may ask Microsoft to revoke the software's ability to use WMDRM to play or copy protected content. Revocation does not affect unprotected content. When you download licenses for protected content, you agree that Microsoft may include a revocation list with the licenses. Content owners may require you to upgrade WMDRM to access their content. If you decline an upgrade, you will not be able to access content that requires the upgrade. This product is licensed under the MPEG-4 visual and AVC patent portfolio licenses for the personal and noncommercial use of a consumer for (i) encoding video in compliance with the MPEG-4 visual standard ("MPEG-4 video") or the AVC standard ("AVC video") and/or (ii) decoding MPEG- 4 or AVC video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal and non-commercial activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed by MPEG LA to provide MPEG-4 and/or AVC video. No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use. Additional information including that relating to promotional, internal and commercial uses and licensing may be obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C. See http://www.mpegla.com. MPEG Layer-3 audio decoding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. 130 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Index accounts ..................................................................11 Exchange Active Sync® ..................................11 Facebook™ .....................................................11 Google™ .........................................................11 adjusting volume .....................................................59 Airplane mode .........................................................31 alarm ......................................................................115 Album ................................................................81, 82 map .................................................................86 My albums .......................................................83 online albums ..................................................87 opening ...........................................................81 pictures ............................................................82 SensMe™ slideshow .......................................84 thumbnail size .................................................82 viewing ..........................................82, 83, 86, 87 viewing local content .......................................81 viewing online photos ......................................88 Android Market™ - See Google Play™ ..................37 Android™ ..................................................................7 animated wallpaper .................................................20 answering service ....................................................41 applications arranging .........................................................22 overview ........................................................126 screen ..............................................................20 sorting .............................................................22 audio ........................................................................62 adjusting volume .............................................59 playing .............................................................59 playing tracks in random order .......................62 audio content related content ................................................60 back cover attaching ............................................................9 removing ............................................................8 backing up contacts ...................................................49, 119 content ..........................................................119 battery .....................................................................12 Bluetooth™ wireless technology ...........................102 BRAVIA® Engine .....................................................81 brightness ................................................................31 business cards sending ............................................................48 calendar .................................................................115 create an event ..............................................115 calls ...................................................................39, 43 barring .............................................................42 diverting ...........................................................42 emergency .......................................................39 forwarding .......................................................42 log ....................................................................40 missed .............................................................40 multiple ............................................................41 reject ................................................................42 settings ............................................................42 waiting .............................................................41 camera .........................................................70, 72, 77 closing .............................................................70 controls ...........................................................70 face detection ..................................................71 geotagging ......................................................72 icons ................................................................77 overview ..........................................................70 recording videos ........................................76, 77 screen ..............................................................70 self-portraits ....................................................71 settings ......................................................72, 77 smile detection ................................................72 Smile Shutter™ ...............................................72 taking photos ......................................70, 71, 72 using the flash .................................................71 video ................................................................76 viewing photos ................................................71 viewing videos .................................................77 zoom ................................................................71 caps lock .................................................................25 charging ...................................................................12 chat ..........................................................................52 conference calls ......................................................41 connectivity .............................................................94 contacts ...................................................................44 backing up .......................................................49 copying ............................................................49 favourite ...........................................................48 groups .............................................................48 importing from SIM card .................................45 joining contact information ..............................47 picture .............................................................47 sending ............................................................48 sharing .............................................................48 transferring ................................................44, 45 corporate email, calendar and contacts ................110 cropping photos .............................................................84 data traffic ...............................................................34 date format ..............................................................30 deleting ....................................................................59 an alarm .........................................................115 music ...............................................................65 photos .............................................................85 tracks ...............................................................59 videos ..............................................................86 device battery .............................................................13 performance ....................................................13 update ...........................................................118 download Internet settings ...............................................33 driving directions ...................................................114 editing photos .............................................................85 email ........................................................................53 more than one account ...................................53 emergency numbers ................................................39 equaliser ..................................................................59 events calendar .........................................................115 extensions ...............................................................18 face detection ..........................................................71 Facebook™ "Like" a track on Facebook™ .........................60 synchronisation .............................................111 131 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Xperia™ with Facebook ................................111 favourites removing radio channels as ............................68 saving radio channels as .................................68 fixed dialling ............................................................43 flash using when taking photos ...............................71 Flight mode - See Airplane mode ............................31 FM radio favourites .........................................................68 selecting a channel ..........................................67 Friends’ music .........................................................62 front camera ............................................................70 geotagging of photos .........................................................72 gesture input ...........................................................27 Gmail™ ....................................................................53 Google Latitude™ .................................................114 Google Maps™ .....................................................114 Google Play™ .........................................................37 Google Talk™ ..........................................................52 Google™ account setup .........................................54 Google™ synchronisation .....................................110 GPS .......................................................................113 headset ....................................................................33 using ................................................................33 Home screen ...........................................................18 customising .....................................................19 icons ..............................................................125, 126 in the camera ...................................................77 importing SIM contacts ...........................................45 improving photos with Mobile BRAVIA® Engine ....81 infinite button ...........................................................60 instant messaging ...................................................52 Internet settings ............................................................33 web browser ....................................................93 Navigation application ...........................................114 notification .............................................................126 light ..................................................................23 panel ..........................................................23, 24 ringtone ...........................................................30 setting ..............................................................24 on-screen keyboard ................................................25 overview ..................................................................61 keyboard .................................................................25 settings ............................................................28 keys .........................................................................12 language ..................................................................31 writing ..............................................................28 Latitude .................................................................114 LCD backlight control ..............................................31 "Like" a photo on Facebook™ ................................88 "Like" a track on Facebook™ .................................60 "Like" a video on Facebook™ .................................88 live wallpaper ...........................................................20 location ............................................................72, 113 locks activating the screen .......................................10 locking the screen ...........................................10 screen lock ......................................................10 micro SIM card inserting .............................................................9 Microsoft® Exchange synchronisation .................110 Mobile BRAVIA® Engine .........................................81 Movies .....................................................................89 clearing video information ...............................90 Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS) settings ............................................................33 music ...........................................................33, 58, 63 adjusting volume .............................................59 changing tracks ...............................................59 deleting ............................................................65 downloading music information ......................61 hearing protection ...........................................63 My playlists ......................................................63 pausing a track ................................................59 playing .............................................................59 purchasing .......................................................64 searching using TrackID™ ..............................64 sending ............................................................60 sharing .............................................................64 shortcuts .........................................................61 transferring to your device ..............................58 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 using a headset ...............................................33 viewing artist info ............................................65 Visualiser .........................................................60 music services .........................................................64 Music Unlimited™ ...................................................65 My music .................................................................61 maintenance ..........................................................118 Maps ..............................................................113, 114 marking options .......................................................15 Media Go™ ...........................................................106 messages settings ............................................................33 MHL (Mobile High-Definition Link) ........................106 pausing a track ........................................................59 personal information ................................................44 phone maintenance ...............................................118 phonebook ..............................................................44 Phonepad ..........................................................25, 27 photo albums viewing ............................................................81 photos .....................................................................85 adding a geotag ..............................................85 adding the geographical position ....................72 associating with a contact ..............................47 cropping ..........................................................84 deleting ............................................................85 editing ..............................................................85 photo viewer ....................................................82 rotating ............................................................84 selecting ..........................................................82 SensMe™ slideshow .......................................84 sharing .............................................................85 slideshow ........................................................84 taking ...................................................70, 71, 72 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 using as ...........................................................84 viewing ................................................71, 81, 82 viewing on a map ............................................86 viewing same location .....................................72 zooming ...........................................................84 PIN .........................................................................121 132 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. playing music ...............................................................59 playlists ....................................................................62 adding a track .................................................62 deleting ............................................................63 playing your own .............................................63 removing tracks ...............................................63 powering off ............................................................10 powering on .............................................................10 presets removing radio channels as ............................68 saving radio channels as .................................68 protective plastic sheet ...........................................15 PUK .......................................................................121 purchasing music ...............................................................64 radio ........................................................................67 favourites .........................................................68 listening to with the speaker ...........................68 mono sound ....................................................68 moving between channels ..............................67 opening ...........................................................67 radio region .....................................................67 searching for channels ....................................68 selecting a channel ..........................................67 stereo sound ...................................................68 visualizer ..........................................................67 radio sound .............................................................68 receiving items using Bluetooth™ .........................103 recently used applications window .........................21 recommending music ..............................................60 recommending photos and videos ..........................88 recording videos ......................................................70 using the camera key ......................................76 recycling your device ............................................123 resetting .................................................................120 resizing photos .............................................................84 ringtone .................................................................115 rotating photos .............................................................84 scanning barcodes ................................................107 screen ......................................................................31 cracked ............................................................15 glass ................................................................15 screen unlock pattern ....................................121 warranty ...........................................................15 screen mirroring ....................................................107 searching music using TrackID™ ....................................64 track information .............................................64 self-portrait ..............................................................70 sending business cards ................................................48 contacts ...........................................................48 music ...............................................................60 sending items using Bluetooth™ ..................103 SensMe™ channels ................................................62 services ...................................................................11 settings call ...................................................................42 camera ......................................................72, 77 data usage .......................................................34 Internet ............................................................33 messaging .......................................................33 MMS ................................................................33 quick settings ..................................................23 still camera ......................................................72 video camera ...................................................77 setup guide ..............................................................10 sharing music ...............................................................64 photos .............................................................85 shuffle music ...........................................................62 silent mode ..............................................................29 SIM card ................................................................121 exporting contacts to ......................................49 importing contacts from ..................................45 slideshow ................................................................84 Smart Connect ......................................................108 smile detection ........................................................72 Smile Shutter™ .......................................................72 SOS - See emergency numbers ..............................39 STAMINA mode changing settings ............................................14 standby time estimating ........................................................14 status .....................................................................125 bar ...................................................................23 still camera ........................................................70, 72 settings ............................................................72 support ..................................................................118 Support application ...............................................123 surround sound feature ...........................................59 symbols ...................................................................25 synchronising ........................................................110 Facebook™ contacts, calendar, photos .......111 Google™ contacts, calendar, email ..............110 with Microsoft® Exchange ............................110 taking photos ...........................................................70 by tapping .......................................................71 self-portraits ....................................................71 using face detection ........................................71 using smile detection ......................................72 using Smile Shutter™ ......................................72 using the camera key ......................................70 telephony - See calls ...............................................39 tethering USB tethering ..................................................95 with Xperia Link™ ...........................................95 text input method ....................................................25 themes .....................................................................20 time ..........................................................................30 time management ..................................................115 TrackID™ technology ..............................................64 buying a track ..................................................64 deleting a track ................................................65 opening ...........................................................64 searching for track information .......................64 sharing a track .................................................64 using results ....................................................64 using with the FM Radio .................................69 viewing artist info ............................................65 viewing charts .................................................64 transferring contacts .....................................................44, 45 turning off ................................................................10 turning on ................................................................10 updating your device .............................................118 usage info ................................................................34 USB connection ....................................................104 using Movies ...........................................................89 using the equaliser ..................................................59 133 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. V vibration ...........................................................30, 115 video albums viewing ............................................................81 video camera ...............................................70, 76, 77 recording videos ..............................................77 settings ............................................................77 Video Unlimited™ ....................................................91 buying videos ..................................................91 creating an account .........................................91 menu overview ..........................................91, 92 notifications .....................................................91 renting videos ..................................................91 watching a video .............................................92 videos ......................................................................85 adjusting volume .............................................85 deleting ............................................................86 fast forwarding and rewinding .........................85 pausing ............................................................85 playing .............................................................85 recording ...................................................76, 77 selecting ..........................................................82 sending ............................................................85 sharing .............................................................85 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 viewing ................................................77, 81, 82 viewing Movies .............................................................89 photos .............................................................71 videos recorded using the camera ..................77 voice input ...............................................................29 voice recognition .....................................................29 voicemail .................................................................41 volume adjusting for videos .........................................85 key ...................................................................29 "WALKMAN" application adding tracks to playlists ................................62 deleting tracks .................................................59 minimising .......................................................59 overview ..........................................................58 playing tracks in random order .......................62 playlists ...........................................................62 using ................................................................59 using the equaliser ..........................................59 "WALKMAN" application widget .............................63 wallpaper .................................................................20 web browser ............................................................93 widgets ....................................................................19 resizing ............................................................19 wireless networks ..................................................113 zoom ........................................................................71 zooming photos .............................................................84 134 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 1 of 2 Sony Consumer Web site At www.sonymobile.com/support there is a support section where help and tips are only a few clicks away. Here you will find the latest computer software updates and tips on how to use your product more efficiently. Important information Service and support You have access to a portfolio of exclusive service advantages such as: • Global and local Web sites providing support. • A global network of Contact Centers. • An extensive network of Sony service partners. • A warranty period. Learn more about the warranty conditions in theLimited warrantysection. At www.sonymobile.com/support, you can find the latest support tools and information. For operator-specific services and features, please contact your network operator. You can also contact our Contact Centers. If your country/region is not represented in the list below, please contact your local dealer. (Calls are charged according to national rates, including local taxes, unless the phone number is a toll-free number.) If your product needs service, please contact the dealer from whom it was purchased, or one of our service partners. For warranty claims, save proof of purchase. Power supply (Charger) Connect the charger to power sources as marked on the product. Do not use outdoors or in damp areas. Do not alter or subject the cord to damage or stress. Unplug the unit before cleaning it. Never alter the plug. If it does not fit into the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by an electrician. When a power supply is connected there is a small drain of power. To avoid this small energy waste, disconnect the power supply when the product is fully charged. Use of charging devices that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Recommendations for care and safe use of our products • Handle with care and keep in a clean and dust-free place. • Warning! May explode if disposed of in fire. • Do not expose to liquid or moisture or excess humidity. • For optimum performance, the product should not be operated in temperatures below -10°C(+14°F) or above Emergency calls Calls cannot be guaranteed under all conditions. Never rely solely upon mobile phones for essential communication. Calls may not be possible in all areas, on all networks, or when certain network services and/or phone features are used. Antenna Use of antenna devices not marketed by Sony could damage the phone, reduce performance, and produce SAR levels above the established limits. Do not cover the antenna with your hand as this affects call quality, power levels and can shorten talk and standby times. Radio Frequency (RF) exposure and Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) When the phone or Bluetooth handsfree is turned on, it emits low levels of radio frequency energy. International safety guidelines have been developed through periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies. These guidelines establish permitted levels of radio wave exposure. The guidelines include a safety margin designed to assure the safety of all persons and to account for any variations in measurements. Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) is used to measure radio frequency energy absorbed by the body when using a mobile phone. The SAR value is determined at the highest certified power level in laboratory conditions, but because the phone is designed to use the minimum power necessary to access the chosen network, the actual SAR level can be well below this value. There is no proof of difference in safety based on difference in SAR value. Products with radio transmitters sold in the US must be certified by the Federal Communications Commission (FCC). When required, tests are performed when the phone is placed at the ear and when • Insert the memory card as far as it will go into any memory card adapter needed. The memory card may not operate properly unless fully inserted. • We recommend that you make a backup copy of important data. We are not responsible for any loss or damage to content you store on the memory card. • Recorded data may be damaged or lost when you remove the memory card or memory card adapter, turn off the power while formatting, reading or writing data, or use the memory card in locations subject to static electricity or high electrical field emissions. Protection of personal information Erase personal data before disposing of the product. To delete data, perform a master reset. Deleting data from the phone memory does not ensure that it cannot be recovered. Sony does not warrant against recovery of information and does not assume responsibility for disclosure of any information even after a master reset. Loudness warning! Avoid volume levels that may be harmful to your hearing. End User Licence Agreement Software delivered with this device and its media is owned by Sony Mobile Communications AB, and/or its affiliated companies and its suppliers and licensors. Sony grants you a non-exclusive limited licence to use the Software solely in conjunction with the Device on which it is installed or delivered. Ownership of the Software is not sold, transferred or otherwise conveyed. Do not use any means to discover the source code or any component of the Software, reproduce and distribute the Software, or modify the Software. You are entitled to transfer rights and obligations to the Software to a third party, solely together with the Device with which you received the Software, provided the third party agrees in writing to be bound by the terms of this Licence. This licence exists throughout the useful life of this Device. It can be terminated by transferring your rights to the Device to a third party in writing. June 27, 2012 15:00:07 Battery New or idle batteries can have short-term reduced capacity. Fully charge the battery before initial use. Use for the intended purpose only. Charge the battery in temperatures between +5°C(+41°F) and +45°C(+113°F). Do not put the battery into your mouth. Do not let the battery contacts touch another metal object. Turn off the product before removing the battery. Performance depends on temperatures, signal strength, usage patterns, features selected and voice or data transmissions. Only Sony service partners should remove or replace built-in batteries. Use of batteries that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Replace the battery only with another Sony battery that has been qualified with the product per the standard IEEE-1725. Use of an unqualified battery may present a risk of fire, explosion, leakage or other hazard. Children Warning! Keep out of the reach of children. Do not allow children to play with mobile phones or accessories. They could hurt themselves or others. Products may contain small parts that could become detached and create a choking hazard. Guidelines for Safe and Efficient Use Please follow these guidelines. Failure to do so might entail a potential health risk or product malfunction. If in doubt as to its proper function, have the product checked by a certified service partner before charging or using it. Use of location-based information by the device may not be uninterrupted or error free and may additionally be dependent on network service availability. Please note that functionality may be reduced or prevented in certain environments such as building interiors or areas adjacent to buildings. Caution: Do not use GPS functionality in a manner which causes distraction from driving. +45°C(+113°F). Do not expose the battery to temperatures above +60°C(+140°F). • Do not expose to flames or lit tobacco products. • Do not drop, throw or try to bend the product. • Do not paint or attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Only Sony authorised personnel should perform service. • Consult with authorised medical staff and the instructions of the medical device manufacturer before using the product near pacemakers or other medical devices or equipment. • Discontinue use of electronic devices, or disable the radio transmitting functionality of the device, where required or requested to do so. • Do not use where a potentially explosive atmosphere exists. • Do not place the product, or install wireless equipment, in the area above an air bag in a car. • Caution: Cracked or broken displays may create sharp edges or splinters that could be harmful upon contact. • Do not use the Bluetooth Headset in positions where it is uncomfortable or will be subject to pressure. worn on the body. For body-worn operation, the phone has been tested when positioned a minimum of 15 mm from the body without any metal parts in the vicinity of the phone or when properly used with an appropriate Sony accessory and worn on the body. When operating with “Hotspot” functionality engaged, a separation distance of 10mm was used. For more information about SAR and radio frequency exposure, go to: www.sonymobile.com/health. information call the Sony Special Needs Center on 877 878 1996 (TTY) or 877 207 2056 (voice), or go to www.sonyericsson-snc.com. Flight mode Bluetooth and WLAN functionality, if available in the device, can be enabled in Flight mode but may be prohibited onboard aircraft or in other areas where radio transmissions are prohibited. In such environments, please seek proper authorisation before enabling Bluetooth or WLAN functionality even in Flight mode. Malware Malware (short for malicious software) is software that can harm the mobile phone or other computers. Malware or harmful applications can include viruses, worms, spyware, and other unwanted programs. While the device does employ security measures to resist such efforts, Sony does not warrant or represent that the device will be impervious to the introduction of malware. You can however reduce the risk of malware attacks by using care when downloading content or accepting applications, refraining from opening or responding to messages from unknown sources, using trustworthy services to access the Internet, and only downloading content to the mobile phone from known, reliable sources. Accessories Use only Sony branded original accessories and certified service partners. Sony does not test third-party accessories. Accessories may influence RF exposure, radio performance, loudness, electric safety and other areas. Third-party accessories and parts may pose a risk to your health or safety or decrease performance. Disposal of old electrical and electronic equipment and battery This symbols on the electronic product or on its packaging indicates that the electronic product inclusive the battery should not be treated as household waste. Instead it should be handed over to the applicable collection point for the recycling of electrical and electronic equipment. Do not attempt to remove internal batteries. Internal batteries shall be removed only by a waste treatment facility or trained service professional. By ensuring this product is disposed of correctly, you will help prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health, which could otherwise be caused by inappropriate waste handling of this product. The recycling of materials will help to conserve natural resources. For more detailed information about recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, your household waste disposal service or the shop where you purchased the product, by calling a Sony Contact Center or at www.sonymobile .com/recycling. Memory card If the product comes complete with a removable memory card, it is generally compatible with the handset purchased but may not be compatible with other devices or the capabilities of their memory cards. Check other devices for compatibility before purchase or use. If the product is equipped with a memory card reader, check memory card compatibility before purchase or use. Memory cards are generally formatted prior to shipping. To reformat the memory card, use a compatible device. Do not use the standard operating system format when formatting the memory card on a PC. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the device or contact customer support. SIM card If your phone is equipped with a standard-sized SIM card slot, inserting an incompatible SIM card (for example, a micro SIM card, a micro SIM card with a non-Sony adapter, or a standard SIM card cut into a micro SIM card size) in the SIM card slot may damage Accessible Solutions/Special Needs In the US, compatible Sony Xperia phones may offer compatibility with TTY terminals (with use of necessary accessory). For more Failure to comply with any of these terms and conditions will terminate the licence immediately. Sony and its third party suppliers and licensors retain all rights, title and interest in and to the Software. To the extent that the Software contains material or code of a third party, such third parties shall be beneficiaries of these terms. This licence is governed by the laws of Sweden. When applicable, the foregoing applies to statutory consumer rights. In the event Software accompanying or provided in conjunction with your device is provided with additional terms and conditions, such provisions shall also govern your possession and usage of the Software. Export regulations Export regulations: Goods delivered under this Agreement may be the subject to import and export regulations of the European Union, the United States and other countries. Purchaser will comply with these applicable laws and regulations and will obtain and maintain any export and import license required for the delivery of goods to Purchaser under this Agreement. Without limiting the foregoing, and as an example, Purchaser will not knowingly export or reexport goods to destinations identified pursuant to Articles in Chapter II of European Council Regulation (EC) 428/2009 and specifically, and without limitation, Purchaser will also comply with U.S. government Export Administration Regulations (“EAR”, 15 C.F.R. §§ 730-774, http://www.bis.doc.gov/) administered by Department of Commerce, Bureau of Industry and Security and economic sanctions regulations (30 C.F.R. §§ 500 et. seq., http:// www.treas.gov/offices/enforcement/ofac/) administered by the U.S. Department of Treasury, Office of Foreign Assets Control. Limited Warranty Sony Mobile Communications AB, SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden, (Sony) or its local affiliated company, provides this Limited Warranty for your mobile phone, original accessory delivered with your mobile phone, and/or your mobile computing product (hereinafter referred to as “Product”). 10 Personal medical devices Mobile phones may affect implanted medical equipment. Reduce risk of interference by keeping a minimum distance of 15 cm(6 inches) between the phone and the device. Use the phone at your right ear. Do not carry the phone in your breast pocket. Turn off the phone if you suspect interference. For use in proximity to personal medical devices, please consult a physician and the device manufacturer. Driving Some vehicle manufacturers forbid the use of phones in their vehicles unless a handsfree kit with an external antenna supports the installation. Check with the vehicle manufacturer's representative to be sure that the mobile phone or Bluetooth handsfree will not affect the electronic systems in the vehicle. Full attention should be given to driving at all times and local laws and regulations restricting the use of wireless devices while driving must be observed. GPS/Location based functions Some products provide GPS/Location based functions. Location determining functionality is provided “As is” and “With all faults”. Sony does not make any representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such location information. your SIM card or your phone permanently. Sony does not warrant and will not be responsible for any damage caused by use of incompatible or modified SIM cards. For Devices Supporting 3D Viewing capabilities In viewing 3D images shot with this phone on a 3D-compatible monitor, you may experience discomfort in the form of eye strain, fatigue, or nausea. To prevent these symptoms, we recommend that you take regular breaks. However, you need to determine for yourself the length and frequency of breaks you require, as they vary according to the individual. If you experience any type of discomfort, stop viewing the 3D images until you feel better, and consult a physician as necessary. Also refer to the operating instructions supplied with the device or software you have connected or are using with this phone. Note that a child’s eyesight is still at the development stage (particularly children below the age of 6). Consult a pediatrician or ophthalmologist before letting your child view 3D images, and make sure he/she observes the above precautions when viewing such images. Warning! If the device requires an adapter for insertion into the handset or another device, do not insert the card directly without the required adapter. Precautions on memory card use • Do not expose the memory card to moisture. • Do not touch terminal connections with your hand or any metal object. • Do not strike, bend, or drop the memory card. • Do not attempt to disassemble or modify the memory card. • Do not use or store the memory card in humid or corrosive locations or in excessive heat such as a closed car in summer, in direct sunlight or near a heater, etc. • Do not press or bend the end of the memory card adapter with excessive force. • Do not let dirt, dust, or foreign objects get into the insert port of any memory card adapter. • Check you have inserted the memory card correctly. Should your Product need warranty service, please return it to the dealer from whom it was purchased, or contact your local Sony Contact Center (national rates may apply) or visit www.sonymobile.com to get further information. Our warranty Subject to the conditions of this Limited Warranty, Sony warrants this Product to be free from defects in design, material and workmanship at the time of its original purchase by a consumer. This Limited Warranty will last for a period of two (2) years as from the original date of purchase of the Product for your mobile phone, and for a period of one (1) year following the original purchase date of the Product for all original accessories (such as the battery, charger or handsfree kit) which may be delivered with your mobile phone. What we will do If, during the warranty period, this Product fails to operate under normal use and service, due to defects in design, materials or workmanship, Sony authorised distributors or service partners, in the country/region* where you purchased the Product, will, at their option, either repair or replace the Product in accordance with the terms and conditions stipulated herein. Sony and its service partners reserve the right to charge a handling fee if a returned Product is found not to be under warranty according to the conditions below. Please note that some of your personal settings, downloads and other information may be lost when your Sony Product is repaired or replaced. At present, Sony may be prevented by applicable law, other regulation or technical restrictions from making a backup copy of certain downloads. Sony does not take any responsibility for any lost information of any kind and will not reimburse you for any such loss. You should always make backup copies of all the information stored on your Sony Product such as downloads, calendar and contacts before handing in your Sony Product for repair or replacement. Conditions 1. This Limited Warranty is valid only if the original proof of purchase for this Product issued by a Sony authorised dealer specifying the 11 www.sonymobile.com Sony Mobile Communications AB SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden 1222-9269.9 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 2 of 2 2. 3. 4. 5. date of purchase and serial number**, is presented with the Product to be repaired or replaced. Sony reserves the right to refuse warranty service if this information has been removed or changed after the original purchase of the Product from the dealer. If Sony repairs or replaces the Product, the repair for the defect concerned, or the replaced Product shall be warranted for the remaining time of the original warranty period or for ninety (90) days from the date of repair, whichever is longer. Repair or replacement may involve the use of functionally equivalent reconditioned units. Replaced parts or components will become the property of Sony. This warranty does not cover any failure of the Product due to normal wear and tear, or due to misuse, including but not limited to use in other than the normal and customary manner, in accordance with the Sony instructions for use and maintenance of the Product. Nor does this warranty cover any failure of the Product due to accident, software or hardware modification or adjustment, acts of God or damage resulting from liquid. A rechargeable battery can be charged and discharged more than a hundred times. However, it will eventually wear out – this is not a defect and corresponds to normal wear and tear. When the talk-time or standby time is noticeably shorter, it is time to replace the battery. Sony recommends that you use only batteries and chargers approved by Sony. Minor variations in display brightness and colour may occur between phones. There may be tiny bright or dark dots on the display. It occurs when individual dots have malfunctioned and can not be adjusted. Two defective pixels are deemed acceptable. Minor variations in camera image appearance may occur between phones. This is nothing uncommon and is not regarded as a defective camera module. Since the cellular system on which the Product is to operate is provided by a carrier independent from Sony, Sony will not be responsible for the operation, availability, coverage, services or range of that system. This warranty does not cover Product failures caused by installations, modifications, or repair or opening of the Product performed by a non-Sony authorised person. 6. The warranty does not cover Product failures which have been caused by use of accessories or other peripheral devices which are not Sony branded original accessories intended for use with the Product. Sony disclaims any and all warranties, whether express or implied, for failures caused to the Product or peripheral devices as a result of viruses, trojan horses, spyware, or other malicious software. Sony strongly recommends that you install appropriate virus protection software on your Product and any peripheral devices connected to it, as available, and update it regularly, to better protect your device. It is understood, however, that such software will never fully protect your Product or its peripheral devices and Sony disclaims all warranties, whether express or implied, in case of failure by such antivirus software to fulfil its intended purpose. 7. Tampering with any of the seals on the Product will void the warranty. 8. THERE ARE NO EXPRESS WARRANTIES, WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL, OTHER THAN THIS PRINTED LIMITED WARRANTY. ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO EVENT SHALL SONY OR ITS LICENSORS BE LIABLE FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOST PROFITS OR COMMERCIAL LOSS TO THE FULL EXTENT THOSE DAMAGES CAN BE DISCLAIMED BY LAW. Some countries/states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, or limitation of the duration of implied warranties, so the preceding limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. The warranty provided does not affect the consumer’s statutory rights under applicable legislation in force, nor the consumer’s rights against the dealer arising from their sales / purchase contract. *Geographical scope of the warranty If you have purchased your Product in a country member of the European Economic Area (EEA) or in Switzerland or the Republic of Chile Colombia Costa Rica Danmark 800-646-425 (número gratuito) 01800-0966-080 (número gratuito) 0 800 011 0400 (número gratuito) 3331 2828 Deutschland 0180 534 2020 (ortsübliche Gebühren) 1-800-085-9518 Dominica (Toll Free) 1-800-0102-50 Ecuador (número gratuito) 06 032 032 Eesti Egypt/مصر 16727 Ελλάδα 801 11 810 810 +30 210 899 19 19 (από κινητό τηλέφωνο) El Salvador 800-6323 (número gratuito) 902 180 576 España (tarifa local) questions.CF@support.sonymobile.co 09 69 32 21 21 09 69 32 21 22 (Xperia™ uniquement) Guatemala 1-800-300-0057 (número gratuito) AN 193, PIN Haïti/Ayiti 5598 (numéro gratuit / nimewo gratis) AN 8000122, Honduras PIN 5599 (número gratuito) Hong Kong/ +852 8203 8863 香港 062 000 000 Hrvatska France questions.CZ@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.DK@support.sonymobile.co questions.DE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.EE@support.sonymobile.co questions.EG@support.sonymobile.co questions.GR@support.sonymobile.co India/भारत Indonesia Ireland Italia Jamaica questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.ES@support.sonymobile.co Κύπρος/ Kıbrıs 1800 11 1800 (Toll Free) +91 (011) 39011111 +62 21 2935 7669 1850 545 888 (Local rate) 06 48895206 (tariffa locale) 1-800-442-3471 (Toll Free) 0800 90 909 Latvija 67 21 43 01 Lietuva 8 700 55030 questions.FR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.HK@support.sonymobile.co questions.HR@support.sonymobile.co questions.IN@support.sonymobile.com 中国 台灣 +90 212 473 77 77 08705 237 237 (Local rate) questions.TR@support.sonymobile.co questions.GB@support.sonymobile.co United States 1 866 766 9374 questions.US@support.sonymobile.co Uruguay 000-401-787-01 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 3 (número gratuito) 0-800-1-00-2250 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m 1900 1525 (miễn questions.VN@support.sonymobile .co phí) 0800 1 8778 questions.BG@support.sonymobile.co 8-800-1008022 questions.RU@support.sonymobile.co +38 044 590 questions.UA@support.sonymobile.co 1515 +971 4 3919 880 questions.JO@support.sonymobile.co +971 4 3919 880 questions.AE@support.sonymobile.co (UAE) Türkiye United Kingdom Venezuela Việt Nam България Россия Україна الأردن الإمارات العربية المتحدة الكويت المملكة العربية السعودية ไทย +86 400 810 0000 +886 2 25625511 02 2483 030 June 27, 2012 15:00:08 Barbados Belgique/ België Belize Bermuda Bolivia Brasil Canada 0800-333-7427 (número gratuito) 1300 650-050 (Toll Free) 1-800-205-6062 (Toll Free) AN 815, PIN 5597 (Toll Free) 1-800-083-9518 (Toll Free) 800-100-542 (número gratuito) 4001-0444 (Capitais e regiões metropolitanas) 0800 884 0444 (Demais regiões) 1 866 766 9374 (Toll Free / sans frais) 1-800-084-9518 (Toll Free) +48 22 22 77 444 808 204 466 (chamada local) República 1-800-751-3370 Dominicana (número gratuito) România AN 1800-0166, PIN 5600 (número gratuito) 815 00 840 (lokaltakst) 0810 200 245 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 00800-787-0009 (número gratuito) 009 800 54 Paraguay 20032 (número gratuito) 0800-532-38 Perú (número gratuito) Philippines/ +632 479 9777 or 1800 1 853 Pilipinas 7669 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Nicaragua Panamá questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AU@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-082-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 02-0745 1611 questions.BE@support.sonymobile.co Polska 1 800-88-7666 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.BR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CA@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 15 0 1800 000 4722 questions.MX@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m questions.NL@support.sonymobile.co Nederland 0900 8998318 Nederlandse 001-866-509-86 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 60 (gratis Antillen nummer) 0800-100-150 questions.NZ@support.sonymobile.co New (Toll Free) Zealand questions.IT@support.sonymobile.com 21 questions.HU@support.sonymobile.co México Pakistan/ پاکستان questions.TW@support.sonymobile.co questions.TH@support.sonymobile.co The Bahamas questions.MY@support.sonymobile.co +212 2 2958 344 questions.MA@support.sonymobile.co Maroc/ المغرب questions.IE@support.sonymobile.com questions.CN@sonymobile.com Australia Portugal Österreich +971 4 3919 880 questions.KW@support.sonymobile.co 800-8200-727 questions.SA@support.sonymobile.co 20 Magyarorsz 01 880 47 47 ág questions.ID@support.sonymobile.com 17 Argentina 14 Norge questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CY@support.sonymobile.co questions.LV@support.sonymobile.co questions.LT@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-080-9518 (Toll Free) Antigua and 1-800-081-9518 (Toll Free) Barbuda Anguilla Cayman Islands Malaysia questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 16 Trinidad and 1-800-080-9521 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) Tobago Trademarks and acknowledgements The Liquid Identity logo and Xperia are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sony Mobile Communications AB. Sony is a trademark or a registered trademark of Sony Corporation. Ericsson is a trademark or registered trademark of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson. Bluetooth is a trademark or a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. and any use of such mark by Sony is under license. Other product and company names mentioned herein may be the trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. 13 12 Central and +27 11 506 0123 Southern Africa Česká 844 550 055 republika Turkey, and such Product was intended for sale in the EEA or in Switzerland or in Turkey, you can have your Product serviced in any EEA country or in Switzerland or in Turkey, under the warranty conditions prevailing in the country in which you require servicing, provided that an identical Product is sold in such country by an authorised Sony distributor. To find out if your Product is sold in the country you are in, please call the local Sony Contact Center. Please observe that certain services may not be available outside the country of original purchase, for example, due to the fact that your Product may have an interior or exterior which is different from equivalent models sold in other countries. Please note in addition that it may sometimes not be possible to repair SIM-locked Products. Our goods come with guarantees that cannot be excluded under the Australian Consumer Law. If you purchased your product in Australia, you are entitled to a replacement or refund for a major failure and compensation for any other reasonably foreseeable loss or damage. You are also entitled to have the goods repaired or replaced if the goods fail to be of acceptable quality and the failure does not amount to a major failure. For warranty service in Australia, please contact 1300 650 050 or Sony Service Centre, 320 Princes Hwy, ROCKDALE NSW 2216. ** In some countries/regions additional information (such as a valid warranty card) may be requested. Saint Kitts and Nevis questions.PL@support.sonymobile.co questions.PT@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co +40 21 401 0401 questions.RO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-087-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 1-800-088-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Saint Vincent and (Toll Free) the Grenadines questions.NO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AT@support.sonymobile.co 021 - 111 22 55 questions.PK@support.sonymobile.co 73 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.PH@support.sonymobile.co Schweiz/ Suisse/ Svizzera 0848 824 040 questions.CH@support.sonymobile .co Singapore +65 6744 0733 Slovenia 0800 81291 questions.SG@support.sonymobile.co questions.si@support.sonymobile.com Slovensko 02 5443 6443 questions.SK@support.sonymobile.co questions.ZA@support.sonymobile.co South Africa 0861 632222 South (+82) 1588 4170 questions.KO@support.sonymobile.co Κorea/대한 민국 09 299 2000 questions.FI@support.sonymobile.com Suomi Sverige 013 24 45 00 (lokal taxa) 001 800 852 7663 or 02401 3030 Thailand 18 questions.SE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 19 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 1 of 2 Sony Consumer Web site At www.sonymobile.com/support there is a support section where help and tips are only a few clicks away. Here you will find the latest computer software updates and tips on how to use your product more efficiently. Important information Service and support You have access to a portfolio of exclusive service advantages such as: • Global and local Web sites providing support. • A global network of Contact Centers. • An extensive network of Sony service partners. • A warranty period. Learn more about the warranty conditions in theLimited warrantysection. At www.sonymobile.com/support, you can find the latest support tools and information. For operator-specific services and features, please contact your network operator. You can also contact our Contact Centers. If your country/region is not represented in the list below, please contact your local dealer. (Calls are charged according to national rates, including local taxes, unless the phone number is a toll-free number.) If your product needs service, please contact the dealer from whom it was purchased, or one of our service partners. For warranty claims, save proof of purchase. Power supply (Charger) Connect the charger to power sources as marked on the product. Do not use outdoors or in damp areas. Do not alter or subject the cord to damage or stress. Unplug the unit before cleaning it. Never alter the plug. If it does not fit into the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by an electrician. When a power supply is connected there is a small drain of power. To avoid this small energy waste, disconnect the power supply when the product is fully charged. Use of charging devices that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Recommendations for care and safe use of our products • Handle with care and keep in a clean and dust-free place. • Warning! May explode if disposed of in fire. • Do not expose to liquid or moisture or excess humidity. • For optimum performance, the product should not be operated in temperatures below -10°C(+14°F) or above Emergency calls Calls cannot be guaranteed under all conditions. Never rely solely upon mobile phones for essential communication. Calls may not be possible in all areas, on all networks, or when certain network services and/or phone features are used. Antenna Use of antenna devices not marketed by Sony could damage the phone, reduce performance, and produce SAR levels above the established limits. Do not cover the antenna with your hand as this affects call quality, power levels and can shorten talk and standby times. Radio Frequency (RF) exposure and Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) When the phone or Bluetooth handsfree is turned on, it emits low levels of radio frequency energy. International safety guidelines have been developed through periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies. These guidelines establish permitted levels of radio wave exposure. The guidelines include a safety margin designed to assure the safety of all persons and to account for any variations in measurements. Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) is used to measure radio frequency energy absorbed by the body when using a mobile phone. The SAR value is determined at the highest certified power level in laboratory conditions, but because the phone is designed to use the minimum power necessary to access the chosen network, the actual SAR level can be well below this value. There is no proof of difference in safety based on difference in SAR value. Products with radio transmitters sold in the US must be certified by the Federal Communications Commission (FCC). When required, tests are performed when the phone is placed at the ear and when • Insert the memory card as far as it will go into any memory card adapter needed. The memory card may not operate properly unless fully inserted. • We recommend that you make a backup copy of important data. We are not responsible for any loss or damage to content you store on the memory card. • Recorded data may be damaged or lost when you remove the memory card or memory card adapter, turn off the power while formatting, reading or writing data, or use the memory card in locations subject to static electricity or high electrical field emissions. Protection of personal information Erase personal data before disposing of the product. To delete data, perform a master reset. Deleting data from the phone memory does not ensure that it cannot be recovered. Sony does not warrant against recovery of information and does not assume responsibility for disclosure of any information even after a master reset. Loudness warning! Avoid volume levels that may be harmful to your hearing. End User Licence Agreement Software delivered with this device and its media is owned by Sony Mobile Communications AB, and/or its affiliated companies and its suppliers and licensors. Sony grants you a non-exclusive limited licence to use the Software solely in conjunction with the Device on which it is installed or delivered. Ownership of the Software is not sold, transferred or otherwise conveyed. Do not use any means to discover the source code or any component of the Software, reproduce and distribute the Software, or modify the Software. You are entitled to transfer rights and obligations to the Software to a third party, solely together with the Device with which you received the Software, provided the third party agrees in writing to be bound by the terms of this Licence. This licence exists throughout the useful life of this Device. It can be terminated by transferring your rights to the Device to a third party in writing. June 27, 2012 15:00:07 Battery New or idle batteries can have short-term reduced capacity. Fully charge the battery before initial use. Use for the intended purpose only. Charge the battery in temperatures between +5°C(+41°F) and +45°C(+113°F). Do not put the battery into your mouth. Do not let the battery contacts touch another metal object. Turn off the product before removing the battery. Performance depends on temperatures, signal strength, usage patterns, features selected and voice or data transmissions. Only Sony service partners should remove or replace built-in batteries. Use of batteries that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Replace the battery only with another Sony battery that has been qualified with the product per the standard IEEE-1725. Use of an unqualified battery may present a risk of fire, explosion, leakage or other hazard. Children Warning! Keep out of the reach of children. Do not allow children to play with mobile phones or accessories. They could hurt themselves or others. Products may contain small parts that could become detached and create a choking hazard. Guidelines for Safe and Efficient Use Please follow these guidelines. Failure to do so might entail a potential health risk or product malfunction. If in doubt as to its proper function, have the product checked by a certified service partner before charging or using it. Use of location-based information by the device may not be uninterrupted or error free and may additionally be dependent on network service availability. Please note that functionality may be reduced or prevented in certain environments such as building interiors or areas adjacent to buildings. Caution: Do not use GPS functionality in a manner which causes distraction from driving. +45°C(+113°F). Do not expose the battery to temperatures above +60°C(+140°F). • Do not expose to flames or lit tobacco products. • Do not drop, throw or try to bend the product. • Do not paint or attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Only Sony authorised personnel should perform service. • Consult with authorised medical staff and the instructions of the medical device manufacturer before using the product near pacemakers or other medical devices or equipment. • Discontinue use of electronic devices, or disable the radio transmitting functionality of the device, where required or requested to do so. • Do not use where a potentially explosive atmosphere exists. • Do not place the product, or install wireless equipment, in the area above an air bag in a car. • Caution: Cracked or broken displays may create sharp edges or splinters that could be harmful upon contact. • Do not use the Bluetooth Headset in positions where it is uncomfortable or will be subject to pressure. worn on the body. For body-worn operation, the phone has been tested when positioned a minimum of 15 mm from the body without any metal parts in the vicinity of the phone or when properly used with an appropriate Sony accessory and worn on the body. When operating with “Hotspot” functionality engaged, a separation distance of 10mm was used. For more information about SAR and radio frequency exposure, go to: www.sonymobile.com/health. information call the Sony Special Needs Center on 877 878 1996 (TTY) or 877 207 2056 (voice), or go to www.sonyericsson-snc.com. Flight mode Bluetooth and WLAN functionality, if available in the device, can be enabled in Flight mode but may be prohibited onboard aircraft or in other areas where radio transmissions are prohibited. In such environments, please seek proper authorisation before enabling Bluetooth or WLAN functionality even in Flight mode. Malware Malware (short for malicious software) is software that can harm the mobile phone or other computers. Malware or harmful applications can include viruses, worms, spyware, and other unwanted programs. While the device does employ security measures to resist such efforts, Sony does not warrant or represent that the device will be impervious to the introduction of malware. You can however reduce the risk of malware attacks by using care when downloading content or accepting applications, refraining from opening or responding to messages from unknown sources, using trustworthy services to access the Internet, and only downloading content to the mobile phone from known, reliable sources. Accessories Use only Sony branded original accessories and certified service partners. Sony does not test third-party accessories. Accessories may influence RF exposure, radio performance, loudness, electric safety and other areas. Third-party accessories and parts may pose a risk to your health or safety or decrease performance. Disposal of old electrical and electronic equipment and battery This symbols on the electronic product or on its packaging indicates that the electronic product inclusive the battery should not be treated as household waste. Instead it should be handed over to the applicable collection point for the recycling of electrical and electronic equipment. Do not attempt to remove internal batteries. Internal batteries shall be removed only by a waste treatment facility or trained service professional. By ensuring this product is disposed of correctly, you will help prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health, which could otherwise be caused by inappropriate waste handling of this product. The recycling of materials will help to conserve natural resources. For more detailed information about recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, your household waste disposal service or the shop where you purchased the product, by calling a Sony Contact Center or at www.sonymobile .com/recycling. Memory card If the product comes complete with a removable memory card, it is generally compatible with the handset purchased but may not be compatible with other devices or the capabilities of their memory cards. Check other devices for compatibility before purchase or use. If the product is equipped with a memory card reader, check memory card compatibility before purchase or use. Memory cards are generally formatted prior to shipping. To reformat the memory card, use a compatible device. Do not use the standard operating system format when formatting the memory card on a PC. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the device or contact customer support. SIM card If your phone is equipped with a standard-sized SIM card slot, inserting an incompatible SIM card (for example, a micro SIM card, a micro SIM card with a non-Sony adapter, or a standard SIM card cut into a micro SIM card size) in the SIM card slot may damage Accessible Solutions/Special Needs In the US, compatible Sony Xperia phones may offer compatibility with TTY terminals (with use of necessary accessory). For more Failure to comply with any of these terms and conditions will terminate the licence immediately. Sony and its third party suppliers and licensors retain all rights, title and interest in and to the Software. To the extent that the Software contains material or code of a third party, such third parties shall be beneficiaries of these terms. This licence is governed by the laws of Sweden. When applicable, the foregoing applies to statutory consumer rights. In the event Software accompanying or provided in conjunction with your device is provided with additional terms and conditions, such provisions shall also govern your possession and usage of the Software. Export regulations Export regulations: Goods delivered under this Agreement may be the subject to import and export regulations of the European Union, the United States and other countries. Purchaser will comply with these applicable laws and regulations and will obtain and maintain any export and import license required for the delivery of goods to Purchaser under this Agreement. Without limiting the foregoing, and as an example, Purchaser will not knowingly export or reexport goods to destinations identified pursuant to Articles in Chapter II of European Council Regulation (EC) 428/2009 and specifically, and without limitation, Purchaser will also comply with U.S. government Export Administration Regulations (“EAR”, 15 C.F.R. §§ 730-774, http://www.bis.doc.gov/) administered by Department of Commerce, Bureau of Industry and Security and economic sanctions regulations (30 C.F.R. §§ 500 et. seq., http:// www.treas.gov/offices/enforcement/ofac/) administered by the U.S. Department of Treasury, Office of Foreign Assets Control. Limited Warranty Sony Mobile Communications AB, SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden, (Sony) or its local affiliated company, provides this Limited Warranty for your mobile phone, original accessory delivered with your mobile phone, and/or your mobile computing product (hereinafter referred to as “Product”). 10 Personal medical devices Mobile phones may affect implanted medical equipment. Reduce risk of interference by keeping a minimum distance of 15 cm(6 inches) between the phone and the device. Use the phone at your right ear. Do not carry the phone in your breast pocket. Turn off the phone if you suspect interference. For use in proximity to personal medical devices, please consult a physician and the device manufacturer. Driving Some vehicle manufacturers forbid the use of phones in their vehicles unless a handsfree kit with an external antenna supports the installation. Check with the vehicle manufacturer's representative to be sure that the mobile phone or Bluetooth handsfree will not affect the electronic systems in the vehicle. Full attention should be given to driving at all times and local laws and regulations restricting the use of wireless devices while driving must be observed. GPS/Location based functions Some products provide GPS/Location based functions. Location determining functionality is provided “As is” and “With all faults”. Sony does not make any representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such location information. your SIM card or your phone permanently. Sony does not warrant and will not be responsible for any damage caused by use of incompatible or modified SIM cards. For Devices Supporting 3D Viewing capabilities In viewing 3D images shot with this phone on a 3D-compatible monitor, you may experience discomfort in the form of eye strain, fatigue, or nausea. To prevent these symptoms, we recommend that you take regular breaks. However, you need to determine for yourself the length and frequency of breaks you require, as they vary according to the individual. If you experience any type of discomfort, stop viewing the 3D images until you feel better, and consult a physician as necessary. Also refer to the operating instructions supplied with the device or software you have connected or are using with this phone. Note that a child’s eyesight is still at the development stage (particularly children below the age of 6). Consult a pediatrician or ophthalmologist before letting your child view 3D images, and make sure he/she observes the above precautions when viewing such images. Warning! If the device requires an adapter for insertion into the handset or another device, do not insert the card directly without the required adapter. Precautions on memory card use • Do not expose the memory card to moisture. • Do not touch terminal connections with your hand or any metal object. • Do not strike, bend, or drop the memory card. • Do not attempt to disassemble or modify the memory card. • Do not use or store the memory card in humid or corrosive locations or in excessive heat such as a closed car in summer, in direct sunlight or near a heater, etc. • Do not press or bend the end of the memory card adapter with excessive force. • Do not let dirt, dust, or foreign objects get into the insert port of any memory card adapter. • Check you have inserted the memory card correctly. Should your Product need warranty service, please return it to the dealer from whom it was purchased, or contact your local Sony Contact Center (national rates may apply) or visit www.sonymobile.com to get further information. Our warranty Subject to the conditions of this Limited Warranty, Sony warrants this Product to be free from defects in design, material and workmanship at the time of its original purchase by a consumer. This Limited Warranty will last for a period of two (2) years as from the original date of purchase of the Product for your mobile phone, and for a period of one (1) year following the original purchase date of the Product for all original accessories (such as the battery, charger or handsfree kit) which may be delivered with your mobile phone. What we will do If, during the warranty period, this Product fails to operate under normal use and service, due to defects in design, materials or workmanship, Sony authorised distributors or service partners, in the country/region* where you purchased the Product, will, at their option, either repair or replace the Product in accordance with the terms and conditions stipulated herein. Sony and its service partners reserve the right to charge a handling fee if a returned Product is found not to be under warranty according to the conditions below. Please note that some of your personal settings, downloads and other information may be lost when your Sony Product is repaired or replaced. At present, Sony may be prevented by applicable law, other regulation or technical restrictions from making a backup copy of certain downloads. Sony does not take any responsibility for any lost information of any kind and will not reimburse you for any such loss. You should always make backup copies of all the information stored on your Sony Product such as downloads, calendar and contacts before handing in your Sony Product for repair or replacement. Conditions 1. This Limited Warranty is valid only if the original proof of purchase for this Product issued by a Sony authorised dealer specifying the 11 www.sonymobile.com Sony Mobile Communications AB SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden 1222-9269.9 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 2 of 2 2. 3. 4. 5. date of purchase and serial number**, is presented with the Product to be repaired or replaced. Sony reserves the right to refuse warranty service if this information has been removed or changed after the original purchase of the Product from the dealer. If Sony repairs or replaces the Product, the repair for the defect concerned, or the replaced Product shall be warranted for the remaining time of the original warranty period or for ninety (90) days from the date of repair, whichever is longer. Repair or replacement may involve the use of functionally equivalent reconditioned units. Replaced parts or components will become the property of Sony. This warranty does not cover any failure of the Product due to normal wear and tear, or due to misuse, including but not limited to use in other than the normal and customary manner, in accordance with the Sony instructions for use and maintenance of the Product. Nor does this warranty cover any failure of the Product due to accident, software or hardware modification or adjustment, acts of God or damage resulting from liquid. A rechargeable battery can be charged and discharged more than a hundred times. However, it will eventually wear out – this is not a defect and corresponds to normal wear and tear. When the talk-time or standby time is noticeably shorter, it is time to replace the battery. Sony recommends that you use only batteries and chargers approved by Sony. Minor variations in display brightness and colour may occur between phones. There may be tiny bright or dark dots on the display. It occurs when individual dots have malfunctioned and can not be adjusted. Two defective pixels are deemed acceptable. Minor variations in camera image appearance may occur between phones. This is nothing uncommon and is not regarded as a defective camera module. Since the cellular system on which the Product is to operate is provided by a carrier independent from Sony, Sony will not be responsible for the operation, availability, coverage, services or range of that system. This warranty does not cover Product failures caused by installations, modifications, or repair or opening of the Product performed by a non-Sony authorised person. 6. The warranty does not cover Product failures which have been caused by use of accessories or other peripheral devices which are not Sony branded original accessories intended for use with the Product. Sony disclaims any and all warranties, whether express or implied, for failures caused to the Product or peripheral devices as a result of viruses, trojan horses, spyware, or other malicious software. Sony strongly recommends that you install appropriate virus protection software on your Product and any peripheral devices connected to it, as available, and update it regularly, to better protect your device. It is understood, however, that such software will never fully protect your Product or its peripheral devices and Sony disclaims all warranties, whether express or implied, in case of failure by such antivirus software to fulfil its intended purpose. 7. Tampering with any of the seals on the Product will void the warranty. 8. THERE ARE NO EXPRESS WARRANTIES, WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL, OTHER THAN THIS PRINTED LIMITED WARRANTY. ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO EVENT SHALL SONY OR ITS LICENSORS BE LIABLE FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOST PROFITS OR COMMERCIAL LOSS TO THE FULL EXTENT THOSE DAMAGES CAN BE DISCLAIMED BY LAW. Some countries/states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, or limitation of the duration of implied warranties, so the preceding limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. The warranty provided does not affect the consumer’s statutory rights under applicable legislation in force, nor the consumer’s rights against the dealer arising from their sales / purchase contract. *Geographical scope of the warranty If you have purchased your Product in a country member of the European Economic Area (EEA) or in Switzerland or the Republic of Chile Colombia Costa Rica Danmark 800-646-425 (número gratuito) 01800-0966-080 (número gratuito) 0 800 011 0400 (número gratuito) 3331 2828 Deutschland 0180 534 2020 (ortsübliche Gebühren) 1-800-085-9518 Dominica (Toll Free) 1-800-0102-50 Ecuador (número gratuito) 06 032 032 Eesti Egypt/مصر 16727 Ελλάδα 801 11 810 810 +30 210 899 19 19 (από κινητό τηλέφωνο) El Salvador 800-6323 (número gratuito) 902 180 576 España (tarifa local) questions.CF@support.sonymobile.co 09 69 32 21 21 09 69 32 21 22 (Xperia™ uniquement) Guatemala 1-800-300-0057 (número gratuito) AN 193, PIN Haïti/Ayiti 5598 (numéro gratuit / nimewo gratis) AN 8000122, Honduras PIN 5599 (número gratuito) Hong Kong/ +852 8203 8863 香港 062 000 000 Hrvatska France questions.CZ@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.DK@support.sonymobile.co questions.DE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.EE@support.sonymobile.co questions.EG@support.sonymobile.co questions.GR@support.sonymobile.co India/भारत Indonesia Ireland Italia Jamaica questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.ES@support.sonymobile.co Κύπρος/ Kıbrıs 1800 11 1800 (Toll Free) +91 (011) 39011111 +62 21 2935 7669 1850 545 888 (Local rate) 06 48895206 (tariffa locale) 1-800-442-3471 (Toll Free) 0800 90 909 Latvija 67 21 43 01 Lietuva 8 700 55030 questions.FR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.HK@support.sonymobile.co questions.HR@support.sonymobile.co questions.IN@support.sonymobile.com 中国 台灣 +90 212 473 77 77 08705 237 237 (Local rate) questions.TR@support.sonymobile.co questions.GB@support.sonymobile.co United States 1 866 766 9374 questions.US@support.sonymobile.co Uruguay 000-401-787-01 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 3 (número gratuito) 0-800-1-00-2250 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m 1900 1525 (miễn questions.VN@support.sonymobile .co phí) 0800 1 8778 questions.BG@support.sonymobile.co 8-800-1008022 questions.RU@support.sonymobile.co +38 044 590 questions.UA@support.sonymobile.co 1515 +971 4 3919 880 questions.JO@support.sonymobile.co +971 4 3919 880 questions.AE@support.sonymobile.co (UAE) Türkiye United Kingdom Venezuela Việt Nam България Россия Україна الأردن الإمارات العربية المتحدة الكويت المملكة العربية السعودية ไทย +86 400 810 0000 +886 2 25625511 02 2483 030 June 27, 2012 15:00:08 Barbados Belgique/ België Belize Bermuda Bolivia Brasil Canada 0800-333-7427 (número gratuito) 1300 650-050 (Toll Free) 1-800-205-6062 (Toll Free) AN 815, PIN 5597 (Toll Free) 1-800-083-9518 (Toll Free) 800-100-542 (número gratuito) 4001-0444 (Capitais e regiões metropolitanas) 0800 884 0444 (Demais regiões) 1 866 766 9374 (Toll Free / sans frais) 1-800-084-9518 (Toll Free) +48 22 22 77 444 808 204 466 (chamada local) República 1-800-751-3370 Dominicana (número gratuito) România AN 1800-0166, PIN 5600 (número gratuito) 815 00 840 (lokaltakst) 0810 200 245 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 00800-787-0009 (número gratuito) 009 800 54 Paraguay 20032 (número gratuito) 0800-532-38 Perú (número gratuito) Philippines/ +632 479 9777 or 1800 1 853 Pilipinas 7669 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Nicaragua Panamá questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AU@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-082-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 02-0745 1611 questions.BE@support.sonymobile.co Polska 1 800-88-7666 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.BR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CA@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 15 0 1800 000 4722 questions.MX@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m questions.NL@support.sonymobile.co Nederland 0900 8998318 Nederlandse 001-866-509-86 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 60 (gratis Antillen nummer) 0800-100-150 questions.NZ@support.sonymobile.co New (Toll Free) Zealand questions.IT@support.sonymobile.com 21 questions.HU@support.sonymobile.co México Pakistan/ پاکستان questions.TW@support.sonymobile.co questions.TH@support.sonymobile.co The Bahamas questions.MY@support.sonymobile.co +212 2 2958 344 questions.MA@support.sonymobile.co Maroc/ المغرب questions.IE@support.sonymobile.com questions.CN@sonymobile.com Australia Portugal Österreich +971 4 3919 880 questions.KW@support.sonymobile.co 800-8200-727 questions.SA@support.sonymobile.co 20 Magyarorsz 01 880 47 47 ág questions.ID@support.sonymobile.com 17 Argentina 14 Norge questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CY@support.sonymobile.co questions.LV@support.sonymobile.co questions.LT@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-080-9518 (Toll Free) Antigua and 1-800-081-9518 (Toll Free) Barbuda Anguilla Cayman Islands Malaysia questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 16 Trinidad and 1-800-080-9521 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) Tobago Trademarks and acknowledgements The Liquid Identity logo and Xperia are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sony Mobile Communications AB. Sony is a trademark or a registered trademark of Sony Corporation. Ericsson is a trademark or registered trademark of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson. Bluetooth is a trademark or a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. and any use of such mark by Sony is under license. Other product and company names mentioned herein may be the trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. 13 12 Central and +27 11 506 0123 Southern Africa Česká 844 550 055 republika Turkey, and such Product was intended for sale in the EEA or in Switzerland or in Turkey, you can have your Product serviced in any EEA country or in Switzerland or in Turkey, under the warranty conditions prevailing in the country in which you require servicing, provided that an identical Product is sold in such country by an authorised Sony distributor. To find out if your Product is sold in the country you are in, please call the local Sony Contact Center. Please observe that certain services may not be available outside the country of original purchase, for example, due to the fact that your Product may have an interior or exterior which is different from equivalent models sold in other countries. Please note in addition that it may sometimes not be possible to repair SIM-locked Products. Our goods come with guarantees that cannot be excluded under the Australian Consumer Law. If you purchased your product in Australia, you are entitled to a replacement or refund for a major failure and compensation for any other reasonably foreseeable loss or damage. You are also entitled to have the goods repaired or replaced if the goods fail to be of acceptable quality and the failure does not amount to a major failure. For warranty service in Australia, please contact 1300 650 050 or Sony Service Centre, 320 Princes Hwy, ROCKDALE NSW 2216. ** In some countries/regions additional information (such as a valid warranty card) may be requested. Saint Kitts and Nevis questions.PL@support.sonymobile.co questions.PT@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co +40 21 401 0401 questions.RO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-087-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 1-800-088-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Saint Vincent and (Toll Free) the Grenadines questions.NO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AT@support.sonymobile.co 021 - 111 22 55 questions.PK@support.sonymobile.co 73 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.PH@support.sonymobile.co Schweiz/ Suisse/ Svizzera 0848 824 040 questions.CH@support.sonymobile .co Singapore +65 6744 0733 Slovenia 0800 81291 questions.SG@support.sonymobile.co questions.si@support.sonymobile.com Slovensko 02 5443 6443 questions.SK@support.sonymobile.co questions.ZA@support.sonymobile.co South Africa 0861 632222 South (+82) 1588 4170 questions.KO@support.sonymobile.co Κorea/대한 민국 09 299 2000 questions.FI@support.sonymobile.com Suomi Sverige 013 24 45 00 (lokal taxa) 001 800 852 7663 or 02401 3030 Thailand 18 questions.SE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 19
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : No Page Mode : UseOutlines XMP Toolkit : 3.1-702 Format : application/pdf Creator : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB Title : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB Create Date : 2013:05:13 08:43+01:00 Creator Tool : AH Formatter V5.3 MR1 (5,3,2011,0610) for Windows Modify Date : 2013:06:03 01:01:12-07:00 Metadata Date : 2013:06:03 01:01:12-07:00 GTS PDFX Conformance : PDF/X-1a:2001 GTS PDFX Version : PDF/X-1:2001 Version ID : 1 Document ID : uuid:52f1405d-2e6f-4a0a-9b5d-97413963beab Instance ID : uuid:b74881c5-2aa4-4c02-9ead-d092f79fdd0f Producer : Antenna House PDF Output Library 2.6.0 (Windows) Trapped : False Page Count : 138 Author : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications ABEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools
user guide - all parts
User guide Xperia™ ZR C5503/C5502 Contents Xperia™ ZR User guide..................................................................6 Getting started...............................................................................7 Android™ – what and why?...............................................................7 Device overview.................................................................................7 Assembly...........................................................................................8 Turning the device on and off .........................................................10 Screen lock......................................................................................10 Setup guide......................................................................................10 Accounts and services.....................................................................11 Getting to know your device........................................................12 Using the keys.................................................................................12 Battery..............................................................................................12 Using the touchscreen.....................................................................15 Using the lockscreen.......................................................................17 Home screen....................................................................................18 Accessing and using applications...................................................20 Status and notifications...................................................................23 Settings menu..................................................................................24 Typing text.......................................................................................25 Customising your device.................................................................29 Enhancing the sound output............................................................32 Memory............................................................................................32 Using a headset ..............................................................................33 Internet and messaging settings......................................................33 Controlling data usage.....................................................................34 Mobile network settings...................................................................35 Google Play™..............................................................................37 Getting started with Google Play™.................................................37 Downloading from Google Play™....................................................37 Clearing your application data.........................................................37 Permissions......................................................................................38 Installing applications not from Google Play™ ...............................38 Calling..........................................................................................39 Emergency calls...............................................................................39 Call handling....................................................................................39 Voicemail..........................................................................................41 Multiple calls....................................................................................41 Conference calls..............................................................................41 Call settings.....................................................................................42 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts ......................................................................................44 About Contacts................................................................................44 Transferring contacts to your new device.......................................44 Contacts screen overview...............................................................46 Managing your contacts..................................................................46 Communicating with your contacts.................................................48 Sharing your contacts......................................................................48 Backing up contacts........................................................................49 Messaging....................................................................................50 Using text and multimedia messaging.............................................50 Text and multimedia message options............................................51 Google Talk™ .................................................................................52 Email.............................................................................................53 Getting started with Email................................................................53 Using email......................................................................................54 Socialife™....................................................................................57 Using the Socialife™ application.....................................................57 "WALKMAN" application .............................................................58 About the "WALKMAN" application.................................................58 Transferring media files to your device ...........................................58 Using the "WALKMAN" application ................................................59 Visualiser .........................................................................................60 Getting more information about a track or artist.............................60 Using My music to organise your tracks ........................................60 Managing playlists...........................................................................62 "WALKMAN" application widget ....................................................63 Protecting your hearing....................................................................63 Music services..............................................................................64 TrackID™ technology......................................................................64 Music Unlimited™............................................................................65 About the PlayNow™ service..........................................................65 FM radio.......................................................................................67 About the FM radio..........................................................................67 Using your favourite radio channels................................................68 Sound settings.................................................................................68 Identifying radio tracks using TrackID™..........................................68 Camera.........................................................................................70 About the camera............................................................................70 Using the still camera......................................................................70 Face detection.................................................................................71 Using Smile Shutter™ to capture smiling faces..............................71 Adding the geographical position to your photos...........................72 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using still camera settings...............................................................72 Using the video camera...................................................................76 Album...........................................................................................81 About Album....................................................................................81 Mobile BRAVIA® Engine..................................................................81 Viewing photos and videos in the Pictures tab ...............................81 Viewing photos and videos in the My albums tab ..........................82 Viewing your photos on a map........................................................86 Viewing online albums.....................................................................87 Movies..........................................................................................89 About Movies...................................................................................89 Using Movies...................................................................................89 Video Unlimited™........................................................................91 About Video Unlimited™..................................................................91 Renting or buying a video................................................................91 Watching a video from Video Unlimited™.......................................92 Web browser................................................................................93 About the web browser....................................................................93 Connectivity.................................................................................94 Connecting to wireless networks.....................................................94 Sharing content with DLNA Certified™ devices..............................97 NFC..................................................................................................99 Bluetooth™ wireless technology...................................................102 Connecting your device to a computer.........................................104 Connecting your device to a TV set...............................................106 Screen mirroring............................................................................107 Scanning barcodes with the NeoReader™ application.................107 Smart Connect...............................................................................108 Synchronising data on your device............................................110 About synchronising data on your device.....................................110 Synchronising with Google™........................................................110 Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts........110 Synchronising with Facebook™....................................................111 Maps and locations....................................................................113 About location services..................................................................113 Using GPS.....................................................................................113 Google Maps™..............................................................................114 Using Google Maps™ to get directions.........................................114 Calendar and alarm clock..........................................................115 Calendar.........................................................................................115 Alarm clock....................................................................................115 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Support and maintenance..........................................................118 Updating your device.....................................................................118 Backup and restore application.....................................................119 Resetting your device....................................................................120 Locking and protecting your device..............................................121 Support application.......................................................................123 Recycling your device....................................................................123 Reference...................................................................................124 Settings overview...........................................................................124 Status and notification icons overview..........................................125 Application overview......................................................................126 Important information.................................................................128 Important information leaflet..........................................................128 Limitations to services and features..............................................128 Protecting your device from water and dust.................................128 Legal information...........................................................................130 Index...........................................................................................131 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Xperia™ ZR User guide This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Getting started Android™ – what and why? Your Xperia™ from Sony runs on the Android platform. Android devices can perform many of the same functions as a computer and you can customise them to your own needs. For example, you can add and delete applications, or enhance existing applications to improve functionality. On Google Play™ you can download a range of applications and games from a constantly growing collection. You can also integrate applications on your Android™ device with other applications and with online services that you use. For example, you can back up your contacts, access your different email accounts and calendars from one place, keep track of your appointments, and engage in social networking. Android™ devices are constantly evolving. When a new software version is available and your device supports this new software, you can update your device to get new features and the latest improvements. Your Android™ device is pre-loaded with Google™ services. To get the most out of the provided Google™ services, you should have a Google™ account and sign in to it when you first start your device. You also need to have Internet access to use many of the features in Android™. New software releases may not be compatible with all devices. Device overview Front camera lens Ear speaker Headset jack Light sensor Power key This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 6 Volume/Zoom key Camera key Strap hole Microphone 10 Notification light 11 Camera lens 12 Camera light 13 Port for charger/USB cable 14 Connector for charging dock 15 Speaker Assembly To remove the back cover • Insert a thumbnail into the gap between the back cover and the bottom side of your device, then lift up the cover. This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To insert the micro SIM card Remove the battery cover and the battery, then pull out the micro SIM card holder. Place the micro SIM card into the micro SIM card holder, with the goldcoloured contacts facing down. Push the micro SIM card and the holder back into the phone. To insert a memory card Remove the back cover and the battery. Insert the memory card into the memory card slot, with the gold-coloured contacts facing down. The memory card may not be included at purchase in all markets. To attach the back cover Place the back cover over the back of the device, then press down on the top corners to lock them into place. Moving from top to bottom, press down the sides of the cover. The clips on the inside of the cover make clicking noises as they lock into place. This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Turning the device on and off To turn on the device Press and hold down the power key until the device vibrates. If your screen goes dark, briefly press the power key to activate the screen. To unlock the screen, drag up or drag down. Enter your SIM card PIN when requested, then select OK. Wait a while for the device to start. Your SIM card PIN is initially supplied by your network operator, but you can change it later from the Settings menu. To correct a mistake made while entering your SIM card PIN, tap To turn off the device Press and hold down the power key In the options menu, tap Power off. Tap OK. until the options menu opens. It may take a while for the device to shut down. Screen lock When your device is on and left idle for a set period of time, the screen darkens to save battery power, and locks automatically. This lock prevents unwanted actions on the touchscreen when you are not using it. On the lockscreen, you can still take photos and play audio tracks. • To activate the screen Briefly press the power key To unlock the screen • Drag • To lock the screen manually When the screen is active, briefly press the power key up or drag down. Setup guide The first time you start your device, a setup guide opens to explain basic functions and help you enter essential settings. This is a good time to configure the device to 10 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. your specific needs. You can also access the setup guide later from the settings menu. To access the setup guide manually From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Setup guide. Accounts and services Sign in to your online service accounts from your device to get easy access when you're on the move. For example, you can integrate contacts from your Google™ account into your phonebook, so you have everything in one place. You can sign up to new online services from your device as well as from a computer. Google™ account Having a Google™ account is key to using a range of applications and services with your Android device. You need a Google™ account, for example, to use the Gmail™ application in your device, to chat with friends using Google Talk™, and to synchronise the calendar application on your device with your Google Calendar™. You also need a Google™ account to download applications and games, music, movies and books from Google Play™. Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account Synchronise your device with your corporate Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account. This way, you keep your work email, contacts and calendar events with you at all times. Facebook™ account Facebook™ is a social networking service that connects you with friends, family and colleagues around the world. Set up Facebook to work on your device so that you can stay in touch from anywhere. 11 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Getting to know your device Using the keys Back • Go back to the previous screen • Close the on-screen keypad, a dialog box, an options menu, or the Notification panel Home • Go to the Home screen Task • Tap to open a window showing your most recently used applications and a small apps bar Battery Charging the battery Your battery is partly charged when you buy the device. It may take a few minutes before the battery icon appears on the screen when you connect the charger cable to a power source, such as a USB port or a charger. You can still use your device while it is charging. Charging your device over a long period of time, for example, overnight, does not damage the battery or the device. The battery will start to discharge a little after it is fully charged and then charges again after a certain time when the charger is connected. This is to extend battery life and may result in the charge status showing a level below 100 percent. 12 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To charge your device Plug the charger into a power outlet. Plug one end of the USB cable into the charger (or into the USB port of a computer). Plug the other end of the cable into the micro USB port on your device, with the USB symbol facing up. The battery status LED lights up when charging starts. When the battery status LED is green, the device is fully charged. Disconnect the USB cable from your device by pulling it straight outwards. Make sure not to bend the connector when removing the cable from the device. Use the charger and USB cable provided with the device to ensure faster charging. If the battery is completely discharged, it may take a few minutes before the LED lights up after you connect the charger cable to a power source. Battery LED status Green The battery is fully charged Red The battery level is low Orange The battery is charging. The battery level is between low and full To check the battery level From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > About phone > Status > Battery level. Improving battery performance The following tips can help you improve battery performance: • • • • • • Charge your device often. This will not affect the lifetime of the battery. Downloading data from the Internet is power consuming. When you're not using the Internet, you can save power by disabling all data connections over mobile networks. This setting does not prevent your device from transmitting data over other wireless networks. Turn off Bluetooth™ and Wi-Fi® when you don't need these features. You can turn them on and off more easily by adding the Quick settings widget to your Home screen. Use the STAMINA mode and Low battery mode features to reduce battery consumption. You can select the power saving mode that best suits the way you use your device. You can also customise the settings of each power saving mode. Set your synchronisation applications (used to synchronise your email, calendar and contacts) to synchronise manually. You can also synchronise automatically, but increase the synchronisation intervals. Check the battery usage menu in your device to see which applications use the most power. Your battery consumes more power when you use video and music streaming 13 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • applications, such as YouTube™. Some applications downloaded from Google Play™ may also consume more power. Close and exit applications that you are not using. Lower the screen display brightness level. Turn off your device or activate the Airplane mode setting if you are in an area with no network coverage. Otherwise, your device repeatedly scans for available networks, and this consumes power. Use a Sony original handsfree device to listen to music. Handsfree devices demand less battery power than your device's own loudspeakers. Keep your device in standby mode whenever possible. Standby time refers to the time during your device is connected to the network and is not being used. Disable any live wallpaper. To access the battery usage menu From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management > Battery usage. • • • • • To add the Data traffic widget to your Home screen Tap and hold an empty area of your Home screen. Tap Widgets > Tools. Tap and hold the Mobile data widget, then drag it to an empty area of your Home screen. To add the Quick settings widget to your Home screen Tap and hold an empty area of your Home screen. Tap Widgets > Tools. Tap and hold the Quick settings widget, then drag it to an empty area of your Home screen. Using STAMINA mode Activate the STAMINA mode feature to pause your Wi-Fi® connection, data traffic and several power consuming applications when your screen is inactive. When STAMINA mode is active, you can still receive phone calls, and text and multimedia messages. You can also set up an applications list to allow some applications to keep running when your screen is inactive. Once the screen becomes active again, all paused functions are resumed. To activate STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to STAMINA mode, then tap Activate. To deactivate STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to STAMINA mode. To change the settings for STAMINA mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. To open the settings menu, tap STAMINA mode. Add or remove applications, as desired. When you're finished, tap Done. Estimating the standby time of your device Standby time refers to the amount of time the battery can last when your device is connected to the network but is not in active use, for example, to receive or make phone calls. STAMINA mode, when activated, continuously evaluates the remaining standby time, which can vary depending on how you use your device. STAMINA mode is more effective in lengthening the standby time if you keep the screen of your 14 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. device locked. If you rarely lock the screen, you may not see much improvement in battery performance. When you use your device for the first time, the estimated standby time may not be accurate since there is no previous usage history to estimate from. To view the estimated standby time From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Using Low battery mode You can activate the Low battery mode feature when the battery level is low. This feature helps you to adjust the settings for screen brightness, data traffic and the vibrate function so that you can reduce battery consumption. To activate Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to Low battery mode, then tap Activate. To deactivate Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. Tap next to Low battery mode. To change the settings for Low battery mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Power management. To open the settings menu, tap Low battery mode. Adjust the settings as desired. When you're finished, tap . Using the touchscreen A protective plastic sheet is already attached to the screen of your device when you buy it. You should peel off this sheet before using the touchscreen. Otherwise, the touchscreen might not function properly. When your device is on and left idle for a set period of time, the screen darkens to save battery power, and locks automatically. This lock prevents unwanted actions on the touchscreen when you are not using it. You can also set personal locks to protect your subscription and make sure only you can access content on your device. The device screen is made from glass. Do not touch the screen if the glass is cracked or shattered. Avoid trying to repair a damaged screen yourself. Glass screens are sensitive to drops and mechanical shocks. Cases of negligent care are not covered by the Sony warranty service. • To open or highlight an item Tap the item. Marking options Marked checkbox Unmarked checkbox Marked list option Unmarked list option 15 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To mark or unmark options Tap the relevant checkbox or list option. Zooming The zoom options available depend on the application you are using. To zoom • Place two fingers on the screen at once and pinch them together (to zoom out) or spread them apart (to zoom in). When you use two fingers on the screen to zoom, it is only possible to zoom if both fingers are within the zoomable area. If you, for example, want to zoom in on a photo, make sure that both fingers are within the photo frame area. Scrolling Scroll by moving your finger up or down on the screen. On some web pages you can also scroll to the sides. Dragging or flicking will not activate anything on the screen. To scroll • Drag or flick your finger in the direction you want to scroll on the screen. To scroll more quickly, flick your finger in the direction you want to go on the screen. 16 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To flick • To scroll more quickly, flick your finger in the direction you want to go on the screen. You can wait for the scrolling movement to stop by itself, or you can stop it immediately by tapping the screen. Sensors Your device has sensors that detect both light and proximity. The light sensor detects the ambient light level and adjusts the brightness of the screen accordingly. The proximity sensor turns the touch screen off during voice calls when your ear is close to the screen. This prevents you from unintentionally activating other functions on your device when you are engaged in a call. Using the lockscreen On the lockscreen, you can play tracks, take photos and record videos without unlocking the screen. To take a photo from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . To activate the camera controls, drag to the left across the screen. Tap . To play an audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . To display the music player controls, drag to the right across the screen. Tap . To pause an audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key When the music player controls appear, tap . 17 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To change the currently playing audio track from the lockscreen To activate the screen, briefly press the power key . When the music player controls appear, tap or . Home screen The Home screen is your gateway to the main features on your device. You can customise your Home screen with widgets, shortcuts, folders, themes, wallpaper and other items. The Home screen extends beyond the regular screen display width, so you need to flick left or right to view content in all of the Home screen's panes. shows which part of the Home screen you are in. You can set a pane as the main Home screen pane, and add or delete panes. The items in the bar at the bottom of the screen are always available for quick access. • To go to the Home screen Press . • To browse the Home screen Flick right or left. To set a pane as the main Home screen pane Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse to the pane that you want to set as your main Home screen pane, then tap . To add a pane to your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse the panes, then tap . 18 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete a pane from your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Flick left or right to browse to the pane that you want to delete, then tap . Widgets Widgets are small applications that you can use directly on your Home screen. For example, the “WALKMAN” widget allows you to start playing music directly. Some widgets are resizable, so you can expand them to view more content or shrink them to save space on your Home screen. To add a widget to the Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates, then tap Widgets. Find and tap the widget that you want to add. To resize a widget Touch and hold a widget until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then release the widget. If the widget can be resized, for example, the Calendar widget, then a highlighted frame and resizing dots appear. Drag the dots inward or outward to shrink or expand the widget. To confirm the new size of the widget, tap anywhere on the Home screen. Rearranging your Home screen Customise the appearance of your Home screen and change the features that you can access from it. Change the screen background, move items around, create folders, and add shortcuts and widgets. Customisation options When you touch and hold an empty area of your Home screen, the following customisation options appear: Add widgets to your Home screen. Add applications and shortcuts. Set a wallpaper for your Home screen. Set a background theme. • To view customisation options from the Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates and customisation options appear at the bottom of the screen. To add a shortcut to your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Apps > Shortcuts. Select a shortcut. You can add an application shortcut directly from the Application screen by touching and holding the application. • To move an item on the Home screen Touch and hold the item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the new location. • To delete an item from the Home screen Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to . 19 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 • To create a folder on the Home screen Touch and hold an application icon or a shortcut until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag and drop it on top of another application icon or shortcut. Enter a name for the folder and tap Done. To add items to a folder on the Home screen Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the folder. To rename a folder on the Home screen Tap the folder to open it. Tap the folder's title bar to show the Folder name field. Enter the new folder name and tap Done. Changing the background of your Home screen Adapt the Home screen to your own style using wallpapers and different themes. To change your Home screen wallpaper Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Wallpapers and select an option. To set a theme for your Home screen Touch and hold an empty area on your Home screen until the device vibrates. Tap Themes, then select a theme. When you change a theme, the background also changes in some applications. Accessing and using applications Open applications from shortcuts on your Home screen or from the Application screen. Application screen The Application screen, which you open from your Home screen, contains the applications that come pre-installed on your device as well as the applications you download. The Application screen extends beyond the regular screen width, so you need to flick left and right to view all content. To open the Application screen • From your Home screen, tap • To browse the Application screen From the Application screen, flick right or left. 20 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a shortcut to an application on the Home screen From your Home screen, tap . Touch and hold an application icon until the screen vibrates, then drag the icon to the top of the screen. The Home screen opens. Drag the icon to the desired location on the Home screen, then release your finger. To share an application from your Application screen From your Home screen, tap . Tap , then tap Share. All applications which can be shared are indicated by Tap the application that you want to share, then select an option and confirm, if necessary. A link to a download of the application is sent to the people you have selected. Opening and closing applications • To open an application From your Home screen or the Application screen, tap the application. • To close an application Press . to exit, while other applications may Some applications are paused when you press continue to run in the background. In the first case, the next time you open the application, you can continue where you left off. Remember that some applications may cause data connection charges when they are running in the background, for example, social networking services. Recently used applications window You can switch between recently used applications from this window. You can also open small apps. • To open the recently used applications window Press . The recently used applications window appears on the right of the screen. Using small apps From the recently used applications window, you can get quick access to several small apps at any time using the small apps bar. A small app only takes up a small area of your screen. So you can interact with a small app and another application at the same time on the same screen. • To open the small apps bar Press . The small apps bar appears at the bottom of the screen. To open a small app To make the small apps bar appear, press Tap the small app that you want to open. A small app window appears. • To close a small app Tap on the small app window. 21 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To move a small app When the small app is open, touch and hold the top left corner of the small app, then move it to the desired location. • To minimise a small app When the small app is open, touch and hold the top left corner of the small app, then drag it to the right edge or to the bottom edge of the screen. To rearrange your small apps To make the small apps bar appear, press . Touch and hold a small app and drag it to the desired position in the small apps bar. To remove a small app from the small apps bar To make the small apps bar appear, press . Touch and hold a small app icon and drag it away from the small apps bar. To restore a previously removed small app To make the small apps bar appear, press . Tap > Installed small apps. Select the small app that you want to restore. To download a small app To make the small apps bar appear, press . Tap > . Find a small app that you want to download, then follow the instructions to complete the installation. Application menu You can open a menu at any time when you are using an application. The menu will look different depending on which application you are using. • To open a menu in an application While using the application, press . A menu is not available in all applications. Rearranging your Application screen Move the applications around on the Application screen according to your preferences. To arrange applications on the Application screen From your Home screen, tap to go to the Application screen. Tap the drop-down list on the top left of the screen and select an option. To move an application on the Application screen Open the Application screen. Touch and hold an item until it magnifies and the device vibrates, then drag the item to the new location. You can only move your applications when Own order is selected. To uninstall an application from the Application screen From your Home screen, tap . Tap , then tap Uninstall. All uninstallable applications are indicated by Tap the application that you want to uninstall, then tap Uninstall. 22 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Status and notifications The status bar at the top of your screen shows what's going on in your device. To the left you get notifications when there is something new or ongoing. For example, new message and calendar notifications appear here. The right side shows the signal strength, battery status, and other information. The status bar allows you to adjust basic settings on your device, for example, Wi-Fi®, Bluetooth™, data traffic, and sound. You can also open the settings menu from the Notification panel to change other settings. A notification light also gives you battery status information and some notifications. For example, a flashing blue light means there is a new message or a missed call. The notification light may not work when the battery level is low. Checking notifications and ongoing activities You can drag down the status bar to open the Notification panel and get more information. For example, you can use the panel to open a new message or view a calendar event. You can also open some applications that run in the background, such as the music player. To open the Notification panel • Drag the status bar downwards. 23 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To close the Notification panel • Drag the tab at the bottom of the Notification panel upwards. • To open a running application from the Notification panel Tap the icon for the running application to open it. • To dismiss a notification from the Notification panel Place your finger on a notification and flick left or right. • To clear the Notification panel From the Notification panel, tap Clear. Setting your device from the Notification panel You can open the settings menu from the Notification panel to adjust basic device settings. For example, you can turn on Wi-Fi®. To open the device settings menu from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To adjust sound settings from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To control the Bluetooth™ function from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To control the Wi-Fi® function from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . To enable or disable data traffic from the Notification panel Drag the status bar downwards. Tap . Settings menu View and change settings for your device from the Settings menu. 24 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To access your device settings From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings. You can also drag the status bar downwards on the Home screen and tap device settings. to access your Typing text You can select from a number of keyboards and input methods to type text containing letters, numbers and other characters. On-screen keyboard Tap the keys of the on-screen QWERTY keyboard to enter text conveniently. Some applications open the on-screen keyboard automatically. You can also open this keyboard by touching a text field. Using the on-screen keyboard 1 Change the character case and turn on the caps lock. For some languages, this key is used to access extra characters in the language. 2 Close the on-screen keyboard view. Note that this icon does not appear in portrait mode. 3 Display numbers and symbols. 4 Personalise your keyboard. This key disappears after the keyboard is personalised. 5 Enter a space. 6 Enter a carriage return or confirm text input. 7 Delete a character before the cursor. All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual device. • To display the on-screen keyboard to enter text Tap a text entry field. • To hide the on-screen keyboard When the on-screen keyboard is open, tap To personalise the on-screen keyboard Open the on-screen keyboard, then tap . Follow the instructions to personalise your on-screen keyboard, for example, mark the Smiley key checkbox. If you don't mark the Smiley key checkbox when you personalise the on-screen keyboard, the smiley icon will not appear. 25 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To use the on-screen keyboard in landscape orientation When you enter text, turn the device sideways. For the keyboard to support this feature, landscape mode must be supported by the application you are using, and your screen orientation settings must be set to automatic. To enter text using the on-screen keyboard To enter a character visible on the keyboard, tap the character. To enter a character variant, touch and hold a regular keyboard character to get a list of available options, then select from the list. For example, to enter "é", touch and hold "e" until other options appear, then, while keeping your finger pressed on the keyboard, drag to and select "é". • To shift between upper-case and lower-case letters Before you enter a letter, tap to switch to upper-case • To turn on the caps lock Before you type a word, touch and hold or until , or vice versa. appears. • To enter numbers or symbols When you enter text, tap . A keyboard with numbers and symbols appears. to view more options. Tap To enter common punctuation marks When you finish entering a word, tap the space bar. Select a punctuation mark from the candidate bar. The selected mark is inserted before the space. To quickly enter a full stop, tap the space bar twice when you finish entering a word. • To delete characters Tap to place the cursor after the character you want to delete, then tap • To enter a carriage return When you enter text, tap to enter a carriage return. To select text Enter some text, then double-tap the text. The word you tap gets highlighted by tabs on both sides. Drag the tabs left or right to select more text. To edit text in landscape orientation Enter some text, then double-tap the entered text. Select the text you want to work with, then tap Edit... and select an option. To paste text from the clipboard, double-tap the text field to make Paste appear, then tap Paste. To edit text in portrait orientation Enter some text, then double-tap the entered text to make the application bar appear. Select the text you want to edit, then use the application bar to make your desired changes. To paste text from the clipboard, double-tap the text field to make Paste appear, then tap Paste. 26 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Application bar Close the application bar Select all text Cut text Copy text Paste text only appears when you have text stored on the clipboard. Using the Gesture input function to write words You can input text by sliding your finger from letter to letter on the on-screen keyboard. Gesture input is only available when you use the on-screen keyboard. To enter text using the Gesture input function When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard, slide your finger from letter to letter to trace the word you want to write. Lift up your finger when you’ve finished entering a word. A word is suggested based on the letters you have traced. If necessary, select the correct word in the candidate bar. To view more options, scroll right or left in the word candidate bar. If you once to delete the entire word. Then try cannot find the desired word, tap again to trace the word using the Gesture input function, or tap each letter to enter the word. If the Space between gestures setting is activated, trace the next word that you want to enter. If not, tap the space bar and then trace the next word you want to enter. To enter joined compound words when the Space between gestures setting is activated, you may need to slide to enter the first part of the word, then tap each letter to enter the rest of the word. To change the Gesture input settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard, tap . Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Text input settings. Mark or unmark the Gesture input checkbox. If you want to automatically add a space between gestures without having to tap the space bar each time, mark the Space between gestures checkbox. Phonepad The Phonepad is similar to a standard 12-key telephone keypad. It gives you predictive text and multi-tap input options. You can activate the Phonepad text input method via the keyboard settings. The Phonepad is only available in portrait orientation. 27 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using the Phonepad Choose a text input option Change the character case and turn on the caps lock Display numbers Display symbols and smileys Enter a space Enter a carriage return or confirm text input Delete a character before the cursor All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual device. To open the Phonepad for the first time Tap a text entry field, then tap . Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Keyboard appearance > Keyboard layout. Select the Phonepad. The Phonepad can only be used in portrait mode. • • • To enter text using the Phonepad When appears in the Phonepad, tap each character key only once, even if the letter you want is not the first letter on the key. Tap the word that appears or tap to view more word suggestions and select a word from the list. When appears in the Phonepad, tap the on-screen key for the character you want to enter. Keep pressing this key until the desired character is selected. Then do the same for the next character you want to enter, and so on. To enter numbers using the Phonepad When the Phonepad is open, tap . A Phonepad with numbers appears. To insert symbols and smileys using the Phonepad When the Phonepad is open, tap . A grid with symbols and smileys appears. Scroll up or down to view more options. Tap a symbol or smiley to select it. Keyboard and Phonepad settings You can select settings for the on-screen keyboard and the Phonepad, such as writing language and automatic correction. 28 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To access the on-screen keyboard and Phonepad settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. or To add a writing language for text input or When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings. Tap Languages > Writing languages and mark the relevant checkboxes. Tap OK to confirm. Text input settings When entering text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, you can access a text input settings menu that helps you set options for text prediction, automatic spacing and quick fixes. For example, you can decide how word options are presented and how words get corrected as you type. You can also set the text input application to remember new words that you write. To change the text input settings When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings > Text input settings and select the relevant settings. or Entering text using voice input When you enter text, you can use the voice input function instead of typing the words. Just speak the words that you want to enter. Voice input is an experimental technology from Google™, and is available for a number of languages and regions. To enable voice input When you enter text using the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad, tap Tap , then tap Keyboard settings . Mark the Google voice typing key checkbox. to save your settings. A microphone icon appears on your onPress screen keyboard or Phonepad. or To enter text using voice input Open the on-screen keyboard or the Phonepad. If is available, tap it. If not, touch and hold the input language key, for example, When appears, speak to enter text. When you're finished, tap again. The suggested text appears. Edit the text manually if necessary. Customising your device You can adjust several device settings to suit your own needs. For example, you can change the language, add a personal ringtone, or change the screen brightness. Adjusting the volume You can adjust the ringtone volume for incoming calls and notifications as well as for music and video playback. • To adjust the ring volume with the volume key Press the volume key up or down. • To adjust the media playing volume with the volume key When playing music or watching video, press the volume key up or down. 29 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Adjusting the sound settings You can adjust several sound settings. For example, you can set your device to silent mode so that it doesn't ring when you're in a meeting. • To set your device to vibrate mode Press the volume key down until appears in the status bar. You can also press and hold down the power key to set your device to vibrate mode. in the menu that opens To set your device to silent mode Press the volume key down until the device vibrates and appears in the status bar. Press the volume key down again. appears in the status bar. You can also press and hold down the power key to set your device to silent mode. and then tap and then tap in the menu that opens To set your device to vibrate and ring mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Vibrate when ringing checkbox. Time and date You can change the time and date on your device. To set the date manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic date & time checkbox, if it is marked. Tap Set date. Adjust the date by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. To set the time manually From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic date & time checkbox if it is marked. Tap Set time. Scroll up or down to adjust the hour and minute. If applicable, scroll up to change am to pm, or vice versa. Tap Done. To set the time zone From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Date & time. Unmark the Automatic time zone checkbox, if it is marked. Tap Select time zone. Select an option. Ringtone settings To set a ringtone From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound > Phone ringtone. Select a ringtone. Tap Done. 30 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To enable touch tones From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Dial pad touch tones and Touch sounds checkboxes. To select the notification sound From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound > Default notification. Select the sound to be played when notifications arrive. Tap Done. Screen settings To adjust the screen brightness From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display > Brightness. Drag the slider to adjust the brightness. Tap OK. The brightness level affects your battery performance. For tips on how to improve battery performance, see Improving battery performance. To set the screen to vibrate From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Vibrate on touch checkbox. The screen now vibrates when you tap soft keys and certain applications. To adjust the idle time before the screen turns off From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display > Sleep. Select an option. To turn off the screen quickly, briefly press the power key To keep the screen active while your device is charging From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Developer options. Mark the Stay awake checkbox. Language settings You can select a default language for your device and change it again at a later time. To change the language From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Language & input > Language. Select an option. Tap OK. If you select the wrong language and cannot read the menu texts, find and tap . Then select the text beside and select the first entry in the menu that opens. You can then select the language you want. Airplane mode In Airplane mode, the network and radio transceivers are turned off to prevent disturbance to sensitive equipment. However, you can still play games, listen to music, watch videos and other content, as long as all this content is saved on your 31 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. memory card or internal storage. You can also be notified by alarms, if alarms are activated. Turning on Airplane mode reduces battery consumption. To turn on Airplane mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Mark the Airplane mode checkbox. You can also press and hold down the power key menu that opens. and then select Airplane mode in the Enhancing the sound output You can enhance the sound output that comes from the speakers in your device using features such as Clear Phase™ and xLOUD™ technology. Using Clear Phase™ technology Use Clear Phase™ technology from Sony to automatically adjust the sound quality coming from your device's internal speakers and get a cleaner, more natural sound. To enhance the speaker sound quality using Clear Phase™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the Clear Phase™ checkbox. The activation of the Clear Phase™ feature has no effect on voice communication applications. For example, there is no change in the voice call sound quality. Using xLOUD™ technology Use xLOUD™ audio filter technology from Sony to enhance the speaker volume without sacrificing quality. Get a more dynamic sound as you listen to your favourite songs. To enhance the speaker volume using xLOUD™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Sound. Mark the xLOUD™ checkbox. The activation of the xLOUD™ feature has no effect on voice communication applications. For example, there is no change in the voice call sound quality. Memory You can save content to your device's internal storage and to a memory card. Memory card Your device supports a microSD™ memory card, which is used for storing content. This type of card can also be used as a portable memory card with other compatible devices. You may have to purchase a memory card separately. Formatting the memory card You can format the memory card in your device, for example, to free up memory. This means that you erase all data on the card. All content on the memory card gets erased when you format it. Make sure you make backups of everything you want to save before formatting the memory card. To back up your content, 32 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. you can copy it to your computer. For more information, refer to the chapter Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. Using a headset Use the accessories provided with your device, or other compatible accessories, for optimal performance. To use a headset Connect the headset to your device. To answer a call, press the call handling key. To end the call, press the call handling key. If a headset is not included with the device, you may purchase one separately. If you are listening to music, the music stops when you answer a call and resumes after you end the call. Internet and messaging settings To send text and multimedia messages and to access the Internet, you must have a mobile data connection and the correct settings. There are different ways to get these settings: • • • For most mobile networks and operators, Internet and messaging settings come preinstalled on your device. You can then start using the Internet and send messages right away. In some cases you will get the option to download Internet and messaging settings the first time you turn on your device. It is also possible to download these settings later from the Settings menu. You can manually add and change Internet and network settings on your device at any time. Contact your network operator for detailed information about Internet and messaging settings. To download Internet and messaging settings From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Internet settings. Tap Accept. To reset the default Internet settings From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Access Point Names. Tap . Tap Reset to default. Access Point Names (APNs) An APN is used to establish data connections between your device and the Internet. The APN defines which type of IP address to use, which security methods to invoke, and which fixed-end connections to use. Checking the APN is useful when you 33 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. cannot access the Internet, have no data connection, or cannot send or receive multimedia messages. To view the current APN From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Tap Access Point Names. If you have several available connections, the active network connection is indicated by a marked button. To add Internet settings manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Access Point Names. Tap . Tap New APN. Tap Name and enter the name of the network profile that you want to create. Tap APN and enter the access point name. Enter all other information required by your network operator. Tap , then tap Save. Usage info For quality purposes, Sony collects anonymous bug reports and statistics regarding your device. None of the information gathered includes personal data. To allow the sending of usage info From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Usage info settings. Mark the Send usage info checkbox if it is not already marked. Tap Agree to allow the sending of usage information. Controlling data usage Keep track of and control the amount of data transferred to and from your device during a given period. For example, you can set data usage warnings and limits for your device to avoid additional charges. You can also limit the amount of data used by individual applications. Adjusting data usage settings can help you keep greater control over data usage but cannot guarantee the prevention of additional charges. To access data usage settings From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To turn data traffic on or off From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To turn data traffic on or off, tap the on-off switch beside Mobile data accordingly. You can also turn data traffic on or off by marking or unmarking the Mobile data traffic checkbox under Settings > More… > Mobile networks. To set a data usage warning Make sure that you have turned on data traffic. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. To set the warning level, drag the lines to the desired values. You receive a warning notification when the amount of data traffic approaches the level you set. 34 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set a data usage limit Make sure that you have turned on data traffic. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. Mark the Set mobile data limit checkbox if it is not marked, then tap OK. To set the data usage limit, drag the lines to the desired values. Once your data usage reaches the set limit, data traffic on your device will be turned off automatically. To control the data usage of individual applications From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Data usage. Find and tap the desired application. Make the necessary adjustments to change the data usage limit, restrict background data, or restrict all data traffic for the application. To access more specific settings for the application, tap View app settings and make the desired changes. Specific settings for an application may not always be accessible. The performance of individual applications may be affected if you change the related data usage settings. Mobile network settings Your device automatically switches between mobile networks depending on what mobile networks are available in different areas. You can also manually set your device to use a particular mobile network mode, for example, WCDMA or GSM. To select a network mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Tap Network Mode. Select a network mode. To select another network manually From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Network operators. Tap Search mode > Manual. Select a network. If you select a network manually, your device will not search for other networks, even if you move out of range of the manually selected network. To activate automatic network selection From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks > Network operators. When a pop-up window appears, tap Search mode. Tap Automatic. Turning off data traffic You can disable all data connections over mobile networks to avoid any unwanted data downloads and synchronisations. Contact your network operator if you need detailed information about your subscription plan and data traffic charges. When data traffic is turned off, you can still use Wi-Fi® and Bluetooth™ connections. You can also send and receive multimedia messages. 35 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn off all data traffic From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Unmark the Mobile data traffic checkbox. Data roaming Some network operators allow mobile data connections via mobile networks when you are outside of your home network (roaming). Note that data transmission charges may apply. Contact your network operator for more information. Applications may sometimes use the Internet connection in your home network without any notification, for example, when sending search and synchronisation requests. Additional charges may apply when such Internet connections are established while you are roaming. Consult your network operator for more information. To activate data roaming From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Mobile networks. Mark the Data roaming checkbox. You can’t activate data roaming when data connections have been deactivated. 36 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Play™ Getting started with Google Play™ Open Google Play™ and enter a world of applications and games. You can browse these applications and games through different categories. You can also rate an application or game and send feedback on it. To use Google Play™, you need to have a Google™ account. See To set up a Google™ account on your device on page 54. Google Play™ may not be available in all countries or regions To open Google Play™ From the Home screen, tap Find and tap Play Store. Downloading from Google Play™ You can download all kinds of applications from Google Play™, including free applications. Before you download applications Before you start downloading from Google Play™, make sure that you have a working Internet connection. Also, remember that you might incur data traffic charges when you download content to your device. Contact your operator for more information. To download a free application In Google Play™, find an item you wish to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details, and follow the instructions to complete the installation. To download a paid application In Google Play™, find an item you wish to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details, and follow the instructions to complete your purchase. To open a downloaded application In Google Play™, press , then tap My Apps. Tap the downloaded application. You can also access downloaded applications from the Application screen. Clearing your application data You may sometimes need to clear data for an application. This might happen if, for example, the application memory becomes full, or you want to clear high scores for a game. You might also want to erase incoming email, text and multimedia messages in some applications. 37 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To clear all cache for an application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Tap the application for which you want to clear all cache. Tap Clear cache. It is not possible to clear the cache for some applications. To delete an installed application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Select the application that you want to delete. Tap Uninstall. It is not possible to delete some preinstalled applications. Permissions Some applications may need to access data, settings and various functions on your device in order to work properly. If so, then they need the relevant permissions from you. For example, a navigation application needs permissions to send and receive data traffic, and access your location. Some applications might misuse their permissions by stealing or deleting data, or by reporting your location. Make sure you only install and give permissions to applications you trust. To view permissions of an application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap Apps. Tap the desired application. Scroll down to view the relevant details under Permissions. Installing applications not from Google Play™ Installing applications of unknown or unreliable origin can damage your device. By default, your device is set to block such installations. However, you can change this setting and allow installations from unknown sources. Sony does not warrant or guarantee the performance of any third-party applications or content transferred via download or other interface to your device. Similarly, Sony is not responsible for any damage or reduced performance of your device attributable to the transfer of thirdparty content. Only use content from reliable sources. Contact the content provider if you have any questions or concerns. To allow the installation of applications not from Google Play™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security. Mark the Unknown sources checkbox. Tap OK. 38 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Calling Emergency calls Your device supports international emergency numbers, for example, 112 or 911. You can normally use these numbers to make emergency calls in any country, with or without the SIM card inserted if you are within range of a network. To make an emergency call From your Home screen, tap . Find and Tap Phone. Enter the emergency number and tap Call. To delete a number, tap You can make emergency calls when no SIM card is inserted or when outgoing calls are barred. To make an emergency call while the SIM card is locked Tap Emergency call. Enter the emergency number and tap Call. To delete a number, tap Call handling You can make a call by manually dialling a phone number, by tapping a number saved in your contact list, or by tapping the phone number in your call log view. You can also use the smart dial feature to quickly find numbers from your contact list and call logs. To dial a phone number From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap . If the call log appears, tap to enter the dialpad view. Enter the phone number and tap . To delete a digit entered by mistake, tap To make a call using smart dial From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Use the dialpad to enter letters or numbers that correspond to the contact you want to call. As you enter each letter or number, a list of possible matches appears. Tap the contact you want to call. • To end a call Tap End call. To make an international call From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Touch and hold 0 until a “+” sign appears. Enter the country code, area code (without the first 0) and phone number, then tap Call. 39 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To answer a call • Drag • To decline a call Drag to the left across the screen. • To reject a second call When you hear repeated beeps during a call, tap • To change the ear speaker volume during a call Press the volume key up or down. • To turn on the loudspeaker during a call Tap . • To mute the microphone during a call Tap . • To activate the screen during a call Briefly press . To enter numbers during a call During the call, tap Dialpad. A keypad appears. Tap the numbers you want to enter. • To mute the ringtone for an incoming call When you receive the call, press the volume key. to the right across the screen. Recent calls In the call log, you can view missed To view your missed calls When you have missed a call, downwards. Tap Missed call. and dialled calls. appears in the status bar. Drag the status bar To call a number from your call log From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone.The call log view appears on the upper part of the screen. To call a number directly, tap the number. To edit a number before calling, touch and hold the number, then tap Edit number before call. You can also call a number by tapping , received > Call back. To add a number from the call log to your contacts From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone.The call log view appears on the upper part of the screen. Touch and hold the number, then tap Add to Contacts. Tap the desired contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact details and tap Done. 40 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Voicemail If your subscription includes a voicemail service, callers can leave voice messages for you when you can't answer calls. Your voicemail service number is normally saved on your SIM card. If not, you can get the number from your service provider and enter it manually. To enter your voicemail number From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Voicemail >Voicemail settings > Voicemail number. Enter your voicemail number. Tap OK. To call your voicemail service From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Phone. Touch and hold 1. Multiple calls If you have activated call waiting, you can handle multiple calls at the same time. When it is activated, you will be notified by a beep if you receive another call. To activate or deactivate call waiting From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Additional settings. To activate or deactivate call waiting, tap Call waiting. • To answer a second call and put the ongoing call on hold When you hear repeated beeps during a call, tap . To make a second call During an ongoing call, tap Dialpad. Enter the number of the recipient and tap Call. The first call is put on hold. The same procedure applies to subsequent calls. • To switch between multiple calls To switch to another call and put the current call on hold, tap • To end the ongoing call and return to the next call on hold Tap End call. Conference calls With a conference or multiparty call, you can have a joint conversation with two or more persons. For details on the number of participants you can add to a conference call, contact your network operator. To make a conference call During an ongoing call, tap Dialpad. Dial the number of the second participant and tap Call. After the second participant answers, the first participant is put on hold. to add the second participant to the conference call. Tap Repeat steps 1 to 3 to add more call participants. 41 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To have a private conversation with a conference call participant During an ongoing conference call, tap {0} participants. Tap the telephone number of the participant with whom you want to talk privately. To end the private conversation and return to the conference call, tap . To release a participant from a conference call During an ongoing conference call, tap the button showing the number of participants. For example, tap 3 participants if there are three participants. Tap next to the participant you want to release. • To end a conference call During the conference call, tap End conference call. Call settings Barring calls You can bar all or certain categories of incoming and outgoing calls. When you use call barring for the first time, you need to enter your PUK (Personal Unblocking Key) and then a new password to activate the call barring function. To bar incoming or outgoing calls From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call barring. Select an option. Enter the password and tap Enable. Rejecting a call with a message You can reject a call with a predefined message. When you reject a call with such a message, the message is automatically sent to the caller and saved on your device. Six messages are predefined on your device. You can select from these predefined messages, which can also be edited if necessary. • • To reject a call with a predefined message Drag Reject with message upward, then select a message. To reject a second call with a predefined message When you hear repeated beeps during a call, drag Reject with message upward, then select a message. To edit the message used to reject a call From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Reject call with message. Tap the message you want to edit, then make the necessary changes. When you're done, tap OK. Forwarding calls You can forward calls, for example, to another phone number, or to an answering service. To forward calls From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call forwarding. Select an option. Enter the number you want to forward the calls to, then tap Enable. 42 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn off call forwarding From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Call forwarding. Select an option, then tap Disable. Showing or hiding your phone number You can select to show or hide your phone number on call recipients' devices when you call them. To show or hide your phone number From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Additional settings > Caller ID. Fixed Dialling Numbers If you have received a PIN2 code from your service provider, you can use a list of Fixed Dialling Numbers (FDN) to restrict outgoing calls. To enable or disable fixed dialling From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Fixed dialling numbers. Tap Activate fixed dialling or Deactivate fixed dialling. Enter your PIN2 and tap OK. To access the list of accepted call recipients From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Call settings > Fixed dialling numbers > Fixed dialling numbers. 43 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts About Contacts Use the Contacts application to store and manage all your numbers, email addresses, and other contact data in one place. Just tap on a contact to see all communications with that contact in one easy overview. You can add new contacts in your device and synchronise them with contacts saved in your Google™ account, Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® account, or other accounts that support synchronisation. The Contacts application automatically creates new entries and also helps you match data such as email addresses with existing entries. Transferring contacts to your new device There are several ways to transfer contacts to your new device. Select a transfer method that best suits your situation. Transferring contacts using a PC You can use a PC to transfer contacts from several device brands, including iPhone, Samsung, HTC and Nokia. You need: • • • • • An Internet-connected PC running Windows® A USB cable for your old device A USB cable for your new Android™ device Your old device Your new Android™ device Using the PC Companion program to transfer contacts If you are transferring contacts using a PC, use the PC Companion program. It's free, and the installation files are already saved on your new device. PC Companion also offers a range of other features, including help to update your device software. To install PC Companion New device: Turn on your new Android™ device and connect it to a PC using a USB cable. New device: Tap Install to install PC Companion on the PC. Computer: If a popup window appears to notify you about available PC software, select Run Startme.exe. Computer: Click Install to start the installation and then follow the instructions to complete the installation. To transfer contacts to your new device using PC Companion Make sure that PC Companion is installed on your PC. Open the PC Companion program on the PC, then click Contacts Setup and follow the instructions to transfer your contacts. Transferring contacts using an Apple® Mac® computer For detailed instructions on how to use an Apple Mac computer to transfer contacts from your old device, go to Transfer your contacts. Transferring contacts using synchronisation accounts Your device works with popular online synchronisation accounts such as Google Sync™, Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync®or Facebook™. If you have synced the contacts in your old device or your computer with an online account, you can transfer 44 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. your contacts to your new device using that account. For more detailed information about synchronisation, see Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts on page 110. To synchronise contacts on your device with a synchronisation account From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap , then tap Settings > Accounts & sync. If you have already set up a synchronisation account and you want to sync with that account, tap the account, then tap , and tap Sync now. Transferring contacts from a SIM card To import contacts from a SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Import contacts > SIM card. If you have set up a synchronisation account, you can choose to add the SIM card contacts under that account. Or you can choose to only use these contacts on your device. Select your desired option. To import an individual contact, find and tap the contact. To import all contacts, tap Import all. Transferring contacts from a memory card To import contacts from a memory card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Import contacts > SD card. If you have set up a synchronisation account, you can add the imported memory card contacts under that account. Or you can choose to only use the imported contacts on your device. Select your desired option. If you have more than one vCard file on the SD card, a list appears showing different batches of contacts saved on your device, with the corresponding dates for when they were created. Select the batch that you want to import. Receiving contacts from other devices To receive contact data sent using Bluetooth™ technology Make sure you have the Bluetooth™ function turned on and your device set to visible. If not, then you cannot receive data from other devices. When you are asked to confirm whether you want to receive the file, tap Accept. Drag down the Notification panel and tap the file you received to import the contact data. To receive contacts sent using a messaging service When you receive a new text message, multimedia message, or email message, open the message. The received contact data appears as a vCard attachment. Tap, or touch and hold the vCard file to open a menu so you can save the contact data. 45 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Contacts screen overview Shortcut tabs Tap a contact to view its details Alphabetical index for browsing contacts Tap a contact thumbnail to access the quick contact menu Search for contacts Create a contact Open more options Managing your contacts You can create, edit and synchronise your contacts in a few simple steps. You can select contacts saved in different accounts and manage how you display them on your device. If you synchronise your contacts with more than one account, you can join contacts on your device to avoid duplicates. Some synchronisation services, for example, some social networking services, do not allow you to edit contact details. • To view your contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Your contacts are listed here. To select which contacts to display in the Contacts application From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Filter. In the list that appears, mark and unmark the desired options. If you have synchronised your contacts with a synchronisation account, that account appears in the list. To further expand the list of options, tap the account. When you are finished, tap OK. 46 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To add a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap . If you have synchronised your contacts with one or more accounts, select the account to which you want to add this contact, or tap Phone contact if you only want to use this contact on your device. Enter or select the desired information for the contact. When you are finished, tap Done. If you add a plus sign and the country code before a contact's phone number, you do not have to edit the number again when you make calls from other countries. To edit a contact From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to edit, then tap . Edit the desired information. When you are finished, tap Done. To associate a picture with a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to edit, then tap . Tap and select the desired method for adding the contact picture. When you have added the picture, tap Done. You can also add a picture to a contact directly from the Album application. To view your communication with a contact From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to view. To view your communication with the contact for different media, tap or flick through the filter items at the bottom of the screen. To delete contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Touch and hold the contact you want to delete. To delete all contacts, press , then tap Mark several. Tap the downwards arrow to open the drop down menu, then select Mark all. Tap , then tap OK. To edit contact information about yourself From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap Myself, then tap . Enter the new information or make the changes you want. When you are done, tap Done. Avoiding duplicate entries in the Contacts application If you synchronise your contacts with a new account or import contact information in other ways, you could end up with duplicate entries in the Contacts application. If this happens, you can join such duplicates to create a single entry. And if you join entries by mistake, you can separate them again later. To link contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to link with another contact. Press , then tap Link contact. Tap the contact whose information you want to join with the first contact, then tap OK to confirm. The information from the first contact is merged with the second contact, and the first contact is no longer displayed in the Contacts list. 47 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To separate linked contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the linked contact you want to edit, then tap Tap Unlink contact. Tap OK. Favourites You can mark contacts as favourites so that you can get quick access to them from the Contacts application. To mark or unmark a contact as a favourite From the Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact you want to add to or remove from your favourites. Tap . To view your favourite contacts From your Home screen, tap , then tap Tap . Groups You can assign contacts to groups to get quicker access to them from within the Contacts application. To assign a contact to a group In the Contacts application, tap the contact that you want to assign to a group. Tap , then tap the bar directly under Assign to group. Mark the checkboxes for the groups to which you want to add the contact, then tap Done. Tap Done. Communicating with your contacts To search for a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap and enter the first few letters of the contact name in the Search contacts field. All contacts beginning with those letters appear. The quick contact menu Tap a contact's thumbnail to view quick communication options for a particular contact. Options include calling the contact, sending a text or multimedia message, and starting a chat using the Google Talk™ application. For an application to appear as an option in the quick contact menu, you may need to set up the application in your device and be logged in to the application. For example, you need to start the Gmail™ application and enter your login details before you can use Gmail™ from the quick contact menu. Sharing your contacts To send your business card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap Myself. Press , then tap Send contact > OK. Select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. 48 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To send a contact From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact whose details you want to send. Press , then tap Send contact > OK. Select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. To send several contacts at once From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Mark several. Mark the contacts you want to send, or select all if you want to send all contacts. Tap , then select an available transfer method and follow the on-screen instructions. Backing up contacts You can use a memory card, a SIM card or an online synchronisation tool such as Microsoft® Exchange ActiveSync® to back up contacts. To export all contacts to a memory card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Back up contacts > Memory Card. Tap OK. To export contacts to a SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then tap . Press , then tap Back up contacts > SIM card. Mark the contacts you want to export, or tap Mark all if you want to export all your contacts. Tap Back up. Select Add contacts if you want to add the contacts to existing contacts on your SIM card, or select Replace all contacts if you want to replace the existing contacts on your SIM card. When you export contacts to a SIM card, not all information may get exported. This is due to memory limitations on SIM cards. 49 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Messaging Using text and multimedia messaging You can send and receive text messages from your device using SMS (Short Message Service). If your subscription includes MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service), you can also send and receive messages that contain media files, for example, pictures and videos. The number of characters you can send in a single text message varies depending on the operator and the language you use. If you exceed the character limit, then all your single messages are linked together and sent as one message. You are charged for each single text message you send. When you view your messages, they appear as conversations, which means that all messages to and from a particular person are grouped together. To send multimedia messages, you need the correct MMS settings on your device. See Internet and messaging settings. To create and send a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap . Tap , then select the desired recipients from the Contacts list. If the recipient is not listed as a contact, enter the contact's number manually and tap . When you are finished adding recipients, tap Done. Tap Write message and enter your message text. If you want to add a media file, tap and select an option. To send the message, tap Send. If you exit a message before sending, it gets saved as a draft. The conversation gets tagged with the word Draft:. To read a received message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the desired conversation. If the message is not yet downloaded, tap and hold the message, then tap Download message. appears there. Just drag down the You can also open messages from the status bar when bar and tap the message. To reply to a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation containing the message. Enter your reply and tap Send. To forward a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the conversation containing the message you want to forward. Touch and hold the message you want to forward, then tap Forward message. Tap , then select a recipient from the Contacts list. If the recipient is not listed as a contact, enter the contact's number manually and tap . When you are finished adding recipients, tap Done. Edit the message, if necessary, and tap Send. In step 4, you can also tap To and enter the recipient's phone number manually. To delete a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation containing the message you want to delete. Touch and hold the message you want to delete, then tap Delete message > Delete. 50 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete conversations From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Delete conversations. Mark the checkboxes for the conversations that you want to delete, then tap > Delete. To save a sender's number From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap > Save. Select an existing contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact information and tap Done. To call a message sender From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap a conversation. Tap the recipient name or number at the top of the screen, then select the recipient name or number from the list that appears. If the recipient is saved in your contacts, tap the phone number that you want to call. If you have not saved the recipient in your contacts, tap . To save a file contained in a message you receive From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap the conversation you want to open. If the message has not been downloaded yet, tap and hold the message, then tap Download message. Touch and hold the file you want to save, then select the desired option. To star a message From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap the conversation you want to open. In the message you want to star, tap . To unstar a message, tap . To view starred messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Starred messages. All starred messages appear in a list. To search for messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Search. Enter your search keywords, then tap the confirm key. Text and multimedia message options To change your message notification settings From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Settings. To set a notification sound, tap Notification tone and select an option. For other notification settings, check or uncheck the relevant checkboxes. To change the delivery report settings for outgoing messages From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap , then tap Settings. Tap Delivery report to activate or deactivate delivery reports. To view messages saved on the SIM card From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap , then tap Settings > SIM messages. 51 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Talk™ The Google Talk™ application lets you chat with your friends using text, voice and video. To start Google Talk™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Talk. To reply to an instant message with Google Talk™ appears in the status bar. When someone contacts you on Google Talk™, Drag the status bar downwards, then tap the message and begin to chat. 52 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Email Getting started with Email You can handle several email accounts at the same time using the Email application, including corporate Microsoft Exchange Active Sync accounts. Emails you receive to your Gmail™ account can be accessed on your device from both the Email and the Gmail™ applications. Using email accounts To set up an email account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Follow the instructions that appear on the screen to complete the setup. For some email services, you may need to contact your email service provider for information on detailed settings for the email account. To set an email account as your default account From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account you want to use as the default account for composing and sending emails. Mark the Default account checkbox. The inbox of the default account appears every time you open the email application. If you only have one email account, this account is automatically the default account. To add an extra email account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen, then tap Add account. Enter the email address and password, then tap Next. If the settings for the email account cannot be downloaded automatically, complete the setup manually. When prompted, enter a name for your email account so that it is easily identifiable. The same name shows in the emails you send from this account. When you are finished, tap Next. To remove an email account from your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account you want to remove. Tap Delete account > OK. Gmail™ and other Google™ services If you have a Google™ account, you can use the Gmail™ application on your device to read, write and organise email messages. After you set up your Google™ account to work on your device, you can also chat to friends using the Google Talk™ application, synchronise your calendar application with your Google Calendar™, and download applications and games from Google Play™. The services and features described in this chapter may not be supported in all countries or regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 53 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set up a Google™ account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Add account > Google. Follow the registration wizard to create a Google™ account, or sign in if you already have an account. You can also sign in to or create a Google™ account from the setup guide the first time you start your device. Or you can go online and create an account at www.google.com/accounts. To open the Gmail™ application From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Gmail . Using email To create and send an email message Make sure that you have set up an email account. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to use. Tap , then tap To and start typing the recipient's name or email address, or and select one or more recipients from your Contacts list. tap Enter the email subject and message text, then tap . To receive email messages From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. To download new messages, tap . If you have set up a corporate email account, you can set the check frequency to Automatic (Push). To read your email messages From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. In the email inbox, scroll up or down and tap the email you want to read. To use the email preview pane From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap and select the account you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. Hold your device horizontally. The email preview pane appears. Scroll up or down in the email inbox and tap the email you want to read. The email opens in the preview pane. To view more information about the email, tap the downward arrow next to the sender's name. In the body text field, pinch two fingers together, or spread them apart, to zoom out or in. To view the email in fullscreen format, tap the split bar (located between the email list and email body) accordingly. In fullscreen format, use the leftward and rightward arrows to read your previous or next message. To return to the inbox view, tap the split bar accordingly. Before using the preview pane, activate it in the preview pane settings. To hide the preview pane, hold your device vertically, or change the preview pane settings. 54 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To change email preview pane settings From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Tap General > Preview pane, then select an option. To view an email message attachment From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Find and tap the email message containing the attachment that you want to view. Emails with attachments are indicated by . After the email message opens, tap , then tap View. To save a sender's email address to your contacts From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Find and tap a message in your email inbox. Tap the name of the sender, then tap OK. Select an existing contact, or tap Create new contact. Edit the contact information, if desired, then tap Done. To reply to an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to reply to, then tap Tap Reply or Reply all. Enter your reply, then tap . To forward an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to forward, then tap . Tap Forward. to select a Tap To and enter the recipient's email address manually, or tap recipient from your contacts. Enter your message text, then tap . To delete an email message From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. In your email inbox, find and tap the message you want to delete, then tap . Tap Yes. To sort your emails From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. If you are using several email accounts, tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to check. If you want to check all your email accounts at once, tap Combined view. Press , then tap Sort. Select a sorting option. To search for emails From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen and select the account that you want to search. Tap . Enter your search text, then tap Go on your keyboard. The search result appears in a list sorted by date. Tap the email that you want to open. To change search options, tap and select a different option. 55 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view all folders for one email account From your Home screen, tap . Then find and tap Email. Tap at the top of the screen and select the account you want to check, then tap again and select Show all folders to view all the folders in this account. To change the inbox check frequency From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the account for which you want to change the inbox check frequency. Tap Inbox check frequency and select an option. To set an Out of Office auto-reply in an Exchange Active Sync account From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Email. Press , then tap Settings. Select the EAS (Exchange Active Sync) account for which you want to set an Out of Office auto-reply. Tap Out of office. Tap beside Out of office so that changes to . If needed, mark the Set time range checkbox and set the time range for the auto reply. Enter your Out of Office message in the body text field. Tap OK to confirm. 56 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Socialife™ Using the Socialife™ application Use the Socialife™ application from Sony to get your favourite news, videos and social networking feeds in one place. The Socialife™ home screen gives a clear overview of friends’ Facebook and Twitter activity, plus news feeds that you have subscribed to. It colour-codes and sizes articles for easy reading, adding photos and cropping images of your friends’ faces to illustrate each story. The Socialife™ application is not available in all markets. To open the Socialife™ application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap . 57 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. "WALKMAN" application About the "WALKMAN" application Get the most out of your "WALKMAN" application. Listen to and organise music and audio books that you have transferred to your device from a computer, or purchased and downloaded from online stores. To make content easily available to the "WALKMAN" application, you can use the Media Go™ application. Media Go™ helps transfer music content between a computer and your device. For more information, see Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. "WALKMAN" application overview Browse your music Search all tracks saved on your device Tap the infinite button to find related information online and plug-ins on Google Play™ Album art (if available) Go to the next track in the current play queue, or fast forward Total time length of the track Elapsed time of current track Progress indicator – drag the indicator or tap along the line to fast forward or rewind Play/Pause button 10 Go to the previous track in the current play queue, or rewind Transferring media files to your device Before using the "WALKMAN" application, it's a good idea to transfer all your favourite media content from a computer to your device and then play or view this content on your device. Media content can include music, photos and videos. The easiest way to transfer files is with a USB cable. After you connect your device and the computer using the USB cable, you can use the file manager application on the computer or the Media Go™ application to transfer the files. 58 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Using the "WALKMAN" application To play audio content From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . In My music, select a music category and browse to the track that you want to open. Tap a track to play it. You might not be able to play copyright-protected items. Please verify that you have necessary rights in material that you intend to share. • • To change tracks When a track is playing, tap or . When a track is playing, swipe the album art left or right. • To pause a track Tap . • To fast forward and rewind music Touch and hold or . You can also drag the progress indicator marker right or left. • To adjust the audio volume Press the volume key. To improve the sound quality using the equaliser When the "WALKMAN" application is open, tap . Tap Settings > Sound enhancements. To adjust the sound manually, drag the frequency band buttons up or down. To adjust the sound automatically, tap and select a style. To turn on the surround sound feature When the "WALKMAN" application is open, tap . Tap Settings > Sound enhancements > Settings > Surround sound (VPT). Select a setting, then tap OK to confirm. To view the current play queue While a track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Play queue. • To minimise the "WALKMAN" application When the "WALKMAN" application is playing, tap to go to the previous to go to the Home screen. The "WALKMAN" application screen, or tap stays playing in the background. To open the "WALKMAN" application when it is playing in the background While a track is playing in the background, drag the status bar downwards to open the Notification panel. Tap the track title to open the "WALKMAN" application. Alternatively, you can press and then select the "WALKMAN" application. To delete a track In My music, browse to the track that you want to delete. Touch and hold the track title, then tap Delete. You can also delete albums this way. 59 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To send a track In My music, when browsing your tracks , touch and hold a track title. Tap Send. Select an application from the list, and follow the on-screen instructions. You can also send albums and playlists in the same way. To "Like" a track on Facebook™ While the track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap the album art. Tap to show that you "Like" the track on Facebook™. If desired, add a comment in the comments field. Tap Share to send the track to Facebook™. If the track is received successfully, you will get a confirmation message from Facebook™. Visualiser The Visualiser adds visual effects to your music tracks as you play them. The effects for each track are based on the characteristics of the music. They change, for example, in response to changes in the music’s loudness, rhythm and frequency level. You can also change the background theme. To turn on the Visualiser In the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Visualiser. Tap to switch to full screen view. To change the background theme In the "WALKMAN" application, tap . Tap Visualiser. Tap > Theme and select a theme. Getting more information about a track or artist In the "WALKMAN" application, you can get more information about the artist that you are listening to by tapping the infinite button The infinite button • • • • • • also gives you access to related content such as: Music videos on YouTube™ Artist info on Wikipedia Lyrics on Google Karaoke videos on YouTube™ Extension searches on the web Content from the PlayNow™ service The accuracy of search results may vary. • To get more information about an artist or track When a track is playing in the "WALKMAN" application, tap Using My music to organise your tracks Tap the My music tab in the "WALKMAN" application to get an overview of all the tracks that are available from your device. In My music, you can manage your albums and playlists, create shortcuts, and arrange your music by mood and tempo. 60 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Overview of My music Go back to the current track Picture of the currently playing artist (if available) Browse your music by artist Categorise your music using SensMe™ channels Manage and edit your music using Music Unlimited™ Browse your favourite playlists Collect links to music and related content that you and friends have shared using online services Browse all playlists Browse audio by track 10 Browse by album To add a shortcut to a track In My music, tap , , or , then browse to the track for which you want to create a shortcut. Touch and hold the track title. Tap Add as shortcut. The shortcut now appears in the My music main view. • To rearrange shortcuts In My music, touch and hold a shortcut until it magnifies and your device vibrates, then drag the item to a new location. • To delete a shortcut In My music, touch and hold a shortcut until it magnifies and your device vibrates, then drag the item to . You can only delete shortcuts that you create yourself. To update your music with the latest information In My music, tap . Tap Download music info > Start. Your device searches online and downloads the latest available album art and track information for your music. The SensMe™ channels application is activated when you download music information. 61 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Categorising your music using SensMe™ channels The SensMe™ channels application helps you arrange your music by mood and tempo. SensMe™ groups all your tracks into several categories, or channels, so you can select music that matches your mood or suits the time of day. • To enable the SensMe™ channels application In My music, tap , then tap Download music info. This application requires a mobile or Wi-Fi® network connection. Using the Friends' music function to share music The Friends’ music function collects links to music and music-related content that you and your friends have shared using Facebook™. To manage music from your friends In My music, tap Friends' music > Recent. Tap an item to open it, then work on it as desired. Tap to show that you "Like" the track on Facebook™. If desired, add a comment in the comments field. To view your shared music In My music, tap Friends' music > My shares. Scroll to an item you want to open, then tap it. All comments about the item, if any, are displayed. Playing music in random order You can play tracks in playlists in random order. A playlist can be, for example, a playlist you have created yourself or an album. To play tracks in random order In My music, tap and navigate to an album, or tap and browse to a playlist. to turn on Shuffle mode. Tap the album art, then tap • To turn off shuffle mode When tracks are playing in random order, tap the album art > Managing playlists In My music, you can create your own playlists from the music that is saved on your device. In addition, you can install the Media Go™ application on a computer and use it to copy playlists from the computer to your device. To create your own playlists In the WALKMAN player, tap the MY MUSIC tab. Tap Playlists. In the menu that opens, tap Create new playlist. Enter a name for the playlist and tap OK. Select your music and tap the Save icon at the top right of the screen. To add tracks to a playlist In My music, when browsing your tracks, touch and hold the name of the artist or the title of the album or track that you want to add. Tap Add to playlist. Tap the name of the playlist to which you want to add the artist, album or track. The artist, album or track is added to the playlist. 62 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To play your own playlists In My music, tap . Under Playlists, tap a playlist. Tap a track to play it. To remove a track from a playlist In a playlist, touch and hold the title of the track you want to delete. Tap Delete from playlist from the list that appears. To delete a playlist In My music, then select Playlists. Touch and hold the playlist you want to delete. Tap Delete. Tap Delete again to confirm. You cannot delete default playlists. "WALKMAN" application widget The "WALKMAN" application widget is a miniature application that gives you direct access to the "WALKMAN" application from your Home screen. You need to add this widget to your Home screen before you can use it. To add the "WALKMAN" application widget to your Home screen Tap an empty area on your Home screen, then tap Widgets. Find and tap WALKMAN. Protecting your hearing Listening to the "WALKMAN" application or other media players at excessive volume or for a prolonged period of time can damage your hearing, even when the volume is at a moderate level. To alert you to such risks, a volume level warning appears when the volume is too high, and after the "WALKMAN" application is used for over 20 hours. • To turn off the volume level warning appears, tap OK to dismiss the warning. When Every time you restart your device, the media volume is automatically set to a moderate level. 63 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Music services TrackID™ technology Identifying music using TrackID™ technology Use the TrackID™ music recognition service to identify a music track you hear playing in your surroundings. Just record a short sample of the song and you’ll get artist, title and album info within seconds. You can purchase tracks identified by TrackID™ and you can view TrackID™ charts to see what TrackID™ users around the globe are searching for. For best results, use TrackID™ technology in a quiet area. The TrackID™ application and the TrackID™ service are not supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. To open the TrackID™ application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap TrackID™. You can also use the TrackID™ widget to open the TrackID™ application. To search for track information using TrackID™ Open the TrackID™ application, then hold your device towards the music source. Tap . If the track is recognised by the TrackID™ service, the results appear on the screen. To return to the TrackID™ start screen, press To view TrackID™ charts Open the TrackID™ application, then tap Charts. The first time you view a chart, it is set to your own region. To see charts of the most popular searches in other regions, tap > Regions. Select a country or region. Using TrackID™ technology results Track information appears when the TrackID™ application recognises a track. You can select to purchase the track or share it using email, SMS or a social networking service. You can also get more information about the track's artist. To buy a track recognised by the TrackID™ application After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Download. Follow the instructions on your device to complete your purchase. You can also select a track to buy by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. The track purchase feature may not be supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. To share a track After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Share, then select a sharing method. Follow the instructions on your device to complete the procedure. You can also select a track to share by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. 64 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To view the artist information for a track After a track has been recognised by the TrackID™ application, tap Artist info. You can also view the artist information for a track by opening the History or Charts tabs from the TrackID™ start screen. To delete a track from the track history Open the TrackID™ application, then tap History. Tap a track title, then tap Delete. Tap Yes to confirm. Music Unlimited™ Using Music Unlimited™ Music Unlimited™ is a subscription-based service that offers access to millions of songs over a mobile network or Wi-Fi® connection. You can manage and edit your personal music library in the cloud from a variety of devices, or sync your playlists and music using a PC that runs the Windows® operating system. Go to www.sonyentertainmentnetwork.com for more information. Music Unlimited™ might not be available in all countries or regions. To open Music Unlimited™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . About the PlayNow™ service You can use the PlayNow™ service to download applications, music, games, ringtones and wallpapers. The PlayNow™ service offers both free and non-free downloads. Note that payment options for non-free applications may vary per country. The PlayNow™ service is not available in all countries. Before you download content Before you download, make sure that you have an Internet connection. Also, you may need to have a memory card inserted in your device to download content. When you download content to your device, you might be charged for the amount of data transferred. Contact your operator for information about data transfer rates in your country. To start PlayNow™ From the Home screen, tap Find and tap . Downloading from the PlayNow™ service Download a range of content from the PlayNow™ service direct to your device. Choose from a variety of applications, games, music, ringtones and other content. Note that payment options for non-free applications may vary per country. 65 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To download a PlayNow item to your device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap PlayNow™. Find an item you want to download by browsing categories, or by using the search function. Tap the item to view its details. Click “Buy now!” to start the purchase process. After your purchase has been validated, you can start to download your content. 66 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. FM radio About the FM radio The FM radio in your device works like any FM radio. For example, you can browse and listen to FM radio stations and save them as favourites. You must connect a wired headset or headphones to your device before you can use the radio. This is because the headset or headphones act as an antenna. After one of these devices is connected, you can then switch the radio sound to the speaker, if desired. When you open the FM radio, available channels appear automatically. If a channel has RDS information, it appears a few seconds after you start listening to the channel. To start the FM radio Connect a headset or a set of headphones to your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap FM radio . The available channels appear as you scroll through the frequency band. When you start the FM radio, available channels appear automatically. If a channel has RDS information, it appears a few seconds after you start listening to the channel. • To move between radio channels Flick your finger up or down along the frequency band. To select the radio region When the radio is open, press . Tap Set radio region. Select an option. To adjust the visualizer When the radio is open, tap . Tap Visualiser. Select an option. FM radio overview Radio on/off button View menu options Move up the frequency band to search for a channel A saved favourite channel Move down the frequency band to search for a channel Tuning dial 67 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 7 Save or remove a channel as a favourite Tuned frequency Using your favourite radio channels You can save the radio channels you most frequently listen to as favourites. By using favourites you can quickly return to a radio channel. To save a channel as a favourite When the radio is open, navigate to the channel that you want to save as a favourite. Tap . Enter a name and select a colour for the channel, then press Save. To remove a channel as a favourite When the radio is open, navigate to the channel that you want to remove. Tap , then tap Delete. Making a new search for radio channels If you have moved to a new location or the reception has improved in your current location, you can start a new scan for radio channels. Any favourites you have saved are not affected by a new scan. To start a new search for radio channels When the radio is open, press . Tap Search for channels. The radio scans the whole frequency band, and all available channels are displayed. Sound settings Switching the radio sound between devices You can listen to the radio through a wired headset or through wired headphones. Once either device is connected, you can switch the sound to the speaker, if desired. To switch the radio sound to the speaker When the radio is open, press . Tap Play in speaker. To switch the sound back to the wired headset or headphones, press and tap Play in headphones. Switching between mono and stereo sound mode You can listen to your FM radio in either mono or stereo mode. In some situations, switching to mono mode can reduce noise and improve sound quality. To switch between mono and stereo sound mode When the radio is open, press . Tap Enable stereo sound. To listen to the radio in mono sound mode again, press and tap Force mono sound. Identifying radio tracks using TrackID™ Use TrackID™ technology to identify music tracks as they play on your device's FM radio. 68 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To identify a song on the FM radio using TrackID™ While the song is playing on your device's FM radio, tap TrackID™. A progress indicator appears while the TrackID™ application samples the song. If successful, you are presented with a track result or a list of possible tracks. to return to the FM Radio. Press The TrackID™ application and the TrackID™ service are not supported in all countries/regions, or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 69 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Camera About the camera The camera in your device is equipped with the highly sensitive Exmor R sensor, which helps you capture sharp photos and videos even in low lighting conditions. From the camera, you can, for example, send your photos and videos to friends as messages, or upload them to a web service. Your device also has a front camera, which is useful for self-portraits. Camera controls overview Zoom in or out Main camera screen Camera key – Activate the camera/Take photos/Record videos View photos and videos Take photos or record video clips Go back a step or exit the camera Switch between front and main camera Camera setting icons Front camera • To open the camera When the screen is active, press and hold down the camera key. • To close the camera Press from the main camera screen. Using the still camera There are three ways to take photos with the still camera. You can press the camera key, tap the on-screen camera button, or touch a spot on the screen. To take a photo using the camera key Activate the camera. Press the camera key fully down. 70 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To take a photo by tapping the on-screen camera button Activate the camera. Point the camera towards the subject. Tap the on-screen camera button . The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. To take a self-portrait using the front camera Activate the camera. Tap the icon on the top left of the screen, then find and select Front camera. To take the photo, press the camera key. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. • To use the zoom function When the camera is open, press the volume key up or down to zoom in or out. To use the still camera flash When the camera is open, tap . Tap Flash, and select your desired flash setting. Take the photo. To view your photos and videos Open the camera, then tap a thumbnail at the top right of the screen to open a photo or video. Flick left or right to view your photos and videos. Videos are identified by . To delete a photo Open the photo that you want to delete. Tap an empty area of the screen to make Tap . Tap OK to confirm. appear. Face detection You can use face detection to bring an off-centre face into focus. The camera automatically detects up to five faces, indicated by white frames. A yellow frame shows which face has been selected for focus. Focus is set to the face closest to the camera. You can also tap one of the frames to select which face should be in focus. To turn on face detection Activate the camera. Tap the icon on the top left of the screen, then select Normal. To display all settings, tap . Tap Focus mode > Face detection. To take a photo using face detection When the camera is open and Face detection turned on, point the camera at your subject. Up to five faces can be detected, and each detected face is framed. Press the camera key halfway down. A yellow frame shows which face is in focus. To take the photo, press the camera key fully down. Using Smile Shutter™ to capture smiling faces Use Smile Shutter™ technology to photograph a face just as it smiles. The camera detects up to five faces and selects one face for smile detection and auto focus. When the selected face smiles, the camera automatically takes a photo. 71 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To turn on Smile Shutter™ Activate the camera. To display all settings, tap . Tap Smile Shutter and select a smile level. To take a photo using Smile Shutter™ When the camera is open and Smile Shutter is turned on, point the camera at your subject. The camera selects which face to focus on. The face selected appears inside a green frame and the photo is taken automatically. If no smile is detected, press the camera key to take the photo manually. Adding the geographical position to your photos Turn on geotagging to add the approximate geographical location (a geotag) to photos when you take them. The geographical location is determined either by wireless networks (mobile or Wi-Fi® networks) or GPS technology. When appears on the camera screen, geotagging is turned on but the geographical position has not been found. When appears, geotagging is turned on and the geographical location is available, so your photo can get geotagged. When neither of these two symbols appears, geotagging is turned off. To turn on geotagging Activate the camera. Tap , then tap Geotagging > On. Tap OK to agree to enable GPS and/or wireless networks. Check the options that you want to select under Location services. to return to the camera screen. After you confirm your settings, press If appears on the camera screen, your location is available and your photo can get geotagged. If not, check your GPS and/or wireless network connection. Using still camera settings To adjust the still camera settings Activate the camera. To display all settings, tap . Select the setting that you want to adjust, then edit as desired. To customise the still camera settings panel When the camera is open, tap to display all settings. Touch and hold the setting you want to move and drag it to the desired position. If you drag the setting outside of the settings panel, the change is cancelled. Still camera settings overview Superior auto Optimise your settings to suit any scene. Burst Use the Burst speed shooting mode to capture several photos in quick succession by keeping your finger pressed on the shutter button. You can choose between three burst speeds, which come with different resolution levels, that is, different picture sizes. Normal Front camera Select the front camera if you want to take self-portrait photos. 72 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Picture effect Apply effects to photos. Scene selection Use a pre-programmed scene type to quickly set the camera for common situations. Sweep Panorama Use this setting to take wide-angle, panoramic photos. Just press the camera key and move the camera steadily from one side to the other. Resolution Choose between several picture sizes and aspect ratios before taking a photo. A photo with a higher resolution requires more memory. 13 MP 4:3 13 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 13MP is available in the following conditions: select Normal capturing mode and HDR is off; select Scene mode except in Backlight Correction HDR mode. 12 MP 4:3 12 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 12MP is maximum resoluted in Superior Auto mode. 9 MP 16:9 9 megapixel picture size with 16:9 aspect ratio. A high resolution widescreen format. Has a higher resolution than full HD. Suitable for photos you want to view on widescreen displays. 5MP 4:3 5 megapixel picture size with 4:3 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on nonwidescreen displays or print in high resolution. 2MP 16:9 2 megapixel picture size with 16:9 aspect ratio. Suitable for photos you want to view on widescreen displays. VGA VGA format with 4:3 aspect ratio. 640x480 pixels. 12 MP is the maximum resolution available when photos are taken using Superior auto mode; when HDR is turned on in Normal mode; or when Scenes (Backlight correction HDR mode) mode is selected. The 13 MP resolution is only available when Normal capturing mode is selected and HDR is turned off, and when Scenes mode is selected (except in Backlight correction HDR mode). Flash Use the flash to take photos when lighting conditions are poor or when there is a backlight. Auto The camera automatically determines if the lighting conditions require the use of a flash. Fill flash Use this setting when the background is brighter than the subject. This removes unwanted dark shadows. Off The flash is turned off. Sometimes photo quality can be better without the flash, even if lighting conditions are poor. Taking a good photo without using the flash requires a steady hand. Use the self-timer to avoid blurred photos. Red-eye reduction Reduces the red colour of eyes when taking a photo. Self-timer With the self-timer you can take a photo without holding the device. Use this function to take self-portraits, or group photos where everyone can be in the photo. You can also use the self-timer to avoid shaking the camera when taking photos. 73 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. On (10 s.) Set a 10-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the photo is taken. On (2 s.) Set a 2-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the photo is taken. Off The photo is taken as soon as you tap the camera screen. Smile Shutter™ Use the smile shutter function to determine what kind of smile the camera reacts to before taking a photo. Quick launch Use Quick launch settings to launch the camera from the lock screen. If the device is in sleep mode of camera, press the camera key. Launch and capture By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first photo is captured immediately after the camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (still camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the still camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch and record video By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first video is shot immediately after the camera video camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (video camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the video camera is launched from sleep mode. Off Focus mode The focus function controls which part of a photo should be sharp. When continuous autofocus is on, the camera keeps adjusting focus so that the area within the yellow focus frame stays sharp. Single auto focus The camera automatically focuses on the selected subject. Continuous autofocus is on. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Multi auto focus The focus is automatically set on several areas of the image. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Continuous autofocus is off. Face detection The camera automatically detects up to five human faces, indicated by frames on the screen. The camera automatically focuses on the nearest face. You can also select which face to focus on by tapping it on the screen. When you tap the camera screen, a blue frame shows which face is selected and in focus. Face detection cannot be used for all scene types. Continuous autofocus is on. Touch focus Touch a specific area on the camera screen to set the area of focus. Continuous autofocus is off. Touch and hold the camera screen until the yellow focus frame turns blue, indicating that the focus is set. The photo is taken when you release your finger. Object tracking When you select an object by touching it in the viewfinder, the camera tracks it for you. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Exposure value 74 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Determine the amount of light in the photo you want to take. A higher value indicates an increased amount of light. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. HDR Use the HDR (High Dynamic Range) setting to take a photo against strong back light or in conditions where the contrast is sharp. HDR compensates for the loss of detail and produces a picture that is representative of both dark and bright areas. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. White balance The white balance setting adjusts the colour balance according to the lighting conditions. Auto Adjusts the colour balance automatically to suit the lighting conditions. Incandescent Adjusts the colour balance for warm lighting conditions, such as under light bulbs. Fluorescent Adjusts the colour balance for fluorescent lighting. Daylight Adjusts the colour balance for sunny outdoor conditions. Cloudy Adjusts the colour balance for a cloudy sky. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. ISO You can reduce image blurring caused by dark conditions or moving subjects by increasing the ISO sensitivity. Auto Sets the ISO sensitivity automatically. 100 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 100. 200 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 200. 400 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 400. 800 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 800. 1600 Sets the ISO sensitivity to 1600. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Metering This function automatically determines a well-balanced exposure by measuring the amount of light striking the image you want to capture. Centre Adjusts the exposure to the centre of the image. Average Calculates the exposure based on the amount of light striking the whole image. 75 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Spot Adjusts the exposure in a very small part of the image that you want to capture. This setting is only available in Normal capturing mode. Image stabiliser When taking a photo, it can be difficult to hold the device steady. The stabiliser helps you by compensating for small movements of the hand. Geotagging Tag photos with details of where you took them. On When geotagging is turned on, the approximate geographical location is added to photos when you take them. To use geotagging, you must enable location features from the Settings menu. For geotags to be added to a photo, the location must be determined before you take the photo. Your location is determined when appears on the camera screen. When your device is searching for your position, appears. Off When geotagging is turned off, you cannot view the location where you took a photo. Auto upload Automatically upload updates to photos to a pre-selected social networking service (SNS). Touch capture Identify a particular focus area by touching the camera screen with your finger. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. This setting is only available when focus mode is set to touch focus. On Off Shutter sound Choose to turn on or turn off the shutter sound when you record a video. Data storage You can choose to save your data either to a removable SD card or to your device's internal storage. Internal storage Photos or videos are saved on the device memory. SD card Photos or videos are saved on the SD card. Using the video camera To record a video using the camera key Activate the camera. To start recording a video, press the camera key. To stop recording, press the camera key again. Shoot your videos in landscape orientation to get the best results. 76 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To record a video by tapping the screen Activate the camera. Point the camera towards the subject. Tap to start recording. Tap to stop recording. Shoot your videos in landscape orientation to get the best results. To play recorded videos Activate the camera. Tap the thumbnails at the top right of the screen. Flick left or right to browse all photo and video files. Videos are identified by Tap to play a video. To stop playing the video, tap or . To delete a recorded video Browse to the video that you want to delete. Tap an empty area of the screen to make appear. Tap . Tap OK to confirm. Using video camera settings To adjust the video camera settings Activate the camera. Tap one of the settings icons on the screen. To display all settings, tap . Select the setting that want to adjust, then make your changes. To customise the video camera settings panel When the video camera is open, tap to display all settings. Touch and hold the setting that you want to move, then drag it to the desired position. If you drag the setting outside of the settings panel, the change is cancelled. Video camera settings overview Scenes The Scenes feature helps you to quickly set up the camera for common situations using pre-programmed scenes. The camera determines a number of settings for you to fit the selected scene, ensuring the best possible video. Off The Scenes feature is off and you can shoot videos manually. Soft snap Use for shooting videos against soft backgrounds. Landscape Use for videos of landscapes. The camera focuses on distant objects. Night When turned on, light sensitivity is increased. Use in poorly lit environments. Videos of fast-moving objects may get blurred. Hold your hand steady, or use a support. Turn off night mode when lighting conditions are good, to improve the video quality. Beach Use in bright environments to avoid overexposed videos. Snow Use in bright environments to avoid overexposed videos. Sports 77 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Use for videos of fast-moving objects. Short exposure time minimises motion blurring. Party Use for indoor videos in poorly lit environments. This scene picks up indoor background lighting or candlelight. Videos of fast-moving objects may get blurred. Hold your hand steady, or use a support. Video resolution Adjust the video resolution for different formats. 1920×1080(16:9) Full HD (Full High Definition) format with 16:9 aspect ratio. 1920×1080 pixels. 1280×720(16:9) HD (High Definition) format with 16:9 aspect ratio. 1280×720 pixels. 640×480(4:3) VGA format with 4:3 aspect ratio. 640x480 pixels. 176×144(11:9) Record videos suitable for sending in multimedia messages. The recording time of this video format is limited to fit in a multimedia message. Photo light Use the light to record videos when lighting conditions are poor or when there is a backlight. On Off Sometimes the video quality can be better without a light, even if lighting conditions are poor. Self-timer With the self-timer you can record a video without holding the device. Use it to record group videos where everyone can be in the video. You can also use the self-timer to avoid shaking the camera when recording videos. On (10 s.) Set a 10-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the video begins to record. On (2 s.) Set a 2-second delay from when you tap the camera screen until the video begins to record. Off The video begins to record as soon as you tap the camera screen. Quick launch Use Quick launch settings to launch the camera from the lock screen. If the device is in sleep mode of camera, press the camera key. Launch and capture By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first photo is captured immediately after the camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (still camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the still camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch and record video By pressing and holding down the camera key, the first video is shot immediately after the camera video camera is launched from sleep mode. Launch only (video camera) By pressing and holding down the camera key, the video camera is launched from sleep mode. Off 78 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Focus mode The focus setting controls which part of a video should be sharp. When continuous autofocus is on, the camera keeps adjusting focus so that the area within the white focus frame stays sharp. Single auto focus The camera automatically focuses on the selected subject. Continuous autofocus is on. Face detection The camera automatically detects up to five human faces, indicated by frames on the screen. The camera automatically focuses on the nearest face. You can also select which face to focus on by tapping it on the screen. When you tap the camera screen, a yellow frame shows which face is selected and in focus. Face detection cannot be used for all scene types. Continuous autofocus is on. Object tracking When you select an object by touching it in the viewfinder, the camera tracks it for you. Exposure value This setting allows you to determine the amount of light in the image you capture. A higher value indicates an increased amount of light. White balance The white balance setting adjusts the colour balance according to the lighting conditions. Auto Adjust the colour balance automatically to the lighting conditions. Incandescent Adjusts the colour balance for warm lighting conditions, such as under light bulbs. Fluorescent Adjust the colour balance for fluorescent lighting. Daylight Adjust the colour balance for sunny outdoor conditions. Cloudy Adjust the colour balance for a cloudy sky. Metering This function automatically determines a well-balanced exposure by measuring the amount of light striking the image that you want to capture. Centre Adjust the exposure to the centre of the image. Average Calculate the exposure based on the amount of light striking the whole image. Spot Adjust the exposure in a very small part of the image that you want to capture. Geotagging Tag photos with details of where you took them. On When geotagging is turned on, the approximate geographical location is added to photos when you take them. To use geotagging, you must enable location features from the Settings menu. For geotags to be added to a photo, the location must be determined before you take the photo. Your location is determined when appears on the camera screen. When your device is searching for your position, appears. Off When geotagging is turned off, you cannot view the location where you took a photo. 79 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Microphone Select whether to pick up the surrounding sound when recording videos. Touch capture Identify a particular focus area by touching the camera screen with your finger. The photo is taken as soon as you release your finger. This setting is only available when focus mode is set to touch focus. On Off Shutter sound Choose to turn on or turn off the shutter sound when you record a video. Data storage You can choose to save your data either to a removable SD card or to your device's internal storage. Internal storage Photos or videos are saved on the device memory. SD card Photos or videos are saved on the SD card. 80 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Album About Album Use Album to view photos and play videos that you’ve taken with your camera, or to view similar content that you've saved to your device. You can add geotags to your photos and videos, and then view them on a world map. In Album, you can also view photos and videos that you've uploaded to an online service, for example, to a Picasa™ web album or to Facebook™. From Album, you can share your favourite photos and videos with friends via Bluetooth™ wireless technology, email, messaging and various online services. You can also perform basic editing tasks on photos and set them as wallpaper or contact pictures. For more information, see Connecting your device to a computer on page 104. Album tab overview • • The following tabs are available in Album: Pictures – view all photos and videos saved on your device. My albums – view your online albums, and your geotagged photos and video clips on a world map . To open Album From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Album. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. Mobile BRAVIA® Engine Sony's Mobile BRAVIA® Engine technology improves the viewing quality of photos and videos after you take them, giving you clearer, sharper and more natural images. Mobile BRAVIA Engine is turned on by default, but you can turn it off if you want to reduce battery consumption. To turn on Mobile BRAVIA® Engine From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Display. Mark the Mobile BRAVIA Engine 2 checkbox if it is not marked. Viewing photos and videos in the Pictures tab In the Pictures tab in Album, you can view your photos and videos in thumbnails in a grid view. 81 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Overview of Pictures tab Grid view of photos and videos. View menu options. Scroll up or down to view content. Tap a photo or video to view it. The date and number of items in the group below. To view photos and videos in grid view From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album. All photos and videos are displayed in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. • To change the size of the thumbnails in Album When viewing thumbnails of photos and videos in Album, spread two fingers apart to zoom in, or pinch two fingers together to zoom out. To work with batches of photos or videos in Album When viewing thumbnails of photos and videos in Album, tap , then tap Select items. Tap the items you want to work with. Selected items are indicated by a blue frame. Use the tools in the toolbar at the top of the screen to work with your selected items. To activate selection mode, you can also touch and hold an item until its frame turns blue. Then you can tap other items to select them. Viewing photos and videos in the My albums tab The following tiles are available in My albums: • • Camera albums – view all photos and videos taken with your device’s camera. Internal memory – view all photos and videos saved to your device's internal storage. 82 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • My SD card – view all photos and videos saved to a removable memory card in your device. Overview of My albums tab View photos and videos using the PlayMemories online service. View photos and videos on Facebook™. View photos and videos in Picasa™. View your photos on a map. View all photos and videos saved to your device's internal storage. View all photos and videos saved to the removable memory card. View your photos in globe mode. View all photos and videos taken with your device’s camera. To view content in list view in the Camera albums tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Camera albums. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. To view content in list view in the Internal memory tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Internal memory. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. 83 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view content in list view in the My SD card tile From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > My SD card. Tap a folder that you want to open. The folder's content appears in a chronologically ordered grid. Videos are indicated by . Tap a photo or video to view it. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. If the screen orientation does not change automatically when you turn your device sideways, mark the Auto-rotate screen checkbox under Settings > Display. Working with photos in Album You can edit photos in Album. For example, you can crop photos, associate them with contacts, or use them as wallpaper. • • To zoom a photo When you are viewing a photo, double-tap the screen to zoom in. Double-tap again to zoom out. When you are viewing a photo, spread two fingers apart to zoom in, or pinch two fingers together to zoom out. To watch a slideshow of your photos When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Slideshow to start playing all the photos in an album. Tap a photo to end the slideshow. To watch a slideshow of your photos with music When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > SensMe™ slideshow. Select the music and theme that you want to use for the slideshow, then tap . The Album application analyses your photos and uses SensMe™ music data to play a slideshow. To pause playing, tap the screen to display the controls, then tap . For more information about SensMe™, see Categorising your music using SensMe™ channels on page 62. To rotate a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap Select Rotate left or Rotate right. The photo is saved in the new orientation. To crop a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Edit photo > Crop. To adjust the crop frame, touch and hold the edge of the crop frame. When the squares at the edges disappear, drag inward or outward to resize the frame. To resize all sides of the crop frame at the same time, touch and hold one of the four corners to make the squares at the edges disappear, then drag the corner accordingly. To move the crop frame to another area of the photo, touch and hold inside the frame, then drag it to the desired position. To save a copy of the photo as you cropped it, tap Save. The original uncropped version remains on your device. To use a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Use as. Select an option from the list that appears. Follow the relevant steps to use the photo. 84 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. • To edit a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Edit photo. To share a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap In the menu that opens, tap the application that you want to use to share the photo, then follow the steps to send it. To add a geotag to a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to open the map screen. Find and tap the desired location to put the photo on the map. To adjust the location of the photo, tap the location on the map to where you want to move the photo. When you are finished, tap OK to save the geotag and return to the photo viewer. When a photo is geotagged, to view the photo on a map. appears along with location information. You can tap this icon To delete a photo When you are viewing a photo, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap Tap OK. Working with videos in Album Use Album to watch videos that you’ve taken with the camera, downloaded, or copied to your device. You can also share your videos with friends, for example, by uploading them to online services. To play a video Open the Pictures tab or the My albums tab in Album. Using grid view or list view, locate the video that you want to open. Tap the video to play it. If the playback controls are not displayed, tap the screen to display them. To hide the controls, tap the screen again. To pause a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap . To fast forward and rewind a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Drag the progress bar marker left to rewind, or right to fast forward. • To adjust the volume of a video Press the volume key. To share a video When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap > Share. In the menu that opens, tap the application that you want to use to share the selected video, then follow the relevant steps to send it. You might not be able to copy, send or transfer copyright-protected items. Also, some items may not send if the file size is too large. 85 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To delete a video In Album, find the video you want to delete. Touch and hold the video to activate selection mode. The frame of the video thumbnail turns blue when it is selected. Tap , then tap OK. Viewing your photos on a map If you enable location detection when taking photos, you can use the information gathered at a later stage. For example, you can view your photos on a map and show friends and family where you were when you took the photo. Adding location information is also referred to as geotagging. When you enable location detection, you can select to use either GPS satellites or wireless networks, or both, to find your position. Overview of Maps tile Search a location on the map. View menu options. A group of photos and/or videos geotagged with the same location. Double tap to zoom in. Pinch to zoom out. Drag to view different parts of the map. Thumbnails of the selected group of photos and/or videos. Tap an item to view it in full screen. To enable location detection From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Location services. Mark the GPS satellites and/or Google's location service checkboxes. To view geotagged photos on a map in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Maps. Tap a photo to view it in full screen. If several photos were taken at the same location, only one of them appears on the map. The total number of photos appears in the top right corner, for example, . To view these photos, tap the cover photo and then tap one of the thumbnails at the bottom of the screen. When viewing a geotagged photo in the photo viewer, you can touch the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the photo on the map. 86 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view geotagged photos on a globe in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums > Globe. Tap a photo to view it in full screen. If several photos were taken at the same location, only one of them appears on the map. The total number of photos appears in the top right corner, for example, . To view these photos, tap the cover photo and then tap one of the thumbnails at the bottom of the screen. When viewing a geotagged photo from the camera application, you can touch the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the photo on the map. To add a geotag when viewing the map in Album When viewing the map in Album, tap , then tap Add geotag. Find and tap the photo to which you want to add the geotag. Tap the desired location on the map to set the geotag, then tap OK. To edit the geotag of a photo in Album When viewing a photo on the map in Album, touch and hold the photo until its frame turns blue. Drag the photo to the new location. You can also tap the desired location on the map instead of dragging. • To change the map view in Album When viewing the map in Album, tap , then select Classic view, Globe view or Satellite view. Viewing online albums In Album, view the photos and videos that you and your friends have uploaded to online services, such as Picasa™ and Facebook™. You can view comments from your friends and add your own comments as well. Overview of online services Active online service. Name of online album. Number of items in the online album. Refresh. View menu options. 87 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 • To view photos from online services in Album From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums. Tap the desired online service. Tap Connect. All available online albums that you have uploaded to the service are displayed. Tap any album to view its content, then tap a photo in the album. Flick left to view the next photo or video. Flick right to view the previous photo or video. To view and add comments to online album content When viewing a photo from an online album, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to view the comments. To view more comments, scroll down the screen. To add your own comments, enter your comments at the bottom of the screen, then tap Post. To "Like" a photo or video on Facebook™ While viewing a photo or video from one of your Facebook™ albums, tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap to show that you "Like" the item on Facebook™. 88 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Movies About Movies Use the Movies application to play movies and other video content that you’ve saved on your device. The Movies application also helps you get poster art, plot summaries, genre info and director details for each movie. You can also play your movies on other devices that are connected to the same network. Videos taken with your device's camera are displayed in the Album application, not in the Movies application. Overview of Movies All video categories available on your device. Browse all movies. Browse content on other connected DLNA Certified™ devices. Browse all TV shows. Manage video content from Video Unlimited™. View menu options. Video Unlimited™ may not be available in all countries or regions. Using Movies To play a video in Movies From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to play. Tap the video you want to select, then tap to play it. To display or hide the controls, tap the screen. To pause playing, tap . To rewind, drag the progress bar marker left. To fast forward, drag the progress bar marker right. 89 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To play a video in full screen When a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap . To play the video in its original size, tap To share a video When a video saved under Movies or TV shows is playing, tap , then tap Share. Tap the application that you want to use to share the selected video, then follow the relevant steps to send it. To get movie information manually Make sure that your device has an active data connection. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Tap , then make sure that the Get video details checkbox is marked. Open the Movies or TV shows tab and browse to the thumbnail of a file that you want to get information about. Touch and hold the thumbnail for the video, then tap Search for info. In the search field, enter keywords for the video, then tap the confirm key on the keyboard. All matches are displayed in a list. Select a search result, then tap Done. The download of the information begins. You also get information about newly added videos automatically when the Movies application is opened and the Get video details checkbox is marked. Data transmission charges may apply. If the downloaded information is not correct, tap keywords. and search again using different To clear information about a video From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to edit. Touch and hold the video thumbnail, then tap Clear info. To play a video on an external device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies > . Tap Throw, then select a device from the list. Select the video that you want to play. To change the sound settings while a video is playing While a video is playing, tap the screen to display the controls. Tap , then tap Sound settings. Mark the checkboxes for the sound settings that you want to activate. When you're finished, tap OK. To delete a video From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies. Select a video category and browse to the video that you want to delete. Touch and hold the video thumbnail, then tap Delete from the list that appears. Tap Delete again to confirm. 90 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Video Unlimited™ About Video Unlimited™ Use the Video Unlimited™ service to rent and purchase videos that you can view not only on your Android device, but also on a PC, PlayStation® Portable (PSP®) or PlayStation® 3. Select your pick from the latest Hollywood releases, action movies, comedies, classics, and a range of other categories. Video Unlimited™ might not be available in all countries or regions. To open Video Unlimited™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . Video Unlimited™ menu overview View your account information Search for a video View the download status for all your items View and change settings for your account, purchases, and downloads Add the current video to a wish list Delete all items in your wish list Delete the video you're currently viewing from the wish list Share information about the current video via a social network, email, Bluetooth or other method View legal information The Video Unlimited™ menu is dynamic, which means that all options are not always available. For example, the option to delete all items in your wish list is only available when you are viewing the list. • To open the Video Unlimited™ menu Open Video Unlimited, then tap . Creating a Video Unlimited™ account You need to create a Video Unlimited™ account if you want to buy or rent movies through the Video Unlimited™ service. Exploring the Video Unlimited™ selection Browse videos by category, or enter text to search for a particular item. You can also choose to preview videos you're interested in. Renting or buying a video When you rent a video, you have a fixed amount of time in which to view it. This time period varies from market to market. You can also choose to download a purchased video to most Sony™ devices that are connected to your Video Unlimited™ account. Video Unlimited™ notifications overview When you buy or rent videos, the following notifications may appear: 91 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Downloading of video is completed Downloading has failed. You need to check that, for example, your device is connected to a Wi-Fi® network, and that you have enough free space on your memory card. Downloading of video is ongoing Downloading is paused Confirmation of successful purchase Rental countdown period has started Watching a video from Video Unlimited™ You can watch your rented or purchased videos on most Sony™ device that are connected to your Video Unlimited™ account. Video menu overview When you watch a video from Video Unlimited™, you can open a menu to get the following options: Delete the current video View information about the current video Change the audio language Change the language of subtitles, or remove subtitles 92 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Web browser About the web browser The Google Chrome™ web browser for Android™ devices comes pre-installed in most markets. Go to http://support.google.com/chrome and click the "Chrome for Mobile" link to get more detailed information about how to use this web browser. Google Chrome™ is not available in all markets. To open the web browser From your Home screen, tap Find and tap . 93 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Connectivity Connecting to wireless networks You can access the Internet wirelessly from your device using Wi-Fi® technology. This way you can browse the web and share media files over the same Wi-Fi® network with other DLNA Certified™ devices, for example, TVs and computers. If your company or organisation has a virtual private network (VPN), you can connect to this network using your device. You can use a VPN to access intranets and other internal services at your company. Before using Wi-Fi® To browse the Internet using a Wi-Fi® connection, you need to search for and connect to an available Wi-Fi® network and then open the Internet browser. The signal strength of the Wi-Fi® network may differ depending on your device's location. Move closer to the Wi-Fi® access point to increase the signal strength. To turn on Wi-Fi® From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Drag the slider beside Wi-Fi® to the right to turn on the Wi-Fi® function. It may take a few seconds before Wi-Fi® is enabled. To connect to a Wi-Fi® network From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Make sure that the Wi-Fi® function is on. Tap Wi-Fi . Available Wi-Fi® networks are displayed. The available networks may be open and secured networks are or secured. Open networks are indicated by indicated by next to the Wi-Fi® network name. Tap a Wi-Fi® network to connect to it. If you are trying to connect to a secure is displayed in the status bar network, you are asked to enter a password. once you are connected. Your device remembers Wi-Fi® networks you connect to. The next time you come within reach of a previously connected Wi-Fi® network, your device automatically connects to it. In some locations, open Wi-Fi® networks require you to log in to a web page before you can get access to the network. Contact the relevant Wi-Fi® network administrator for more information. To connect to another Wi-Fi® network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Detected Wi-Fi® networks are displayed. Tap another Wi-Fi® network to connect to it. To scan for Wi-Fi® networks manually From your Home screen, tap to go to the Application screen. Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press , then tap Scan. Your device now scans for all available Wi-Fi® networks. To connect to a Wi-Fi® network, tap the network name from the list of available networks. 94 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To add a Wi-Fi® network manually Make sure that Wi-Fi® is turned on. From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi . Tap . Enter the Network SSID for the network. Tap the Security field to select a security type. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. The Wi-Fi® network name may be indicated as SSID, ESSID or Access Point. Contact your Wi-Fi® network administrator to get the Network SSID and password. Advanced Wi-Fi® settings Wi-Fi® network status When you are connected to a Wi-Fi® network or when there are Wi-Fi® networks available in your vicinity, it is possible to see the status of these Wi-Fi® networks. You can also enable your device to notify you whenever an open Wi-Fi® network is detected. To enable Wi-Fi® network notifications Turn on Wi-Fi®, if it is not already on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press . Tap Advanced. Mark the Network notification checkbox. To view detailed information about a connected Wi-Fi® network From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Tap the Wi-Fi® network that you are currently connected to. Detailed network information is displayed. Wi-Fi® sleep policy By adding a Wi-Fi® sleep policy, you can specify when to switch from Wi-Fi® to mobile data. If you are not connected to a Wi-Fi® network, your device uses a mobile data connection to access the Internet (if you have set up and enabled a mobile data connection on your device). To add a Wi-Fi® sleep policy From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Wi-Fi. Press . Tap Advanced. Tap Keep Wi-Fi on during sleep. Select an option. Sharing your mobile data connection You can share your device's mobile data connection with a single computer using a USB cable. This process is called USB tethering. You can also share your device's data connection with up to eight other devices at once, by turning your device into a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot. When your device is sharing its data connection, the following icons may appear in the status bar or in the Notification panel: USB tethering is active 95 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Portable Wi-Fi® hotspot is active To share your data connection using a USB cable Deactivate all USB cable connections to your device. Using the USB cable that came with your device, connect your device to a computer. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Mark the USB tethering checkbox. To stop sharing your data connection, unmark the USB tethering checkbox or disconnect the USB cable. You cannot share your device's data connection and SD card over a USB cable at the same time. You may need to prepare your computer to establish a network connection via USB cable. Go to www.android.com/tether to get the most current information. To use your device as a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings > Set up Wi-Fi hotspot. Enter the Network SSID for the network. Tap the Security field to select a security type. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. Mark the Portable Wi-Fi hotspot checkbox. Your device starts broadcasting its Wi-Fi network name (SSID). Up to eight computers or other devices can now connect to this network. Unmark the Portable Wi-Fi hotspot checkbox when you want to stop sharing your data connection via Wi-Fi®. To rename or secure your portable hotspot From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > Tethering & portable hotspot. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings > Set up Wi-Fi hotspot. Enter the Network SSID for the network. To select a security type, tap the Security field. If required, enter a password. Tap Save. Virtual private networks (VPNs) Use your device to connect to virtual private networks (VPNs), which allow you to access resources inside a secured local network from outside the actual network. For example, VPN connections are commonly used by corporations and educational institutions for users who need to access intranets and other internal services when they are outside of the internal network, for example, when they are travelling. VPN connections can be set up in many ways, depending on the network. Some networks may require you to transfer and install a security certificate in your device. For detailed information on how to set up a connection to your virtual private network, please contact the network administrator of your company or organisation. To add a virtual private network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > VPN. Tap Add VPN profile. Select the type of VPN to add. Enter your VPN settings. Tap Save. 96 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To connect to a virtual private network From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More… > VPN. In the list of available networks, tap the VPN that you want to connect to. Enter the required information. Tap Connect. To disconnect from a virtual private network Drag the status bar downwards. Tap the notification for the VPN connection to turn it off. Sharing content with DLNA Certified™ devices You can view or play media content saved to your device on other devices such as, for example, a TV, or a computer. Such devices must be DLNA Certified™ by the Digital Living Network Alliance and all devices must be connected to the same WiFi® network in order for content to be shared. You can also view or play content from other DLNA Certified™ devices on your device. After you set up the sharing of content between devices, you can, for example, listen to music files stored on your home computer from your device, or view photos taken with your device's camera on a large-screen TV. Playing files from DLNA Certified™ devices on your device When you play files from another DLNA Certified™ device on your device, this other device acts as a server. In other words, it shares content over a network. The server device must have its content sharing function enabled and give access permission to your device. It also must be connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. To play a shared track on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap WALKMAN. Tap My music to open the music library. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select the track that you want to play. The track starts playing automatically. To play a shared video on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Movies > Devices. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select the video that you want to play. To view a shared photo on your device Make sure the devices that you want to share files with are connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album > My albums. All your available online albums and connected devices are displayed. Select a device from the list of connected devices. Browse the folders of the connected device and select a photo to view it. Preparing to play content from your device on DLNA Certified™ devices Before you can view or play media files from your device on other DLNA Certified™ devices, you must set up file sharing on your device. The devices that you share content with are called client devices. For example, a TV, computer or tablet can act 97 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. as client devices. Your device works as a media server when it makes content available to client devices. When you set up file sharing on your device, you must also give access permission to client devices. After you do so, such devices appear as registered devices. Devices that are waiting for access permission are listed as pending devices. To set up file sharing with other DLNA Certified™ devices Connect your device to a Wi-Fi® network. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. To turn on the Share content function, drag the slider. appears in the status bar. Your device can now work as a media server. Connect your computer or other devices to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. A notification appears in the status bar of your device. Open the notification and set the relevant access permissions for other devices. The instructions described above may differ depending on the client devices used. Refer to your client device User guide for more information. If the device cannot connect, check that your Wi-Fi® network is working. You can also access the Media server menu under Settings > More… > Media server settings. If you close the Media server view, file sharing function function stays running in the background. To stop sharing files with other DLNA Certified™ devices From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Drag the slider to turn off the Share content function. To set access permissions for a pending device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Pending devices list. Select an access permission level. To change the name of a registered device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Registered devices list, then select Change name. Enter a new name for the device. To change the access level of a registered device From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Select a device from the Registered devices list. Tap Change access level and select an option. To get help about sharing content with other DLNA Certified™ devices From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap . Tap My music to open the music library. Press , then tap Media server. Tap . 98 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Playing files on a Digital Media Renderer device Using DLNA™ technology, you can push media content saved on your device to another device connected to the same Wi-Fi® network. The other device must be able to function as a Digital Media Renderer (DMR) device, which means that it can render, or play, content received from your device. A DMR device can be, for example, a TV with DLNA function, or a PC running Windows® 7 or higher. The settings for enabling the Digital Media Renderer may vary depending on the device used. Refer to the user guide for the respective device for more detailed information. To view photos or videos from your device on a DMR device Make sure that you have correctly set up the DMR device and that it is connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Album. Browse to and open the file that you want to view. Tap the screen to display the toolbars, then tap and select a DMR device to share your content with. The selected files start playing in chronological order on the device that you select. To disconnect from the DMR device, tap and select My phone. The file stops playing on the DMR device but continues playing on your device. You can also share a video from the Movies application on your device by tapping the video and then tapping . To play a music track from your device on a DMR device Make sure that you have correctly set up the DMR device and that it is connected to the same Wi-Fi® network as your device. From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap WALKMAN. Tap My music to open the music library. Select a music category and browse to the track that you want to share, then tap the track. Tap and select a DMR device to share your content with. The track plays automatically on the device that you select. To disconnect from the DMR device, tap and select My phone. The track stops playing on the DMR device but continues playing on your device. NFC Use Near Field Communications (NFC) to share data with other devices, such as a video, photo, web page address, music file or contact. You can also use NFC to scan tags that give you more information about a product or service as well as tags that activate certain functions on your device. NFC is a wireless technology with a maximum range of one centimetre, so the devices sharing data must be held close to each other. Before you can use NFC, you must first turn on the NFC function, and the device's screen must be active. NFC may not be available in all countries and/or regions. To turn on the NFC function From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Mark the NFC checkbox. 99 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. NFC detection area The location of the NFC detection area is not the same on all devices. When sharing data with another device using NFC, refer to the User guide of the other device for more information. To share a contact with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To view contacts, go to your Home screen, tap , then tap . Tap the contact that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas of each device touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the contact appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the contact information is displayed on the screen of the receiving device and is also saved on the receiving device. To share a music file with another device using NFC Make sure that both your device and the receiving device have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To open the "WALKMAN" application, tap , then find and tap . Tap the My music tab to open the music library. Select a music category and browse to the track you want to share. Tap the track to play it. You can then tap to pause the track. The transfer works whether the track is playing or paused. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas of each device touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the track appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the music file plays immediately on the receiving device. At the same time, the file is saved on the receiving device. You might not be able to copy, send or transfer copyright-protected items. 100 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To share a photo or video with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. To view photos and videos in your device, go to your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Album. Tap the photo or video that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the photo or video appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the photo or video is displayed on the screen of the receiving device. At the same time, the item is saved on the receiving device. You can also use NFC to share a video from the Movies application. To share a web address with another device using NFC Make sure that both devices have the NFC function turned on, and that both screens are active. From your Home screen, tap . To open the web browser, find and tap . Load the web page that you want to share. Hold your device and the receiving device back to back so that the NFC detection areas touch each other. When the devices connect, they vibrate and play a short sound. A thumbnail of the web page appears. Tap the thumbnail to start the transfer. When the transfer is done, the web page is displayed on the screen of the receiving device. Scanning NFC tags Your device can scan various kinds of NFC tags. For example, it can scan embedded tags on a poster, on a billboard advertisement, or beside a product in a retail store. You can receive additional information, such as a web address. To scan an NFC tag Make sure that your device has the NFC function turned on and that the screen is active. Place your device over the tag so that the NFC detection area touches it. Your device scans the tag and displays the content collected. Tap the content of the tag to open it. To open the tag, tap it. Paying for items with your device You can use the Operator wallet application on your device to pay for items in stores that support NFC payment methods. Just tap your device on specially enabled electronic payment pads to pay for your purchases. Payments are backed by a credit or debit card, or by prepaid cards or vouchers. Your payment information is stored in the payment application, so you don’t need to enter it every time. To use Operator wallet, your SIM card must have a secure element embedded. Contact your network operator for more details. Google Wallet™ Use the Google Wallet™ application to pay for goods at checkouts. If there is a supported NFC terminal at the checkout, you can just tap your device on the terminal to pay. Google Wallet™ stores details of your credit and debit cards as well as details of coupons and other special offers. Most major credit card types are supported. Security features include a PIN, encrypted storage and the ability to remotely disable a lost wallet. 101 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Operator wallet The Operator wallet application lets you access a variety of services provided by your network operator, such as the option to pay for items in underground trains and stores. Contact your network operator for more information about such services. To select a wallet for use on your device Make sure that the NFC function is on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > More…. Tap Wallet and select an option. Connecting to an NFC compatible device You can connect your device to other NFC compatible devices produced by Sony, such as a speaker or a headphone. When establishing this kind of connection, refer to the User guide of the compatible device for more information. You may need to have Wi-Fi® or Bluetooth™ activated on both devices for the connection to work. Bluetooth™ wireless technology Use the Bluetooth™ function to send files to other Bluetooth™ compatible devices, or to connect to handsfree accessories. Turn on the Bluetooth™ function in your device and create wireless connections to other Bluetooth™ compatible devices such as computers, handsfree accessories, and phones. Bluetooth™ connections work better within 10 metres (33 feet), with no solid objects in between. In some cases you have to manually pair your device with other Bluetooth™ devices. Interoperability and compatibility among Bluetooth™ devices can vary. To turn on the Bluetooth™ function and make your device visible From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings. Tap the on-off switch beside Bluetooth to turn on the Bluetooth™ function. Tap Bluetooth. Your device and a list of available Bluetooth™ devices appear. Tap your device name to make your device visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. To adjust your device's visibility time to other Bluetooth™ devices From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Visibility timeout. Select an option. Naming your device You can give your device a name. This name is shown to other devices after you have turned on the Bluetooth™ function and your device is set to visible. To give your device a name Make sure that the Bluetooth™ function is turned on. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Rename phone. Enter a name for your device. Tap Rename. 102 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Pairing with another Bluetooth™ device When you pair your device with another device, you can, for example, connect your device to a Bluetooth™ headset or a Bluetooth™ car kit and use these other devices to make and receive calls. Once you have paired your device with a Bluetooth™ device, your device will remember this pairing. When pairing your device with a Bluetooth™ device, you may need to enter a passcode. Your device will automatically try the generic passcode 0000. If this does not work, refer to the user guide for your Bluetooth™ device to get the device passcode. You do not need to re-enter the passcode the next time you connect to a paired Bluetooth™ device. Some Bluetooth™ devices, for example, most Bluetooth™ headsets, require you to both pair and connect with the other device. You can pair your device with several Bluetooth™ devices, but you can only connect to one Bluetooth™ profile at the same time. To pair your device with another Bluetooth™ device Make sure that the device you want to pair your device with has the Bluetooth™ function activated and is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. All available Bluetooth™ devices appear in a list. Tap the Bluetooth™ device that you want to pair with your device. Enter a passcode, if required, or confirm the same passcode on both devices. Your device and the Bluetooth™ device are now paired. To connect your device to another Bluetooth™ device If you are connecting to a Bluetooth device that requires you to first pair your device before connecting, follow the relevant steps to pair your device with that device. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Tap the Bluetooth™ device to which you want to connect your device. To unpair a Bluetooth™ device From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Under Paired devices, tap beside the name of the device that you want to unpair. Tap Unpair. Sending and receiving items using Bluetooth™ technology Share items with other Bluetooth™ compatible devices such as phones or computers. You can send and receive several kinds of items using the Bluetooth™ function, such as: • • • • Photos and videos Music and other audio files Contacts Web pages 103 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 10 To send items using Bluetooth™ Receiving device: Make sure the Bluetooth™ function is turned on and that the device is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. Sending device: Open the application which contains the item that you want to send, and scroll to the item. Depending on the application and the item you want to send, you may need to, for example, touch and hold the item, open the item or press . Other ways to send an item may exist. Select Share or Send. Select Bluetooth. Turn on Bluetooth™, if you are asked to do so. Tap the name of the receiving device. Receiving device: If asked, accept the connection. Sending device: If asked, confirm the transfer to the receiving device. Receiving device: Accept the incoming item. To receive items using Bluetooth™ Make sure that the Bluetooth™ function is on and is visible to other Bluetooth™ devices. The sending device now starts sending data to your device. If prompted, enter the same passcode on both devices, or confirm the suggested passcode. When you are notified of an incoming file to your device, drag the status bar downwards and tap the notification to accept the file transfer. Tap Accept to start the file transfer. To view the progress of the transfer, drag the status bar downwards. To open a received item, drag the status bar downwards and tap the relevant notification. To view files you have received using Bluetooth™ From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Bluetooth. Press and select Show received files. Connecting your device to a computer Connect your device to a computer and start transferring pictures, music and other file types. The easiest ways to connect are using a USB cable or Bluetooth wireless technology. When you connect your device to the computer using a USB cable, you are prompted to install the PC Companion application on your computer. PC Companion helps you access additional computer applications to transfer and organise media files, update your device, synchronise device content, and more. You might not be able to transfer some copyright-protected material between your device and a computer. Transferring and handling content using a USB cable Use a USB cable connection between a computer and your device for easy transfer and management of your files. Once the two devices are connected, you can drag and drop content between your device and the computer, or between your device's internal storage and SD card, using the computer's file explorer. If you're transferring music, video, pictures or other media files to your device, it's best to use the Media Go™ application on your computer. Media Go™ converts media files so that you can use them on your device. 104 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To transfer content between your device and computer using a USB cable Using a USB cable, connect your device to a computer. Internal storage & SD card connected appears in the status bar on the screen of your device. Computer: Open Microsoft® Windows® Explorer from the desktop and wait until your device's internal storage and your SD card appear as external disks in Microsoft® Windows® Explorer. Computer: Drag and drop the desired files between your device and the computer. To transfer content between internal storage and an SD card via USB Using a USB cable, connect your device to a computer. Internal storage & SD card connected appears in the status bar on the screen of your device. Computer: Open Microsoft® Windows® Explorer from the desktop and wait until your device's internal storage and your SD card appear as external disks in Microsoft® Windows® Explorer. Computer: Drag and drop the desired files between the device's internal storage and the SD card. To transfer files directly from internal storage to an SD card in the device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Storage > Transfer data to SD card. Mark the file types you want to transfer to the SD card. Tap Transfer. The direct transfer method means that a USB cable connection to a computer is not necessary. Transferring files using Media transfer mode via Wi-Fi® You can transfer files between your device and other MTP compatible devices, such as a computer, using a Wi-Fi® connection. Before connecting, you first need to pair the two devices. If you're transferring music, video, pictures or other media files between your device and a computer, it's best to use the Media Go™ application on the computer. Media Go™ converts media files so that you can use them on your device. In order to use this feature, you need a Wi-Fi® enabled device that supports Media transfer, for example, a computer running Microsoft® Windows Vista® or Windows® 7. To pair your device wirelessly with a computer using Media transfer mode Make sure Media transfer mode is enabled on your device. It is normally enabled by default. Connect your device to the computer using a USB cable. Computer: Once the name of your device appears on the screen, click Network configuration and follow the instructions to pair the computer. When you are finished pairing, disconnect the USB cable from both devices. The above instructions only work if Windows® 7 is installed on your computer and the computer is connected to a Wi-Fi® Access Point via a network cable. To connect paired devices wirelessly in Media transfer mode Make sure Media transfer mode is enabled on your device. It is normally enabled by default. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to connect to under Trusted devices. Tap Connect. Make sure the Wi-Fi® function is turned on. 105 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 4 To disconnect a wirelessly paired device in Media transfer mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to disconnect from under Trusted devices. Tap Disconnect. To remove a pairing with another device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > USB Connectivity. Tap the paired device that you want to remove. Tap Forget. PC Companion PC Companion is a computer application that gives you access to additional features and services which help you transfer music, video and pictures to and from your device. You can also use PC Companion to update your device and get the latest software version available. The installation files for PC Companion are saved on your device and the installation is launched from the device when you connect it to a computer via USB cable. You need an internet connected computer running one of the following operating systems to use the PC Companion application: • • • Microsoft® Windows® 7 Microsoft® Windows Vista® Microsoft® Windows® XP (Service Pack 3 or higher) To start PC Companion Make sure that PC Companion is installed on your PC. Open the PC Companion application on the PC, then click Start to open one of the features that you want to use. Media Go™ The Media Go™ computer application helps you transfer and manage media content in your device and computer. You can install and access Media Go™ from within the PC Companion application. You need one of these operating systems to use the Media Go™ application: • • • Microsoft® Windows® 7 Microsoft® Windows Vista® Microsoft® Windows® XP, Service Pack 3 or higher To transfer content using the Media Go™ application Connect your device to a computer using a supported USB cable. Device: In the status bar, Internal storage connected appears. Computer: Open the PC Companion application on the PC first. In PC Companion, click Media Go to start the Media Go™ application. In some cases, you may have to wait for Media Go™ to install. Using Media Go™, drag and drop files between your computer and device. Connecting your device to a TV set Connect your device to a TV set and start viewing content saved in your device on a larger screen. When you connect your device to the TV set, the TV launcher application opens. This application helps you to play media files from your device on TVs and other devices. You may have to purchase an MHL cable separately. 106 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To view content from your device on a TV which supports MHL input Connect your device to the TV using an MHL cable. appears in your device's status bar after a connection is established. The TV launcher application starts automatically. Follow the instructions to view your media files on the TV. To view content from your device on a TV which supports HDMI™ input Connect your device to an MHL-HDMI adaptor, and connect the adaptor to a USB power supply. Connect the adaptor to a TV using a HDMI™ cable. appears in your device's status bar after a connection is established. The TV launcher application starts automatically. Follow the instructions to view your media files on the TV. To view help about using the TV remote control While your device is connected to the TV set, drag the status bar downwards to open the Notification panel. Tap MHL connected. You can also press the yellow button on the TV remote control to open the Notification panel. • To disconnect your device from the TV set Disconnect the MHL™ cable or the MHL-HDMI adaptor from your device. Screen mirroring Use Screen mirroring to show the screen of your device on a TV or other large display without using a cable connection. Wi-Fi Direct™ technology creates a wireless connection between the two devices, so you can sit back and enjoy your favourite photos from the comfort of your couch. You can also use this feature to listen to music from your phone via the TV's speakers. Your TV must support screen mirroring based on Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Miracast™ for the functionality described above to work. If your TV does not support screen mirroring, you need to purchase a wireless display adapter separately. When using screen mirroring, the image quality may sometimes be negatively impacted if there is interference from other Wi-Fi® networks. To mirror the screen of your device on a TV screen Follow the instructions in the User guide for your TV to turn on the screen mirroring function. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Xperia™ > Screen mirroring. Tap Turn on Screen mirroring and select a device. When using screen mirroring, do not cover the Wi-Fi antenna area of your device. Scanning barcodes with the NeoReader™ application About scanning with the NeoReader™ application Use your device as a barcode scanner to find out more about items you scan. For example, you see a coat in a magazine ad and want to find the nearest retail outlet to buy it. If the ad contains a readable barcode, the NeoReader™ application uses this code to access mobile web content, such as a web page with more product information or a map of nearby outlets. NeoReader™ supports most standard barcode types. 107 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To start the NeoReader™ application From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap NeoReader™. To scan a barcode When the NeoReader™ application is open, hold your device over the barcode until the complete barcode is visible in the viewfinder. Your device automatically scans the barcode, and vibrates when the barcode is recognised. To enter a barcode manually When the NeoReader™ application is open, tap Enter the numbers of the barcode in the text field, then tap GO!. NeoReader™ application menu overview The following menu options are available in the NeoReader™ application: Tap to open more options Enter the barcode numbers manually. This option can be used if your camera has difficulty reading the barcode View a list of previously scanned barcodes View information about the NeoReader™ application. Read more about different barcode types, and about how to use NeoReader™ Select your personal settings, such as language or country. This information is used to personalise barcode content. Also, you can select preferences for how you use the NeoReader™ application Send a text message to invite a friend to download the NeoReader™ application Smart Connect About Smart Connect Use the Smart Connect application to set what happens in your device when you connect or disconnect an accessory. You can also use it to set a specific action or a group of actions to launch on your device at certain times of the day. For example, when you connect your headset or headphones, you can set an event so that the following actions are launched on your device: • • • Between 7am and 9am, when you commute to work, the WALKMAN player starts, and the web browser opens the morning paper. The ring volume is set to vibrate. Between office hours, a conference call app opens on your device. On the way back from work, the FM radio starts, and a notes app with your shopping list opens. To start the Smart Connect application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Smart Connect. 108 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a Smart Connect event Start the Smart Connection application. If you are opening Smart Connect for the first time, tap OK to close the introduction screen. On the Events tab, tap . Give the event a name, then tap Create. Under When, add either an accessory or a time interval, or both. Under Do this, add what you want to happen in your device. Under At the end, add what you want to happen when you disconnect the accessory or when the time interval comes to an end. If both these conditions are set, the actions start either when you disconnect the accessory, or when the time interval comes to an end. To save the event, press . To add a Bluetooth™ accessory, you have to first pair it with your device. To edit a Smart Connect event Start the Smart Connection application. On the Events tab, tap an event. If the event is switched off, tap . Adjust the settings as desired. To save the event, press . To delete an incorrect entry, touch and hold the entry and then tap Delete. 109 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Synchronising data on your device About synchronising data on your device You can sync contacts, email, calendar events, and other information with your device from multiple email accounts, synchronisation services and other kinds of accounts, depending on the applications installed on your device. Synchronising your device with other information sources is an easy and practical way to stay up to date. Synchronising with Google™ Synchronise your device with different Google™ services to keep your information up to date, regardless of which device you're using your Google™ account from. For example, you can synchronise your contacts, Gmail™, calendar and web browser data. To set up a Google™ account for synchronisation From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Google. Follow the registration wizard to create a Google™ account, or sign in if you already have an account. Mark the Back up & restore checkbox if you want to back up data to your Google™ account, then tap Next. Tap your newly created Google™ account, then tap the items you that want to synchronise. To synchronise manually with your Google™ account From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise. Press , then tap Sync now. To synchronise an application with a Google™ account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise with. A list appears of applications that can be synchronised with the Google account. Tap the application that you want to synchronise with the selected Google account. To synchronise the web browser data From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to synchronise with, then tap Sync Browser. To remove a Google™ account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Google. Tap the Google™ account that you want to remove from the accounts list. Press , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. Synchronising your corporate email, calendar and contacts Access your corporate email messages, calendar appointments and contacts directly from your device. View and manage them just as easily as you would from a 110 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. computer. After setup, you can find your information in the Email, Calendar and Contacts applications. For you to access the functionality described above, your corporate information must be stored on a Microsoft® Exchange server. To set up corporate email, calendar and contacts From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Exchange ActiveSync. Enter your corporate email address and password. Tap Next. Your device begins to retrieve your account information. If a failure occurs, contact your corporate network administrator for more information. Tap OK to allow your corporate server to control your device. Select what data you want to sync with your device, such as contacts and calendar entries. If desired, activate the device administrator to allow your corporate server to control certain security features on your device. For example, you can allow your corporate server to set password rules and set storage encryption. When the setup is done, enter a name for the corporate account. To edit the setup of corporate email, calendar and contacts From your Home screen, tap . Tap Email, then tap . Tap Settings and select a corporate account. Change the desired settings. To set a synchronisation interval for a corporate account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Email, then tap . Tap Settings and select a corporate account. Tap Inbox check frequency and select an interval option. To remove a corporate account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Exchange ActiveSync, then select the corporate account. Tap , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. Synchronising with Facebook™ There are two ways to use Facebook™ on your device. You can use the standard Facebook application to access your online Facebook account, or you can synchronise your Facebook account with your device and share content between Facebook™ and a range of other applications. For example, you can share music in the "WALKMAN" application on your device via Facebook. To synchronise your device with Facebook, you must first set up an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account — a solution developed by Sony to enable easy integration. To set up an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account on your device From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Add account > Xperia™ with Facebook. Follow the on-screen instructions to sign in to your Facebook™ account, or create a new account. To synchronise manually with an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Xperia™ with Facebook. Select the account that you want to synchronise. Press , then tap Sync now. 111 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To remove an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account When you remove an "Xperia™ with Facebook" account from your device, the associated online Facebook account is not deleted and you can still access it from a computer. From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Xperia™ with Facebook. Select the account that you want to remove. Press , then tap Remove account. Tap Remove account again to confirm. 112 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Maps and locations About location services Use your device to find out where you are. There are two methods: GPS and wireless networks. Enable the wireless networks option if you only need your approximate location, and want it fast. If you want a more exact position, and have a clear view of the sky, enable the GPS option. In situations where the wireless network connection is weak, you should enable both options to ensure that your location is found. Sony does not warrant the accuracy of any location services including but not limited to navigational services. Using GPS Your device has a global positioning system (GPS) receiver that uses satellite signals to calculate your location. When you use features that require the GPS receiver to find your location, make sure you have a clear view of the sky. To enable GPS From your Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Location services. Mark the GPS satellites checkbox. Getting the best performance The first time you use the GPS it can take 5 to 10 minutes for your location to be found. To help the search, make sure you have a clear view of the sky. Stand still and don't cover the GPS antenna (the highlighted area in the image). The GPS signals can pass through clouds and plastic, but not through most solid objects such as buildings and mountains. If your location isn't found after a few minutes, move to another location. 113 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Google Maps™ Track your current location, view real-time traffic situations and receive detailed directions to your destination. Before taking trips, you can download and save maps to your memory card to avoid high roaming costs. The Google Maps™ application requires the use of an Internet connection. You may incur data connection charges when you connect to the Internet from your device. Contact your network operator for more information. The Google Maps™ application may not be available in every market, country or region. To use Google Maps™ From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Maps. If you want to use Google Maps™, you have to enable one of the location methods available under Settings > Location services. • To learn more about Google Maps™ When you use Google Maps™, tap , then tap Help. Viewing your friends’ locations with Google Latitude™ Join Google Latitude™ to view your friends’ locations on maps and share your location and other information with them. Using Google Maps™ to get directions Use the Google Maps™ application to get directions when you travel by foot, public transportation, or car. You can add a shortcut to a destination on your Home screen to get quick directions from wherever you are. When you view a map, you make an Internet connection, and data is transferred to your device. So it's a good idea to download and save maps to your device before you take a trip. This way, you can avoid high roaming costs. Sony does not warrant the accuracy of any directional services. Using the Navigation application Use the Navigation application in your device to get turn-by-turn instructions on how to get places. The directions are both spoken and displayed on the screen. The Navigation application may not be available in every market. To start Navigation From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Navigation. 114 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Calendar and alarm clock Calendar Your device has a calendar application for managing your time schedule. If you have a Google™ account, you can also synchronise the calendar application on your device with your web calendar. To set the calendar view From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Calendar. Tap Month, Week or Day to select an option. To view multiple calendars From your Home screen, tap , then find and tap Calendar. Press , then tap My calendars. Select the calendars you want to view. To create a calendar event From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Tap . Enter the name, time, location and description for the event. Select a reminder for the event. To add a new reminder for the event, tap If desired, tap More and select another option under Repetition. Tap Done. When the appointment time approaches, your device plays a short sound to remind you. Also, appears in the status bar. To view a calendar event From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Tap the event you want to view. To change the calendar settings From your Home screen, tap , then tap Calendar. Press , then tap Settings. Tap the setting you want to change, then edit as desired. Alarm clock Use your device as an alarm clock and select any sound saved on your device as your alarm signal. The alarm does not sound if your device is turned off. But it does sound when the device is set to silent mode. To open the alarm clock From your Home screen, tap Find and tap Alarm & clock. To set a new alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap Add alarm. Tap Time and adjust the time by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. If desired, edit other alarm settings. Tap Done. 115 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To edit an existing alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Time and adjust the time by scrolling up and down. Tap Done. If desired, edit other alarm settings. Tap Done. The alarm time format displayed is the same as the format you select for your general time settings, for example, 12-hour or 24-hour. To deactivate an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap next to the alarm you want to deactivate. To activate an existing alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap next to the alarm you want to activate. To delete an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Touch and hold the alarm you want to delete. Tap Delete alarm, then tap Yes. To set the ringtone for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings and unmark the Style settings checkbox. Tap Alarm sound and select an option. Tap Done, then tap Done. To set a recurring alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Repeat. Mark the checkboxes for the desired days, then tap OK. Tap Done. To set the title for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then tap the Alarm text field and enter a name for the alarm. Tap Done. To activate the vibrate function for an alarm From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock. Tap the alarm you want to edit. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then mark the Vibrate checkbox. Tap Done. 116 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set alarms to sound when the device is in silent mode From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Alarm & clock, then tap to select an alarm. Tap Advanced alarm settings, then mark the Alarm in silent mode checkbox. Tap Done. • To snooze an alarm when it sounds Tap Snooze - min. • To turn off an alarm when it sounds Slide to the right. 117 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Support and maintenance Updating your device Update your device to the most recent software version to get optimal performance and the latest enhancements. You can use the Update center application on your device to run a wireless update or you can use the PC Companion application on a computer to run an update using a USB cable connection. If you update wirelessly, then you can use either a mobile network or a Wi-Fi® network connection. Just make sure you back up and save all data stored on your device before you update. When you run an update using the Update center application, a data connection is established and related charges may be incurred. Also, the availability of updates over a mobile network depends on your operator. Contact your network operator for more information. Updating your device wirelessly Use the Update center application to update your device wirelessly. You can download software updates manually, or you can allow Update service to update your device automatically whenever downloads become available. When the automatic update feature is activated, a notification appears in the status bar every time an update becomes available. To download software updates manually from Update center From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Select the desired application or system update and tap Download, or tap Update all to download all application updates. Application updates launch automatically after download. With system updates, wait for your device to restart, then install the update manually. You may incur data connection charges when downloading updates over mobile networks. To activate automatic software updates using the Update Center application From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Press , then tap Settings. Mark the Allow automatic downloads checkbox, then tap Agree. Updates are now downloaded automatically as soon as they become available. You may incur data connection charges when downloading updates over mobile networks. To install system updates From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Update Centre. Select a system update you want to install, then tap Install. Updating your device using a USB cable connection Some updates are not available for wireless download. Notifications appear in the status bar to inform you of such updates. To download and run the updates, you need a USB cable and a computer running the PC Companion application. You can install PC Companion on the computer using installation files saved on your device, or you can download the application directly from PC Companion. 118 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To download the PC Companion application from your device Connect your device to a computer using a USB cable. When prompted, follow the instructions in your device to launch the installation of PC Companion on the computer. PC Companion can also be downloaded from PC Companion. To download software updates using a USB cable connection Install the PC Companion application on the computer you are using, if it is not already installed. Connect your device to the computer using a USB cable. Computer: Launch the PC Companion application. After a few moments, PC Companion detects your device and searches for new software for it. Device: When notifications appear in the status bar, follow the on-screen instructions to carry out the relevant software updates. To update your device using an Apple® Mac® computer Install Sony™ Bridge for Mac application on the Apple® Mac® computer you are using, if it is not already installed. Using a USB cable, connect your device to the Apple® Mac® computer. Computer: Launch Sony™ Bridge for Mac application. After a few moments, Sony™ Bridge for Mac application detects your device and searches for new software for it. Computer: If a new software update is detected, a popup window appears. Follow the on-screen instructions to carry out the relevant software updates. Sony™ Bridge for Mac application is downloadable from Bridge for mac. Backup and restore application Use the Backup and restore application to make backups of content to a memory card or a USB storage device. Such backups can be used to restore your content and some settings in cases where your data gets lost or deleted. Types of content you can back up Use the Backup and restore application to back up the following types of data: • • • • • • • Bookmarks Call log Contacts Applications downloaded from Google Play™ Multimedia messages System settings (such as alarms, ringer volume, and language settings) Text messages You do not need to back up music files and photos or videos taken with the camera. They are backed up automatically to the device's memory card. You may incur additional data transmission charges when you restore applications from Google Play™. Preparing to use the Backup and restore application Before backing up your content, you can select the backup destination and the types of data that you want to back up. To select the backup destination From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up. Tap the bar under Where to store data. Select the destination to which you want to back up your content. 119 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To select the data types to back up From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up. Select the data types that you want to back up. To back up content From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Back up, then tap Back up now. Restoring backed up content using the Backup and restore application When you restore backed up content, you must select a backup record to restore from. If you have backed up content several times, you may have several backup records. After you select a backup record, you can then select which types of data to restore. To restore content from a backup record From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Tap Restore. Select the record that you want to restore from, then tap Restore now. Remember that any changes you make to your data and settings after you create a backup will get deleted during a restore procedure. Managing backup records You can delete or rename records of the backups that you make using the Backup & restore function. To rename a backup record From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Press , then tap Manage backup records. Select the backup record that you want to rename. Tap . Enter a new name and tap Rename. To delete backup records From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Back up & restore. Press , then tap Manage backup records. Select the backup record that you want to delete, or tap all records. Tap > Delete. if you want to delete Resetting your device About resetting your device You can reset your device to its original settings, with or without deleting all of your personal data. It is possible to reset your device to the state it was in before you first turned it on. But before you perform a reset, make sure to back up any important data saved on your device. 120 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. To perform a factory data reset To avoid permanent damage to your device, do not restart your device while a reset procedure is underway. From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Backup & reset. Tap Factory data reset. If you also want to erase data such as pictures and music, which is saved to your device's internal storage, mark the Erase internal storage checkbox. Tap Reset phone. To confirm, tap Erase everything. Locking and protecting your device IMEI number Every device has a unique IMEI (International Mobile Equipment Identity) number. You should keep a copy of this number. If your device is stolen, your network provider can use your IMEI number to stop the device from accessing the network in your country. To view your IMEI number • • Turn off your phone, then remove the battery cover and battery to view your IMEI number. Open the phone dialer on your device and enter *#06#*. To view your IMEI number in the device From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > About phone > Status. Scroll to IMEI to view the IMEI number. Setting a screen lock There are several ways to lock the screen on your device. For example, you can use the Face Unlock feature, which uses a picture of your face to unlock the screen. You can also set a screen unlock pattern, a number-based PIN lock, or a text-based password. It is very important that you remember your screen unlock pattern, PIN or password. If you forget this information, it may not be possible to restore important data such as contacts and messages. Refer to Sony customer support for more information. 121 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To set a screen lock From your Home screen, tap Select an option. > Settings > Security > Screen lock. To set up the Face Unlock feature From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Tap Face Unlock, then follow the instructions in your device to capture your face. After your face is successfully captured, tap Continue. Select a backup lock method and follow the instructions in the device to complete the setup. The Face Unlock feature is less secure than a screen lock pattern, PIN, or password. Someone who looks similar to you could unlock your device. For best results, capture your face in an indoor area that is well lit but not too bright, and hold the device at eye level. To unlock the screen using the Face Unlock feature Activate the screen. Look at your device from the same angle you used to capture your Face Unlock photo. If the Face Unlock feature fails to recognise your face, you need to draw the backup pattern or enter the PIN to unlock the screen. To disable the Face Unlock protection From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw your backup screen unlock pattern or enter your PIN. Tap Swipe. To create a screen unlock pattern From the Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security > Screen lock > Pattern. Follow the instructions in your device. You are asked to select a security question that will be used to unlock the device if you forget your screen unlock pattern. To unlock the screen using a screen unlock pattern Activate the screen. Draw your screen unlock pattern. If the unlock pattern you draw on the screen is rejected five times in a row, you can select to either wait 30 seconds and then try again, or to answer the security question you have selected. To change the screen unlock pattern From your Home screen, tap . Find and tap Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw your screen unlock pattern. Tap Pattern. Follow the instructions in your device. To disable the screen unlock pattern From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Draw the screen unlock pattern. Tap Swipe. 122 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. 1 To create a screen unlock PIN From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock > PIN. Enter a numeric PIN. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap Continue. Re-enter and confirm your PIN. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap OK. To disable the screen unlock PIN From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Enter your PIN, then tap Next. Tap Swipe. To create a screen lock password From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock > Password. Enter a password. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap Continue. Re-enter and confirm your password. If necessary, tap to minimise the keyboard. Tap OK. To disable the screen unlock password From your Home screen, tap > Settings > Security > Screen lock. Enter your password and tap Continue. Tap Swipe. Support application To access the support application From your Application screen, find and tap Find and tap the required support item. Recycling your device Got an old device lying around the house? Why not recycle it? By doing so, you will help us reuse its materials and components, and you’ll protect the environment, too! Find out more about the recycling options in your region at blogs.sonymobile.com/ about-us/sustainability/commitment/overview/. 123 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Reference Settings overview Get to know the settings in your device so that you can personalise them to your own requirements. Wi-Fi Turn Wi-Fi® on or off, scan for available Wi-Fi® networks, or add a Wi-Fi® network. Bluetooth Turn Bluetooth™ on or off, search for available Bluetooth™ devices, and make your device visible or invisible to other Bluetooth™ devices. Data usage Turn the mobile data traffic on or off, and keep track of your data usage details over a specified period of time. More… Turn Airplane mode on or off, configure settings for VPN and mobile networks, and enable your device to share its mobile data connection as a portable Wi-Fi® hotspot, or via USB tethering or Bluetooth™ tethering. You can also enable or disable the NFC function. Call settings Manage and configure settings for fixed dialing numbers, voicemail and Internet calls. Sound Configure how your device rings, vibrates, or alerts you when you receive communications. You can also use these settings to set the volume level for music, video, games or other media with audio, and to make related adjustments. Display Enable the screen to switch orientation when you rotate your device. You can also set the brightness, font size, wallpaper and screen timeout. Storage Check out the available space on the internal storage and on the SD card. You can also erase the SD card, or unmount it for safe removal. Power management Turn the power saving modes on or off. You can also view your battery status and see how different applications consume battery power. Apps Manage running applications, downloaded applications and applications on the SD card. Xperia™ Access a range of settings tailored to your Xperia device, for example, USB connection mode, Internet, screen mirroring, security, and Throw settings. Location services Enable or disable access to your location information. Security Protect your device by setting up different locks and passwords. You can also allow the installation of applications not from Google Play™. Language & input Select the device language, adjust text input options, add words to the personal dictionary and configure speech settings. Backup & reset Back up your data and reset your device. Setup guide Get help setting up your device. Add account Add an account on your device, for example, an email account or a Google™ account. 124 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Date & time Set the time and date, or choose the network-provided values. Select your preferred date and hour format. Accessibility Enable your installed accessibility services and adjust related settings. Developer options Set options for application development. For example, you can display CPU usage on the Home screen or set your device to enter debug mode when USB connections are active. About phone View information about your device, such as the model number and signal strength. You can also update your software to the latest version. Status and notification icons overview Status icons The following status icons may appear on your screen: Signal strength No signal Roaming GPRS is available EDGE is available NFC is activated 3G is available Sending and downloading GPRS data Sending and downloading EDGE data Sending and downloading 3G data Battery status The battery is charging GPS is activated Airplane mode is activated The Bluetooth™ function is activated The SIM card is not inserted The microphone is muted The speakerphone is on Silent mode Vibrate mode An alarm is set Synchronisation is ongoing Problem with sign-in or synchronisation A Wi-Fi® connection is enabled and wireless networks are available 125 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Notification icons The following notification icons may appear on your screen: New email message New text message or multimedia message New voicemail An upcoming calendar event A song is playing The device is connected to a computer via a USB cable Warning message Error message Missed call Call ongoing Call on hold Call forwarding on Software updates available Downloading data Uploading data More (undisplayed) notifications Application overview Use the Alarm and clock application to set various kinds of alarms. Use your web browser to navigate and view web pages, manage bookmarks, and manage text and images. Use the Calculator application to perform basic calculations. Use the Calendar application to keep track of your events and manage your appointments. Use the camera to take photos and record video clips. Use the Contact application to manage phone numbers, email address and other information related to your contacts. Access your downloaded applications. Use the Email application to send and receive emails through both private and corporate accounts. Use the Facebook application to engage in social networking with friends, family members and colleagues around the world. Browse and listen to FM radio stations. Use the Album application to view and to work with your photos and videos. Use the Gmail™ application to read, write and organise email messages. Search for information in your device and on the web. 126 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. View your current location, find other locations, and calculate routes using Google Maps™. Go to Google Play™ to download free and paid applications for your device. Use the Messaging application to send and receive text and multimedia messages. Use the Movies application to play videos in your device, and share videos with your friends or on other devices using DLNA™. Use the "WALKMAN" application to organise and play music, audio books and podcasts. Navigate your way using spoken, turn-by-turn instructions. View news stories and weather forecasts. Make phone calls by dialling the number manually or by using the smart dial function. Search for places, for example, restaurants and cafés. Use the Video Unlimited™ application to rent and purchase videos. Use the subscription-based Music Unlimited™ application to access millions of songs over a mobile data connection or Wi-Fi® connection. Optimise settings to suit your own requirements. Use the Google Talk™ application to chat with friends online. Identify music tracks that you hear playing in your surroundings, and get artist, album and other info. Use the Help application to access user support in the device. For example, you can access a User guide, troubleshooting information, plus tips and tricks. Use YouTube™ to share and view videos from around the world. Download and install new applications and updates. Some applications are not supported all networks and/or service providers in all areas. 127 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Important information Important information leaflet Before you use your device, please read the Important information leaflet provided in the Setup guide in your device or in the box. To access the setup guide manually From the Home screen, tap . Tap Settings > Setup guide. Limitations to services and features Some of the services and features described in this User guide are not supported in all countries/regions or by all networks and/or service providers in all areas. Without limitation, this applies to the GSM International Emergency Number, 112. Please contact your network operator or service provider to determine availability of any specific service or feature and whether additional access or usage fees apply. Use of certain features and applications described in this guide may require access to the Internet. You may incur data connection charges when you connect to the Internet from your device. Contact your wireless service provider for more information. Protecting your device from water and dust In order for your device to be waterproof, the covers for the micro USB port and the headset jack must be firmly closed. Also, make sure that the battery cover is attached correctly. Avoid exposing your device to environments with excessive dust or moisture. Normal wear and tear along with damage to your device can reduce its ability to resist dust or moisture. You can use the device in the following fresh (non-saline) water conditions: Swimming pool Diving Shooting photos and videos You should only use the device in water depths of 1.5 metres or less. Do not use your device in the following conditions: Sand/mud Salt water Other liquid chemicals Water can sometimes cause unintended touch actions on the screen. So it is recommended to activate the Touch Block function before using the device in water. You may need to first download the Touch Block application by using the Update center application in your device. 128 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Your smartphone is waterproof and dust resistant in compliance with the Ingress Protection ratings IP5X, IPX5 and IPX8 (see details below). Always firmly attach all covers to ensure the water and dust resistance of the device. If liquid is detected inside the device, for example, underneath one of the covers or on the battery, your warranty will be void. Never submerge your device in salt water or let the micro USB port or headset jack come in contact with salt water. Also, never expose the device to any liquid chemicals, or to moist environments with extreme high or low temperatures. The waterproof ability of the micro USB port and the headset jack is not guaranteed in all environments or conditions. After using the device in water, dry off the areas around the micro USB port cover and the headset jack cover. If the speaker or microphone get wet, dry these areas and wait for three hours before using them again. You can, however, use other features in the device that do not utilise the speaker or microphone. All compatible accessories, including batteries, chargers, handsfree devices and micro USB cables, are not waterproof and dust resistant on their own. Your warranty does not cover damage or defects caused by abuse or improper use of your device. If you have any further questions about the use of your products, refer to our Customer support service for help. IP (Ingress Protection) rating Your device has an IP rating, which means it has undergone certified tests to measure its resistance levels to both dust and water. The first digit in the two-digit IP rating indicates the level of protection against solid objects, including dust. The second digit indicates how resistant the device is to water. The higher the numbers, the higher the respective protection. Your smartphone is waterproof and dust resistant in compliance with the Ingress Protection ratings IP5X, IPX5 and IPX8 (see details below). These ratings mean that your device is dust resistant and is protected against low pressure water stream as well as against the effects of submersion for 30 minutes in fresh (non-saline) water up to 1.5 metres deep. You can therefore use the device in dusty environments, when your fingers are wet, and in extreme weather conditions, for example, when it’s snowing or raining, or when humidity levels are high. You can also use the device in fresh water conditions (for example, in a swimming pool) to take underwater photos or shoot underwater videos using the Camera key. See the table below for more details. Resistance to solid objects and dust Resistance to water IP0X. No special protection IPX0. No special protection IP1X. Protected against solid objects > 50 mm in diameter IPX1. Protected against dripping water IP2X. Protected against solid objects > 12.5 mm in diameter IPX2. Protected against dripping water when tilted up to 15 degrees from normal position IP3X. Protected against solid objects > 2.5 mm in diameter IPX3. Protected against spraying water IP4X. Protected against solid objects > 1 mm in diameter IPX4. Protected against splashing water IP5X. Protected against dust; limited ingress (no harmful deposit) IPX5. Protected against water jet spray IP6X. Dust tight IPX6. Protected against heavy jet spray IPX7. Protected against the effects of immersion IPX8. Protected against submersion The IPX5 and IPX8 ratings are based on tests lasting 30 minutes in water depths of 1.5 metres. Go to www.sonymobile.com/testresults for more information. 129 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Legal information Sony C5503/C5502 This User guide is published by Sony Mobile Communications AB or its local affiliated company, without any warranty. Improvements and changes to this User guide necessitated by typographical errors, inaccuracies of current information, or improvements to programs and/or equipment, may be made by Sony Mobile Communications AB at any time and without notice. Such changes will, however, be incorporated into new editions of this User guide. ©Sony Mobile Communications AB, 2013. All rights reserved. Your mobile phone has the capability to download, store and forward additional content, for example, ringtones. The use of such content may be restricted or prohibited by rights of third parties, including but not limited to restriction under applicable copyright laws. You, and not Sony, are entirely responsible for additional content that you download to or forward from your mobile phone. Prior to your use of any additional content, please verify that your intended use is properly licensed or is otherwise authorized. Sony does not guarantee the accuracy, integrity or quality of any additional content or any other third party content. Under no circumstances will Sony be liable in any way for your improper use of additional content or other third party content. This User guide may reference services or applications provided by third parties. Use of such programming or services may require separate registration with the third party provider and may be subject to additional terms of use. For applications accessed on or through a third-party website, please review such websites’ terms of use and applicable privacy policy in advance. Sony does not warrant or guarantee the availability or performance of any third-party websites or offered services. Remove the battery to see regulatory information such as the CE mark. All product and company names mentioned herein are the trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. All other trademarks are property of their respective owners. Visit www.sonymobile.com for more information. All illustrations are for illustration purposes only and may not accurately depict the actual phone. This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from Microsoft. Content owners use Windows Media digital rights management technology (WMDRM) to protect their intellectual property, including copyrights. This device uses WMDRM software to access WMDRM-protected content. If the WMDRM software fails to protect the content, content owners may ask Microsoft to revoke the software's ability to use WMDRM to play or copy protected content. Revocation does not affect unprotected content. When you download licenses for protected content, you agree that Microsoft may include a revocation list with the licenses. Content owners may require you to upgrade WMDRM to access their content. If you decline an upgrade, you will not be able to access content that requires the upgrade. This product is licensed under the MPEG-4 visual and AVC patent portfolio licenses for the personal and noncommercial use of a consumer for (i) encoding video in compliance with the MPEG-4 visual standard ("MPEG-4 video") or the AVC standard ("AVC video") and/or (ii) decoding MPEG- 4 or AVC video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal and non-commercial activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed by MPEG LA to provide MPEG-4 and/or AVC video. No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use. Additional information including that relating to promotional, internal and commercial uses and licensing may be obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C. See http://www.mpegla.com. MPEG Layer-3 audio decoding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. 130 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Index accounts ..................................................................11 Exchange Active Sync® ..................................11 Facebook™ .....................................................11 Google™ .........................................................11 adjusting volume .....................................................59 Airplane mode .........................................................31 alarm ......................................................................115 Album ................................................................81, 82 map .................................................................86 My albums .......................................................83 online albums ..................................................87 opening ...........................................................81 pictures ............................................................82 SensMe™ slideshow .......................................84 thumbnail size .................................................82 viewing ..........................................82, 83, 86, 87 viewing local content .......................................81 viewing online photos ......................................88 Android Market™ - See Google Play™ ..................37 Android™ ..................................................................7 animated wallpaper .................................................20 answering service ....................................................41 applications arranging .........................................................22 overview ........................................................126 screen ..............................................................20 sorting .............................................................22 audio ........................................................................62 adjusting volume .............................................59 playing .............................................................59 playing tracks in random order .......................62 audio content related content ................................................60 back cover attaching ............................................................9 removing ............................................................8 backing up contacts ...................................................49, 119 content ..........................................................119 battery .....................................................................12 Bluetooth™ wireless technology ...........................102 BRAVIA® Engine .....................................................81 brightness ................................................................31 business cards sending ............................................................48 calendar .................................................................115 create an event ..............................................115 calls ...................................................................39, 43 barring .............................................................42 diverting ...........................................................42 emergency .......................................................39 forwarding .......................................................42 log ....................................................................40 missed .............................................................40 multiple ............................................................41 reject ................................................................42 settings ............................................................42 waiting .............................................................41 camera .........................................................70, 72, 77 closing .............................................................70 controls ...........................................................70 face detection ..................................................71 geotagging ......................................................72 icons ................................................................77 overview ..........................................................70 recording videos ........................................76, 77 screen ..............................................................70 self-portraits ....................................................71 settings ......................................................72, 77 smile detection ................................................72 Smile Shutter™ ...............................................72 taking photos ......................................70, 71, 72 using the flash .................................................71 video ................................................................76 viewing photos ................................................71 viewing videos .................................................77 zoom ................................................................71 caps lock .................................................................25 charging ...................................................................12 chat ..........................................................................52 conference calls ......................................................41 connectivity .............................................................94 contacts ...................................................................44 backing up .......................................................49 copying ............................................................49 favourite ...........................................................48 groups .............................................................48 importing from SIM card .................................45 joining contact information ..............................47 picture .............................................................47 sending ............................................................48 sharing .............................................................48 transferring ................................................44, 45 corporate email, calendar and contacts ................110 cropping photos .............................................................84 data traffic ...............................................................34 date format ..............................................................30 deleting ....................................................................59 an alarm .........................................................115 music ...............................................................65 photos .............................................................85 tracks ...............................................................59 videos ..............................................................86 device battery .............................................................13 performance ....................................................13 update ...........................................................118 download Internet settings ...............................................33 driving directions ...................................................114 editing photos .............................................................85 email ........................................................................53 more than one account ...................................53 emergency numbers ................................................39 equaliser ..................................................................59 events calendar .........................................................115 extensions ...............................................................18 face detection ..........................................................71 Facebook™ "Like" a track on Facebook™ .........................60 synchronisation .............................................111 131 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Xperia™ with Facebook ................................111 favourites removing radio channels as ............................68 saving radio channels as .................................68 fixed dialling ............................................................43 flash using when taking photos ...............................71 Flight mode - See Airplane mode ............................31 FM radio favourites .........................................................68 selecting a channel ..........................................67 Friends’ music .........................................................62 front camera ............................................................70 geotagging of photos .........................................................72 gesture input ...........................................................27 Gmail™ ....................................................................53 Google Latitude™ .................................................114 Google Maps™ .....................................................114 Google Play™ .........................................................37 Google Talk™ ..........................................................52 Google™ account setup .........................................54 Google™ synchronisation .....................................110 GPS .......................................................................113 headset ....................................................................33 using ................................................................33 Home screen ...........................................................18 customising .....................................................19 icons ..............................................................125, 126 in the camera ...................................................77 importing SIM contacts ...........................................45 improving photos with Mobile BRAVIA® Engine ....81 infinite button ...........................................................60 instant messaging ...................................................52 Internet settings ............................................................33 web browser ....................................................93 Navigation application ...........................................114 notification .............................................................126 light ..................................................................23 panel ..........................................................23, 24 ringtone ...........................................................30 setting ..............................................................24 on-screen keyboard ................................................25 overview ..................................................................61 keyboard .................................................................25 settings ............................................................28 keys .........................................................................12 language ..................................................................31 writing ..............................................................28 Latitude .................................................................114 LCD backlight control ..............................................31 "Like" a photo on Facebook™ ................................88 "Like" a track on Facebook™ .................................60 "Like" a video on Facebook™ .................................88 live wallpaper ...........................................................20 location ............................................................72, 113 locks activating the screen .......................................10 locking the screen ...........................................10 screen lock ......................................................10 micro SIM card inserting .............................................................9 Microsoft® Exchange synchronisation .................110 Mobile BRAVIA® Engine .........................................81 Movies .....................................................................89 clearing video information ...............................90 Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS) settings ............................................................33 music ...........................................................33, 58, 63 adjusting volume .............................................59 changing tracks ...............................................59 deleting ............................................................65 downloading music information ......................61 hearing protection ...........................................63 My playlists ......................................................63 pausing a track ................................................59 playing .............................................................59 purchasing .......................................................64 searching using TrackID™ ..............................64 sending ............................................................60 sharing .............................................................64 shortcuts .........................................................61 transferring to your device ..............................58 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 using a headset ...............................................33 viewing artist info ............................................65 Visualiser .........................................................60 music services .........................................................64 Music Unlimited™ ...................................................65 My music .................................................................61 maintenance ..........................................................118 Maps ..............................................................113, 114 marking options .......................................................15 Media Go™ ...........................................................106 messages settings ............................................................33 MHL (Mobile High-Definition Link) ........................106 pausing a track ........................................................59 personal information ................................................44 phone maintenance ...............................................118 phonebook ..............................................................44 Phonepad ..........................................................25, 27 photo albums viewing ............................................................81 photos .....................................................................85 adding a geotag ..............................................85 adding the geographical position ....................72 associating with a contact ..............................47 cropping ..........................................................84 deleting ............................................................85 editing ..............................................................85 photo viewer ....................................................82 rotating ............................................................84 selecting ..........................................................82 SensMe™ slideshow .......................................84 sharing .............................................................85 slideshow ........................................................84 taking ...................................................70, 71, 72 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 using as ...........................................................84 viewing ................................................71, 81, 82 viewing on a map ............................................86 viewing same location .....................................72 zooming ...........................................................84 PIN .........................................................................121 132 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. playing music ...............................................................59 playlists ....................................................................62 adding a track .................................................62 deleting ............................................................63 playing your own .............................................63 removing tracks ...............................................63 powering off ............................................................10 powering on .............................................................10 presets removing radio channels as ............................68 saving radio channels as .................................68 protective plastic sheet ...........................................15 PUK .......................................................................121 purchasing music ...............................................................64 radio ........................................................................67 favourites .........................................................68 listening to with the speaker ...........................68 mono sound ....................................................68 moving between channels ..............................67 opening ...........................................................67 radio region .....................................................67 searching for channels ....................................68 selecting a channel ..........................................67 stereo sound ...................................................68 visualizer ..........................................................67 radio sound .............................................................68 receiving items using Bluetooth™ .........................103 recently used applications window .........................21 recommending music ..............................................60 recommending photos and videos ..........................88 recording videos ......................................................70 using the camera key ......................................76 recycling your device ............................................123 resetting .................................................................120 resizing photos .............................................................84 ringtone .................................................................115 rotating photos .............................................................84 scanning barcodes ................................................107 screen ......................................................................31 cracked ............................................................15 glass ................................................................15 screen unlock pattern ....................................121 warranty ...........................................................15 screen mirroring ....................................................107 searching music using TrackID™ ....................................64 track information .............................................64 self-portrait ..............................................................70 sending business cards ................................................48 contacts ...........................................................48 music ...............................................................60 sending items using Bluetooth™ ..................103 SensMe™ channels ................................................62 services ...................................................................11 settings call ...................................................................42 camera ......................................................72, 77 data usage .......................................................34 Internet ............................................................33 messaging .......................................................33 MMS ................................................................33 quick settings ..................................................23 still camera ......................................................72 video camera ...................................................77 setup guide ..............................................................10 sharing music ...............................................................64 photos .............................................................85 shuffle music ...........................................................62 silent mode ..............................................................29 SIM card ................................................................121 exporting contacts to ......................................49 importing contacts from ..................................45 slideshow ................................................................84 Smart Connect ......................................................108 smile detection ........................................................72 Smile Shutter™ .......................................................72 SOS - See emergency numbers ..............................39 STAMINA mode changing settings ............................................14 standby time estimating ........................................................14 status .....................................................................125 bar ...................................................................23 still camera ........................................................70, 72 settings ............................................................72 support ..................................................................118 Support application ...............................................123 surround sound feature ...........................................59 symbols ...................................................................25 synchronising ........................................................110 Facebook™ contacts, calendar, photos .......111 Google™ contacts, calendar, email ..............110 with Microsoft® Exchange ............................110 taking photos ...........................................................70 by tapping .......................................................71 self-portraits ....................................................71 using face detection ........................................71 using smile detection ......................................72 using Smile Shutter™ ......................................72 using the camera key ......................................70 telephony - See calls ...............................................39 tethering USB tethering ..................................................95 with Xperia Link™ ...........................................95 text input method ....................................................25 themes .....................................................................20 time ..........................................................................30 time management ..................................................115 TrackID™ technology ..............................................64 buying a track ..................................................64 deleting a track ................................................65 opening ...........................................................64 searching for track information .......................64 sharing a track .................................................64 using results ....................................................64 using with the FM Radio .................................69 viewing artist info ............................................65 viewing charts .................................................64 transferring contacts .....................................................44, 45 turning off ................................................................10 turning on ................................................................10 updating your device .............................................118 usage info ................................................................34 USB connection ....................................................104 using Movies ...........................................................89 using the equaliser ..................................................59 133 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. V vibration ...........................................................30, 115 video albums viewing ............................................................81 video camera ...............................................70, 76, 77 recording videos ..............................................77 settings ............................................................77 Video Unlimited™ ....................................................91 buying videos ..................................................91 creating an account .........................................91 menu overview ..........................................91, 92 notifications .....................................................91 renting videos ..................................................91 watching a video .............................................92 videos ......................................................................85 adjusting volume .............................................85 deleting ............................................................86 fast forwarding and rewinding .........................85 pausing ............................................................85 playing .............................................................85 recording ...................................................76, 77 selecting ..........................................................82 sending ............................................................85 sharing .............................................................85 transferring to/from a computer ......................58 viewing ................................................77, 81, 82 viewing Movies .............................................................89 photos .............................................................71 videos recorded using the camera ..................77 voice input ...............................................................29 voice recognition .....................................................29 voicemail .................................................................41 volume adjusting for videos .........................................85 key ...................................................................29 "WALKMAN" application adding tracks to playlists ................................62 deleting tracks .................................................59 minimising .......................................................59 overview ..........................................................58 playing tracks in random order .......................62 playlists ...........................................................62 using ................................................................59 using the equaliser ..........................................59 "WALKMAN" application widget .............................63 wallpaper .................................................................20 web browser ............................................................93 widgets ....................................................................19 resizing ............................................................19 wireless networks ..................................................113 zoom ........................................................................71 zooming photos .............................................................84 134 This is an Internet version of this publication. © Print only for private use. Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 1 of 2 Sony Consumer Web site At www.sonymobile.com/support there is a support section where help and tips are only a few clicks away. Here you will find the latest computer software updates and tips on how to use your product more efficiently. Important information Service and support You have access to a portfolio of exclusive service advantages such as: • Global and local Web sites providing support. • A global network of Contact Centers. • An extensive network of Sony service partners. • A warranty period. Learn more about the warranty conditions in theLimited warrantysection. At www.sonymobile.com/support, you can find the latest support tools and information. For operator-specific services and features, please contact your network operator. You can also contact our Contact Centers. If your country/region is not represented in the list below, please contact your local dealer. (Calls are charged according to national rates, including local taxes, unless the phone number is a toll-free number.) If your product needs service, please contact the dealer from whom it was purchased, or one of our service partners. For warranty claims, save proof of purchase. Power supply (Charger) Connect the charger to power sources as marked on the product. Do not use outdoors or in damp areas. Do not alter or subject the cord to damage or stress. Unplug the unit before cleaning it. Never alter the plug. If it does not fit into the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by an electrician. When a power supply is connected there is a small drain of power. To avoid this small energy waste, disconnect the power supply when the product is fully charged. Use of charging devices that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Recommendations for care and safe use of our products • Handle with care and keep in a clean and dust-free place. • Warning! May explode if disposed of in fire. • Do not expose to liquid or moisture or excess humidity. • For optimum performance, the product should not be operated in temperatures below -10°C(+14°F) or above Emergency calls Calls cannot be guaranteed under all conditions. Never rely solely upon mobile phones for essential communication. Calls may not be possible in all areas, on all networks, or when certain network services and/or phone features are used. Antenna Use of antenna devices not marketed by Sony could damage the phone, reduce performance, and produce SAR levels above the established limits. Do not cover the antenna with your hand as this affects call quality, power levels and can shorten talk and standby times. Radio Frequency (RF) exposure and Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) When the phone or Bluetooth handsfree is turned on, it emits low levels of radio frequency energy. International safety guidelines have been developed through periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies. These guidelines establish permitted levels of radio wave exposure. The guidelines include a safety margin designed to assure the safety of all persons and to account for any variations in measurements. Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) is used to measure radio frequency energy absorbed by the body when using a mobile phone. The SAR value is determined at the highest certified power level in laboratory conditions, but because the phone is designed to use the minimum power necessary to access the chosen network, the actual SAR level can be well below this value. There is no proof of difference in safety based on difference in SAR value. Products with radio transmitters sold in the US must be certified by the Federal Communications Commission (FCC). When required, tests are performed when the phone is placed at the ear and when • Insert the memory card as far as it will go into any memory card adapter needed. The memory card may not operate properly unless fully inserted. • We recommend that you make a backup copy of important data. We are not responsible for any loss or damage to content you store on the memory card. • Recorded data may be damaged or lost when you remove the memory card or memory card adapter, turn off the power while formatting, reading or writing data, or use the memory card in locations subject to static electricity or high electrical field emissions. Protection of personal information Erase personal data before disposing of the product. To delete data, perform a master reset. Deleting data from the phone memory does not ensure that it cannot be recovered. Sony does not warrant against recovery of information and does not assume responsibility for disclosure of any information even after a master reset. Loudness warning! Avoid volume levels that may be harmful to your hearing. End User Licence Agreement Software delivered with this device and its media is owned by Sony Mobile Communications AB, and/or its affiliated companies and its suppliers and licensors. Sony grants you a non-exclusive limited licence to use the Software solely in conjunction with the Device on which it is installed or delivered. Ownership of the Software is not sold, transferred or otherwise conveyed. Do not use any means to discover the source code or any component of the Software, reproduce and distribute the Software, or modify the Software. You are entitled to transfer rights and obligations to the Software to a third party, solely together with the Device with which you received the Software, provided the third party agrees in writing to be bound by the terms of this Licence. This licence exists throughout the useful life of this Device. It can be terminated by transferring your rights to the Device to a third party in writing. June 27, 2012 15:00:07 Battery New or idle batteries can have short-term reduced capacity. Fully charge the battery before initial use. Use for the intended purpose only. Charge the battery in temperatures between +5°C(+41°F) and +45°C(+113°F). Do not put the battery into your mouth. Do not let the battery contacts touch another metal object. Turn off the product before removing the battery. Performance depends on temperatures, signal strength, usage patterns, features selected and voice or data transmissions. Only Sony service partners should remove or replace built-in batteries. Use of batteries that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Replace the battery only with another Sony battery that has been qualified with the product per the standard IEEE-1725. Use of an unqualified battery may present a risk of fire, explosion, leakage or other hazard. Children Warning! Keep out of the reach of children. Do not allow children to play with mobile phones or accessories. They could hurt themselves or others. Products may contain small parts that could become detached and create a choking hazard. Guidelines for Safe and Efficient Use Please follow these guidelines. Failure to do so might entail a potential health risk or product malfunction. If in doubt as to its proper function, have the product checked by a certified service partner before charging or using it. Use of location-based information by the device may not be uninterrupted or error free and may additionally be dependent on network service availability. Please note that functionality may be reduced or prevented in certain environments such as building interiors or areas adjacent to buildings. Caution: Do not use GPS functionality in a manner which causes distraction from driving. +45°C(+113°F). Do not expose the battery to temperatures above +60°C(+140°F). • Do not expose to flames or lit tobacco products. • Do not drop, throw or try to bend the product. • Do not paint or attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Only Sony authorised personnel should perform service. • Consult with authorised medical staff and the instructions of the medical device manufacturer before using the product near pacemakers or other medical devices or equipment. • Discontinue use of electronic devices, or disable the radio transmitting functionality of the device, where required or requested to do so. • Do not use where a potentially explosive atmosphere exists. • Do not place the product, or install wireless equipment, in the area above an air bag in a car. • Caution: Cracked or broken displays may create sharp edges or splinters that could be harmful upon contact. • Do not use the Bluetooth Headset in positions where it is uncomfortable or will be subject to pressure. worn on the body. For body-worn operation, the phone has been tested when positioned a minimum of 15 mm from the body without any metal parts in the vicinity of the phone or when properly used with an appropriate Sony accessory and worn on the body. When operating with “Hotspot” functionality engaged, a separation distance of 10mm was used. For more information about SAR and radio frequency exposure, go to: www.sonymobile.com/health. information call the Sony Special Needs Center on 877 878 1996 (TTY) or 877 207 2056 (voice), or go to www.sonyericsson-snc.com. Flight mode Bluetooth and WLAN functionality, if available in the device, can be enabled in Flight mode but may be prohibited onboard aircraft or in other areas where radio transmissions are prohibited. In such environments, please seek proper authorisation before enabling Bluetooth or WLAN functionality even in Flight mode. Malware Malware (short for malicious software) is software that can harm the mobile phone or other computers. Malware or harmful applications can include viruses, worms, spyware, and other unwanted programs. While the device does employ security measures to resist such efforts, Sony does not warrant or represent that the device will be impervious to the introduction of malware. You can however reduce the risk of malware attacks by using care when downloading content or accepting applications, refraining from opening or responding to messages from unknown sources, using trustworthy services to access the Internet, and only downloading content to the mobile phone from known, reliable sources. Accessories Use only Sony branded original accessories and certified service partners. Sony does not test third-party accessories. Accessories may influence RF exposure, radio performance, loudness, electric safety and other areas. Third-party accessories and parts may pose a risk to your health or safety or decrease performance. Disposal of old electrical and electronic equipment and battery This symbols on the electronic product or on its packaging indicates that the electronic product inclusive the battery should not be treated as household waste. Instead it should be handed over to the applicable collection point for the recycling of electrical and electronic equipment. Do not attempt to remove internal batteries. Internal batteries shall be removed only by a waste treatment facility or trained service professional. By ensuring this product is disposed of correctly, you will help prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health, which could otherwise be caused by inappropriate waste handling of this product. The recycling of materials will help to conserve natural resources. For more detailed information about recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, your household waste disposal service or the shop where you purchased the product, by calling a Sony Contact Center or at www.sonymobile .com/recycling. Memory card If the product comes complete with a removable memory card, it is generally compatible with the handset purchased but may not be compatible with other devices or the capabilities of their memory cards. Check other devices for compatibility before purchase or use. If the product is equipped with a memory card reader, check memory card compatibility before purchase or use. Memory cards are generally formatted prior to shipping. To reformat the memory card, use a compatible device. Do not use the standard operating system format when formatting the memory card on a PC. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the device or contact customer support. SIM card If your phone is equipped with a standard-sized SIM card slot, inserting an incompatible SIM card (for example, a micro SIM card, a micro SIM card with a non-Sony adapter, or a standard SIM card cut into a micro SIM card size) in the SIM card slot may damage Accessible Solutions/Special Needs In the US, compatible Sony Xperia phones may offer compatibility with TTY terminals (with use of necessary accessory). For more Failure to comply with any of these terms and conditions will terminate the licence immediately. Sony and its third party suppliers and licensors retain all rights, title and interest in and to the Software. To the extent that the Software contains material or code of a third party, such third parties shall be beneficiaries of these terms. This licence is governed by the laws of Sweden. When applicable, the foregoing applies to statutory consumer rights. In the event Software accompanying or provided in conjunction with your device is provided with additional terms and conditions, such provisions shall also govern your possession and usage of the Software. Export regulations Export regulations: Goods delivered under this Agreement may be the subject to import and export regulations of the European Union, the United States and other countries. Purchaser will comply with these applicable laws and regulations and will obtain and maintain any export and import license required for the delivery of goods to Purchaser under this Agreement. Without limiting the foregoing, and as an example, Purchaser will not knowingly export or reexport goods to destinations identified pursuant to Articles in Chapter II of European Council Regulation (EC) 428/2009 and specifically, and without limitation, Purchaser will also comply with U.S. government Export Administration Regulations (“EAR”, 15 C.F.R. §§ 730-774, http://www.bis.doc.gov/) administered by Department of Commerce, Bureau of Industry and Security and economic sanctions regulations (30 C.F.R. §§ 500 et. seq., http:// www.treas.gov/offices/enforcement/ofac/) administered by the U.S. Department of Treasury, Office of Foreign Assets Control. Limited Warranty Sony Mobile Communications AB, SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden, (Sony) or its local affiliated company, provides this Limited Warranty for your mobile phone, original accessory delivered with your mobile phone, and/or your mobile computing product (hereinafter referred to as “Product”). 10 Personal medical devices Mobile phones may affect implanted medical equipment. Reduce risk of interference by keeping a minimum distance of 15 cm(6 inches) between the phone and the device. Use the phone at your right ear. Do not carry the phone in your breast pocket. Turn off the phone if you suspect interference. For use in proximity to personal medical devices, please consult a physician and the device manufacturer. Driving Some vehicle manufacturers forbid the use of phones in their vehicles unless a handsfree kit with an external antenna supports the installation. Check with the vehicle manufacturer's representative to be sure that the mobile phone or Bluetooth handsfree will not affect the electronic systems in the vehicle. Full attention should be given to driving at all times and local laws and regulations restricting the use of wireless devices while driving must be observed. GPS/Location based functions Some products provide GPS/Location based functions. Location determining functionality is provided “As is” and “With all faults”. Sony does not make any representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such location information. your SIM card or your phone permanently. Sony does not warrant and will not be responsible for any damage caused by use of incompatible or modified SIM cards. For Devices Supporting 3D Viewing capabilities In viewing 3D images shot with this phone on a 3D-compatible monitor, you may experience discomfort in the form of eye strain, fatigue, or nausea. To prevent these symptoms, we recommend that you take regular breaks. However, you need to determine for yourself the length and frequency of breaks you require, as they vary according to the individual. If you experience any type of discomfort, stop viewing the 3D images until you feel better, and consult a physician as necessary. Also refer to the operating instructions supplied with the device or software you have connected or are using with this phone. Note that a child’s eyesight is still at the development stage (particularly children below the age of 6). Consult a pediatrician or ophthalmologist before letting your child view 3D images, and make sure he/she observes the above precautions when viewing such images. Warning! If the device requires an adapter for insertion into the handset or another device, do not insert the card directly without the required adapter. Precautions on memory card use • Do not expose the memory card to moisture. • Do not touch terminal connections with your hand or any metal object. • Do not strike, bend, or drop the memory card. • Do not attempt to disassemble or modify the memory card. • Do not use or store the memory card in humid or corrosive locations or in excessive heat such as a closed car in summer, in direct sunlight or near a heater, etc. • Do not press or bend the end of the memory card adapter with excessive force. • Do not let dirt, dust, or foreign objects get into the insert port of any memory card adapter. • Check you have inserted the memory card correctly. Should your Product need warranty service, please return it to the dealer from whom it was purchased, or contact your local Sony Contact Center (national rates may apply) or visit www.sonymobile.com to get further information. Our warranty Subject to the conditions of this Limited Warranty, Sony warrants this Product to be free from defects in design, material and workmanship at the time of its original purchase by a consumer. This Limited Warranty will last for a period of two (2) years as from the original date of purchase of the Product for your mobile phone, and for a period of one (1) year following the original purchase date of the Product for all original accessories (such as the battery, charger or handsfree kit) which may be delivered with your mobile phone. What we will do If, during the warranty period, this Product fails to operate under normal use and service, due to defects in design, materials or workmanship, Sony authorised distributors or service partners, in the country/region* where you purchased the Product, will, at their option, either repair or replace the Product in accordance with the terms and conditions stipulated herein. Sony and its service partners reserve the right to charge a handling fee if a returned Product is found not to be under warranty according to the conditions below. Please note that some of your personal settings, downloads and other information may be lost when your Sony Product is repaired or replaced. At present, Sony may be prevented by applicable law, other regulation or technical restrictions from making a backup copy of certain downloads. Sony does not take any responsibility for any lost information of any kind and will not reimburse you for any such loss. You should always make backup copies of all the information stored on your Sony Product such as downloads, calendar and contacts before handing in your Sony Product for repair or replacement. Conditions 1. This Limited Warranty is valid only if the original proof of purchase for this Product issued by a Sony authorised dealer specifying the 11 www.sonymobile.com Sony Mobile Communications AB SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden 1222-9269.9 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 2 of 2 2. 3. 4. 5. date of purchase and serial number**, is presented with the Product to be repaired or replaced. Sony reserves the right to refuse warranty service if this information has been removed or changed after the original purchase of the Product from the dealer. If Sony repairs or replaces the Product, the repair for the defect concerned, or the replaced Product shall be warranted for the remaining time of the original warranty period or for ninety (90) days from the date of repair, whichever is longer. Repair or replacement may involve the use of functionally equivalent reconditioned units. Replaced parts or components will become the property of Sony. This warranty does not cover any failure of the Product due to normal wear and tear, or due to misuse, including but not limited to use in other than the normal and customary manner, in accordance with the Sony instructions for use and maintenance of the Product. Nor does this warranty cover any failure of the Product due to accident, software or hardware modification or adjustment, acts of God or damage resulting from liquid. A rechargeable battery can be charged and discharged more than a hundred times. However, it will eventually wear out – this is not a defect and corresponds to normal wear and tear. When the talk-time or standby time is noticeably shorter, it is time to replace the battery. Sony recommends that you use only batteries and chargers approved by Sony. Minor variations in display brightness and colour may occur between phones. There may be tiny bright or dark dots on the display. It occurs when individual dots have malfunctioned and can not be adjusted. Two defective pixels are deemed acceptable. Minor variations in camera image appearance may occur between phones. This is nothing uncommon and is not regarded as a defective camera module. Since the cellular system on which the Product is to operate is provided by a carrier independent from Sony, Sony will not be responsible for the operation, availability, coverage, services or range of that system. This warranty does not cover Product failures caused by installations, modifications, or repair or opening of the Product performed by a non-Sony authorised person. 6. The warranty does not cover Product failures which have been caused by use of accessories or other peripheral devices which are not Sony branded original accessories intended for use with the Product. Sony disclaims any and all warranties, whether express or implied, for failures caused to the Product or peripheral devices as a result of viruses, trojan horses, spyware, or other malicious software. Sony strongly recommends that you install appropriate virus protection software on your Product and any peripheral devices connected to it, as available, and update it regularly, to better protect your device. It is understood, however, that such software will never fully protect your Product or its peripheral devices and Sony disclaims all warranties, whether express or implied, in case of failure by such antivirus software to fulfil its intended purpose. 7. Tampering with any of the seals on the Product will void the warranty. 8. THERE ARE NO EXPRESS WARRANTIES, WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL, OTHER THAN THIS PRINTED LIMITED WARRANTY. ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO EVENT SHALL SONY OR ITS LICENSORS BE LIABLE FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOST PROFITS OR COMMERCIAL LOSS TO THE FULL EXTENT THOSE DAMAGES CAN BE DISCLAIMED BY LAW. Some countries/states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, or limitation of the duration of implied warranties, so the preceding limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. The warranty provided does not affect the consumer’s statutory rights under applicable legislation in force, nor the consumer’s rights against the dealer arising from their sales / purchase contract. *Geographical scope of the warranty If you have purchased your Product in a country member of the European Economic Area (EEA) or in Switzerland or the Republic of Chile Colombia Costa Rica Danmark 800-646-425 (número gratuito) 01800-0966-080 (número gratuito) 0 800 011 0400 (número gratuito) 3331 2828 Deutschland 0180 534 2020 (ortsübliche Gebühren) 1-800-085-9518 Dominica (Toll Free) 1-800-0102-50 Ecuador (número gratuito) 06 032 032 Eesti Egypt/مصر 16727 Ελλάδα 801 11 810 810 +30 210 899 19 19 (από κινητό τηλέφωνο) El Salvador 800-6323 (número gratuito) 902 180 576 España (tarifa local) questions.CF@support.sonymobile.co 09 69 32 21 21 09 69 32 21 22 (Xperia™ uniquement) Guatemala 1-800-300-0057 (número gratuito) AN 193, PIN Haïti/Ayiti 5598 (numéro gratuit / nimewo gratis) AN 8000122, Honduras PIN 5599 (número gratuito) Hong Kong/ +852 8203 8863 香港 062 000 000 Hrvatska France questions.CZ@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.DK@support.sonymobile.co questions.DE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.EE@support.sonymobile.co questions.EG@support.sonymobile.co questions.GR@support.sonymobile.co India/भारत Indonesia Ireland Italia Jamaica questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.ES@support.sonymobile.co Κύπρος/ Kıbrıs 1800 11 1800 (Toll Free) +91 (011) 39011111 +62 21 2935 7669 1850 545 888 (Local rate) 06 48895206 (tariffa locale) 1-800-442-3471 (Toll Free) 0800 90 909 Latvija 67 21 43 01 Lietuva 8 700 55030 questions.FR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.HK@support.sonymobile.co questions.HR@support.sonymobile.co questions.IN@support.sonymobile.com 中国 台灣 +90 212 473 77 77 08705 237 237 (Local rate) questions.TR@support.sonymobile.co questions.GB@support.sonymobile.co United States 1 866 766 9374 questions.US@support.sonymobile.co Uruguay 000-401-787-01 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 3 (número gratuito) 0-800-1-00-2250 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m 1900 1525 (miễn questions.VN@support.sonymobile .co phí) 0800 1 8778 questions.BG@support.sonymobile.co 8-800-1008022 questions.RU@support.sonymobile.co +38 044 590 questions.UA@support.sonymobile.co 1515 +971 4 3919 880 questions.JO@support.sonymobile.co +971 4 3919 880 questions.AE@support.sonymobile.co (UAE) Türkiye United Kingdom Venezuela Việt Nam България Россия Україна الأردن الإمارات العربية المتحدة الكويت المملكة العربية السعودية ไทย +86 400 810 0000 +886 2 25625511 02 2483 030 June 27, 2012 15:00:08 Barbados Belgique/ België Belize Bermuda Bolivia Brasil Canada 0800-333-7427 (número gratuito) 1300 650-050 (Toll Free) 1-800-205-6062 (Toll Free) AN 815, PIN 5597 (Toll Free) 1-800-083-9518 (Toll Free) 800-100-542 (número gratuito) 4001-0444 (Capitais e regiões metropolitanas) 0800 884 0444 (Demais regiões) 1 866 766 9374 (Toll Free / sans frais) 1-800-084-9518 (Toll Free) +48 22 22 77 444 808 204 466 (chamada local) República 1-800-751-3370 Dominicana (número gratuito) România AN 1800-0166, PIN 5600 (número gratuito) 815 00 840 (lokaltakst) 0810 200 245 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 00800-787-0009 (número gratuito) 009 800 54 Paraguay 20032 (número gratuito) 0800-532-38 Perú (número gratuito) Philippines/ +632 479 9777 or 1800 1 853 Pilipinas 7669 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Nicaragua Panamá questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AU@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-082-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 02-0745 1611 questions.BE@support.sonymobile.co Polska 1 800-88-7666 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.BR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CA@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 15 0 1800 000 4722 questions.MX@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m questions.NL@support.sonymobile.co Nederland 0900 8998318 Nederlandse 001-866-509-86 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 60 (gratis Antillen nummer) 0800-100-150 questions.NZ@support.sonymobile.co New (Toll Free) Zealand questions.IT@support.sonymobile.com 21 questions.HU@support.sonymobile.co México Pakistan/ پاکستان questions.TW@support.sonymobile.co questions.TH@support.sonymobile.co The Bahamas questions.MY@support.sonymobile.co +212 2 2958 344 questions.MA@support.sonymobile.co Maroc/ المغرب questions.IE@support.sonymobile.com questions.CN@sonymobile.com Australia Portugal Österreich +971 4 3919 880 questions.KW@support.sonymobile.co 800-8200-727 questions.SA@support.sonymobile.co 20 Magyarorsz 01 880 47 47 ág questions.ID@support.sonymobile.com 17 Argentina 14 Norge questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CY@support.sonymobile.co questions.LV@support.sonymobile.co questions.LT@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-080-9518 (Toll Free) Antigua and 1-800-081-9518 (Toll Free) Barbuda Anguilla Cayman Islands Malaysia questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 16 Trinidad and 1-800-080-9521 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) Tobago Trademarks and acknowledgements The Liquid Identity logo and Xperia are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sony Mobile Communications AB. Sony is a trademark or a registered trademark of Sony Corporation. Ericsson is a trademark or registered trademark of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson. Bluetooth is a trademark or a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. and any use of such mark by Sony is under license. Other product and company names mentioned herein may be the trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. 13 12 Central and +27 11 506 0123 Southern Africa Česká 844 550 055 republika Turkey, and such Product was intended for sale in the EEA or in Switzerland or in Turkey, you can have your Product serviced in any EEA country or in Switzerland or in Turkey, under the warranty conditions prevailing in the country in which you require servicing, provided that an identical Product is sold in such country by an authorised Sony distributor. To find out if your Product is sold in the country you are in, please call the local Sony Contact Center. Please observe that certain services may not be available outside the country of original purchase, for example, due to the fact that your Product may have an interior or exterior which is different from equivalent models sold in other countries. Please note in addition that it may sometimes not be possible to repair SIM-locked Products. Our goods come with guarantees that cannot be excluded under the Australian Consumer Law. If you purchased your product in Australia, you are entitled to a replacement or refund for a major failure and compensation for any other reasonably foreseeable loss or damage. You are also entitled to have the goods repaired or replaced if the goods fail to be of acceptable quality and the failure does not amount to a major failure. For warranty service in Australia, please contact 1300 650 050 or Sony Service Centre, 320 Princes Hwy, ROCKDALE NSW 2216. ** In some countries/regions additional information (such as a valid warranty card) may be requested. Saint Kitts and Nevis questions.PL@support.sonymobile.co questions.PT@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co +40 21 401 0401 questions.RO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-087-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 1-800-088-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Saint Vincent and (Toll Free) the Grenadines questions.NO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AT@support.sonymobile.co 021 - 111 22 55 questions.PK@support.sonymobile.co 73 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.PH@support.sonymobile.co Schweiz/ Suisse/ Svizzera 0848 824 040 questions.CH@support.sonymobile .co Singapore +65 6744 0733 Slovenia 0800 81291 questions.SG@support.sonymobile.co questions.si@support.sonymobile.com Slovensko 02 5443 6443 questions.SK@support.sonymobile.co questions.ZA@support.sonymobile.co South Africa 0861 632222 South (+82) 1588 4170 questions.KO@support.sonymobile.co Κorea/대한 민국 09 299 2000 questions.FI@support.sonymobile.com Suomi Sverige 013 24 45 00 (lokal taxa) 001 800 852 7663 or 02401 3030 Thailand 18 questions.SE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 19 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 1 of 2 Sony Consumer Web site At www.sonymobile.com/support there is a support section where help and tips are only a few clicks away. Here you will find the latest computer software updates and tips on how to use your product more efficiently. Important information Service and support You have access to a portfolio of exclusive service advantages such as: • Global and local Web sites providing support. • A global network of Contact Centers. • An extensive network of Sony service partners. • A warranty period. Learn more about the warranty conditions in theLimited warrantysection. At www.sonymobile.com/support, you can find the latest support tools and information. For operator-specific services and features, please contact your network operator. You can also contact our Contact Centers. If your country/region is not represented in the list below, please contact your local dealer. (Calls are charged according to national rates, including local taxes, unless the phone number is a toll-free number.) If your product needs service, please contact the dealer from whom it was purchased, or one of our service partners. For warranty claims, save proof of purchase. Power supply (Charger) Connect the charger to power sources as marked on the product. Do not use outdoors or in damp areas. Do not alter or subject the cord to damage or stress. Unplug the unit before cleaning it. Never alter the plug. If it does not fit into the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by an electrician. When a power supply is connected there is a small drain of power. To avoid this small energy waste, disconnect the power supply when the product is fully charged. Use of charging devices that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Recommendations for care and safe use of our products • Handle with care and keep in a clean and dust-free place. • Warning! May explode if disposed of in fire. • Do not expose to liquid or moisture or excess humidity. • For optimum performance, the product should not be operated in temperatures below -10°C(+14°F) or above Emergency calls Calls cannot be guaranteed under all conditions. Never rely solely upon mobile phones for essential communication. Calls may not be possible in all areas, on all networks, or when certain network services and/or phone features are used. Antenna Use of antenna devices not marketed by Sony could damage the phone, reduce performance, and produce SAR levels above the established limits. Do not cover the antenna with your hand as this affects call quality, power levels and can shorten talk and standby times. Radio Frequency (RF) exposure and Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) When the phone or Bluetooth handsfree is turned on, it emits low levels of radio frequency energy. International safety guidelines have been developed through periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific studies. These guidelines establish permitted levels of radio wave exposure. The guidelines include a safety margin designed to assure the safety of all persons and to account for any variations in measurements. Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) is used to measure radio frequency energy absorbed by the body when using a mobile phone. The SAR value is determined at the highest certified power level in laboratory conditions, but because the phone is designed to use the minimum power necessary to access the chosen network, the actual SAR level can be well below this value. There is no proof of difference in safety based on difference in SAR value. Products with radio transmitters sold in the US must be certified by the Federal Communications Commission (FCC). When required, tests are performed when the phone is placed at the ear and when • Insert the memory card as far as it will go into any memory card adapter needed. The memory card may not operate properly unless fully inserted. • We recommend that you make a backup copy of important data. We are not responsible for any loss or damage to content you store on the memory card. • Recorded data may be damaged or lost when you remove the memory card or memory card adapter, turn off the power while formatting, reading or writing data, or use the memory card in locations subject to static electricity or high electrical field emissions. Protection of personal information Erase personal data before disposing of the product. To delete data, perform a master reset. Deleting data from the phone memory does not ensure that it cannot be recovered. Sony does not warrant against recovery of information and does not assume responsibility for disclosure of any information even after a master reset. Loudness warning! Avoid volume levels that may be harmful to your hearing. End User Licence Agreement Software delivered with this device and its media is owned by Sony Mobile Communications AB, and/or its affiliated companies and its suppliers and licensors. Sony grants you a non-exclusive limited licence to use the Software solely in conjunction with the Device on which it is installed or delivered. Ownership of the Software is not sold, transferred or otherwise conveyed. Do not use any means to discover the source code or any component of the Software, reproduce and distribute the Software, or modify the Software. You are entitled to transfer rights and obligations to the Software to a third party, solely together with the Device with which you received the Software, provided the third party agrees in writing to be bound by the terms of this Licence. This licence exists throughout the useful life of this Device. It can be terminated by transferring your rights to the Device to a third party in writing. June 27, 2012 15:00:07 Battery New or idle batteries can have short-term reduced capacity. Fully charge the battery before initial use. Use for the intended purpose only. Charge the battery in temperatures between +5°C(+41°F) and +45°C(+113°F). Do not put the battery into your mouth. Do not let the battery contacts touch another metal object. Turn off the product before removing the battery. Performance depends on temperatures, signal strength, usage patterns, features selected and voice or data transmissions. Only Sony service partners should remove or replace built-in batteries. Use of batteries that are not Sony branded may pose increased safety risks. Replace the battery only with another Sony battery that has been qualified with the product per the standard IEEE-1725. Use of an unqualified battery may present a risk of fire, explosion, leakage or other hazard. Children Warning! Keep out of the reach of children. Do not allow children to play with mobile phones or accessories. They could hurt themselves or others. Products may contain small parts that could become detached and create a choking hazard. Guidelines for Safe and Efficient Use Please follow these guidelines. Failure to do so might entail a potential health risk or product malfunction. If in doubt as to its proper function, have the product checked by a certified service partner before charging or using it. Use of location-based information by the device may not be uninterrupted or error free and may additionally be dependent on network service availability. Please note that functionality may be reduced or prevented in certain environments such as building interiors or areas adjacent to buildings. Caution: Do not use GPS functionality in a manner which causes distraction from driving. +45°C(+113°F). Do not expose the battery to temperatures above +60°C(+140°F). • Do not expose to flames or lit tobacco products. • Do not drop, throw or try to bend the product. • Do not paint or attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Only Sony authorised personnel should perform service. • Consult with authorised medical staff and the instructions of the medical device manufacturer before using the product near pacemakers or other medical devices or equipment. • Discontinue use of electronic devices, or disable the radio transmitting functionality of the device, where required or requested to do so. • Do not use where a potentially explosive atmosphere exists. • Do not place the product, or install wireless equipment, in the area above an air bag in a car. • Caution: Cracked or broken displays may create sharp edges or splinters that could be harmful upon contact. • Do not use the Bluetooth Headset in positions where it is uncomfortable or will be subject to pressure. worn on the body. For body-worn operation, the phone has been tested when positioned a minimum of 15 mm from the body without any metal parts in the vicinity of the phone or when properly used with an appropriate Sony accessory and worn on the body. When operating with “Hotspot” functionality engaged, a separation distance of 10mm was used. For more information about SAR and radio frequency exposure, go to: www.sonymobile.com/health. information call the Sony Special Needs Center on 877 878 1996 (TTY) or 877 207 2056 (voice), or go to www.sonyericsson-snc.com. Flight mode Bluetooth and WLAN functionality, if available in the device, can be enabled in Flight mode but may be prohibited onboard aircraft or in other areas where radio transmissions are prohibited. In such environments, please seek proper authorisation before enabling Bluetooth or WLAN functionality even in Flight mode. Malware Malware (short for malicious software) is software that can harm the mobile phone or other computers. Malware or harmful applications can include viruses, worms, spyware, and other unwanted programs. While the device does employ security measures to resist such efforts, Sony does not warrant or represent that the device will be impervious to the introduction of malware. You can however reduce the risk of malware attacks by using care when downloading content or accepting applications, refraining from opening or responding to messages from unknown sources, using trustworthy services to access the Internet, and only downloading content to the mobile phone from known, reliable sources. Accessories Use only Sony branded original accessories and certified service partners. Sony does not test third-party accessories. Accessories may influence RF exposure, radio performance, loudness, electric safety and other areas. Third-party accessories and parts may pose a risk to your health or safety or decrease performance. Disposal of old electrical and electronic equipment and battery This symbols on the electronic product or on its packaging indicates that the electronic product inclusive the battery should not be treated as household waste. Instead it should be handed over to the applicable collection point for the recycling of electrical and electronic equipment. Do not attempt to remove internal batteries. Internal batteries shall be removed only by a waste treatment facility or trained service professional. By ensuring this product is disposed of correctly, you will help prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health, which could otherwise be caused by inappropriate waste handling of this product. The recycling of materials will help to conserve natural resources. For more detailed information about recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, your household waste disposal service or the shop where you purchased the product, by calling a Sony Contact Center or at www.sonymobile .com/recycling. Memory card If the product comes complete with a removable memory card, it is generally compatible with the handset purchased but may not be compatible with other devices or the capabilities of their memory cards. Check other devices for compatibility before purchase or use. If the product is equipped with a memory card reader, check memory card compatibility before purchase or use. Memory cards are generally formatted prior to shipping. To reformat the memory card, use a compatible device. Do not use the standard operating system format when formatting the memory card on a PC. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the device or contact customer support. SIM card If your phone is equipped with a standard-sized SIM card slot, inserting an incompatible SIM card (for example, a micro SIM card, a micro SIM card with a non-Sony adapter, or a standard SIM card cut into a micro SIM card size) in the SIM card slot may damage Accessible Solutions/Special Needs In the US, compatible Sony Xperia phones may offer compatibility with TTY terminals (with use of necessary accessory). For more Failure to comply with any of these terms and conditions will terminate the licence immediately. Sony and its third party suppliers and licensors retain all rights, title and interest in and to the Software. To the extent that the Software contains material or code of a third party, such third parties shall be beneficiaries of these terms. This licence is governed by the laws of Sweden. When applicable, the foregoing applies to statutory consumer rights. In the event Software accompanying or provided in conjunction with your device is provided with additional terms and conditions, such provisions shall also govern your possession and usage of the Software. Export regulations Export regulations: Goods delivered under this Agreement may be the subject to import and export regulations of the European Union, the United States and other countries. Purchaser will comply with these applicable laws and regulations and will obtain and maintain any export and import license required for the delivery of goods to Purchaser under this Agreement. Without limiting the foregoing, and as an example, Purchaser will not knowingly export or reexport goods to destinations identified pursuant to Articles in Chapter II of European Council Regulation (EC) 428/2009 and specifically, and without limitation, Purchaser will also comply with U.S. government Export Administration Regulations (“EAR”, 15 C.F.R. §§ 730-774, http://www.bis.doc.gov/) administered by Department of Commerce, Bureau of Industry and Security and economic sanctions regulations (30 C.F.R. §§ 500 et. seq., http:// www.treas.gov/offices/enforcement/ofac/) administered by the U.S. Department of Treasury, Office of Foreign Assets Control. Limited Warranty Sony Mobile Communications AB, SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden, (Sony) or its local affiliated company, provides this Limited Warranty for your mobile phone, original accessory delivered with your mobile phone, and/or your mobile computing product (hereinafter referred to as “Product”). 10 Personal medical devices Mobile phones may affect implanted medical equipment. Reduce risk of interference by keeping a minimum distance of 15 cm(6 inches) between the phone and the device. Use the phone at your right ear. Do not carry the phone in your breast pocket. Turn off the phone if you suspect interference. For use in proximity to personal medical devices, please consult a physician and the device manufacturer. Driving Some vehicle manufacturers forbid the use of phones in their vehicles unless a handsfree kit with an external antenna supports the installation. Check with the vehicle manufacturer's representative to be sure that the mobile phone or Bluetooth handsfree will not affect the electronic systems in the vehicle. Full attention should be given to driving at all times and local laws and regulations restricting the use of wireless devices while driving must be observed. GPS/Location based functions Some products provide GPS/Location based functions. Location determining functionality is provided “As is” and “With all faults”. Sony does not make any representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such location information. your SIM card or your phone permanently. Sony does not warrant and will not be responsible for any damage caused by use of incompatible or modified SIM cards. For Devices Supporting 3D Viewing capabilities In viewing 3D images shot with this phone on a 3D-compatible monitor, you may experience discomfort in the form of eye strain, fatigue, or nausea. To prevent these symptoms, we recommend that you take regular breaks. However, you need to determine for yourself the length and frequency of breaks you require, as they vary according to the individual. If you experience any type of discomfort, stop viewing the 3D images until you feel better, and consult a physician as necessary. Also refer to the operating instructions supplied with the device or software you have connected or are using with this phone. Note that a child’s eyesight is still at the development stage (particularly children below the age of 6). Consult a pediatrician or ophthalmologist before letting your child view 3D images, and make sure he/she observes the above precautions when viewing such images. Warning! If the device requires an adapter for insertion into the handset or another device, do not insert the card directly without the required adapter. Precautions on memory card use • Do not expose the memory card to moisture. • Do not touch terminal connections with your hand or any metal object. • Do not strike, bend, or drop the memory card. • Do not attempt to disassemble or modify the memory card. • Do not use or store the memory card in humid or corrosive locations or in excessive heat such as a closed car in summer, in direct sunlight or near a heater, etc. • Do not press or bend the end of the memory card adapter with excessive force. • Do not let dirt, dust, or foreign objects get into the insert port of any memory card adapter. • Check you have inserted the memory card correctly. Should your Product need warranty service, please return it to the dealer from whom it was purchased, or contact your local Sony Contact Center (national rates may apply) or visit www.sonymobile.com to get further information. Our warranty Subject to the conditions of this Limited Warranty, Sony warrants this Product to be free from defects in design, material and workmanship at the time of its original purchase by a consumer. This Limited Warranty will last for a period of two (2) years as from the original date of purchase of the Product for your mobile phone, and for a period of one (1) year following the original purchase date of the Product for all original accessories (such as the battery, charger or handsfree kit) which may be delivered with your mobile phone. What we will do If, during the warranty period, this Product fails to operate under normal use and service, due to defects in design, materials or workmanship, Sony authorised distributors or service partners, in the country/region* where you purchased the Product, will, at their option, either repair or replace the Product in accordance with the terms and conditions stipulated herein. Sony and its service partners reserve the right to charge a handling fee if a returned Product is found not to be under warranty according to the conditions below. Please note that some of your personal settings, downloads and other information may be lost when your Sony Product is repaired or replaced. At present, Sony may be prevented by applicable law, other regulation or technical restrictions from making a backup copy of certain downloads. Sony does not take any responsibility for any lost information of any kind and will not reimburse you for any such loss. You should always make backup copies of all the information stored on your Sony Product such as downloads, calendar and contacts before handing in your Sony Product for repair or replacement. Conditions 1. This Limited Warranty is valid only if the original proof of purchase for this Product issued by a Sony authorised dealer specifying the 11 www.sonymobile.com Sony Mobile Communications AB SE-221 88 Lund, Sweden 1222-9269.9 Legal-Leaflets---Generic_EN (24M)_1222-9269.9.pdf 2 of 2 2. 3. 4. 5. date of purchase and serial number**, is presented with the Product to be repaired or replaced. Sony reserves the right to refuse warranty service if this information has been removed or changed after the original purchase of the Product from the dealer. If Sony repairs or replaces the Product, the repair for the defect concerned, or the replaced Product shall be warranted for the remaining time of the original warranty period or for ninety (90) days from the date of repair, whichever is longer. Repair or replacement may involve the use of functionally equivalent reconditioned units. Replaced parts or components will become the property of Sony. This warranty does not cover any failure of the Product due to normal wear and tear, or due to misuse, including but not limited to use in other than the normal and customary manner, in accordance with the Sony instructions for use and maintenance of the Product. Nor does this warranty cover any failure of the Product due to accident, software or hardware modification or adjustment, acts of God or damage resulting from liquid. A rechargeable battery can be charged and discharged more than a hundred times. However, it will eventually wear out – this is not a defect and corresponds to normal wear and tear. When the talk-time or standby time is noticeably shorter, it is time to replace the battery. Sony recommends that you use only batteries and chargers approved by Sony. Minor variations in display brightness and colour may occur between phones. There may be tiny bright or dark dots on the display. It occurs when individual dots have malfunctioned and can not be adjusted. Two defective pixels are deemed acceptable. Minor variations in camera image appearance may occur between phones. This is nothing uncommon and is not regarded as a defective camera module. Since the cellular system on which the Product is to operate is provided by a carrier independent from Sony, Sony will not be responsible for the operation, availability, coverage, services or range of that system. This warranty does not cover Product failures caused by installations, modifications, or repair or opening of the Product performed by a non-Sony authorised person. 6. The warranty does not cover Product failures which have been caused by use of accessories or other peripheral devices which are not Sony branded original accessories intended for use with the Product. Sony disclaims any and all warranties, whether express or implied, for failures caused to the Product or peripheral devices as a result of viruses, trojan horses, spyware, or other malicious software. Sony strongly recommends that you install appropriate virus protection software on your Product and any peripheral devices connected to it, as available, and update it regularly, to better protect your device. It is understood, however, that such software will never fully protect your Product or its peripheral devices and Sony disclaims all warranties, whether express or implied, in case of failure by such antivirus software to fulfil its intended purpose. 7. Tampering with any of the seals on the Product will void the warranty. 8. THERE ARE NO EXPRESS WARRANTIES, WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL, OTHER THAN THIS PRINTED LIMITED WARRANTY. ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO EVENT SHALL SONY OR ITS LICENSORS BE LIABLE FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOST PROFITS OR COMMERCIAL LOSS TO THE FULL EXTENT THOSE DAMAGES CAN BE DISCLAIMED BY LAW. Some countries/states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages, or limitation of the duration of implied warranties, so the preceding limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. The warranty provided does not affect the consumer’s statutory rights under applicable legislation in force, nor the consumer’s rights against the dealer arising from their sales / purchase contract. *Geographical scope of the warranty If you have purchased your Product in a country member of the European Economic Area (EEA) or in Switzerland or the Republic of Chile Colombia Costa Rica Danmark 800-646-425 (número gratuito) 01800-0966-080 (número gratuito) 0 800 011 0400 (número gratuito) 3331 2828 Deutschland 0180 534 2020 (ortsübliche Gebühren) 1-800-085-9518 Dominica (Toll Free) 1-800-0102-50 Ecuador (número gratuito) 06 032 032 Eesti Egypt/مصر 16727 Ελλάδα 801 11 810 810 +30 210 899 19 19 (από κινητό τηλέφωνο) El Salvador 800-6323 (número gratuito) 902 180 576 España (tarifa local) questions.CF@support.sonymobile.co 09 69 32 21 21 09 69 32 21 22 (Xperia™ uniquement) Guatemala 1-800-300-0057 (número gratuito) AN 193, PIN Haïti/Ayiti 5598 (numéro gratuit / nimewo gratis) AN 8000122, Honduras PIN 5599 (número gratuito) Hong Kong/ +852 8203 8863 香港 062 000 000 Hrvatska France questions.CZ@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.DK@support.sonymobile.co questions.DE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.EE@support.sonymobile.co questions.EG@support.sonymobile.co questions.GR@support.sonymobile.co India/भारत Indonesia Ireland Italia Jamaica questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.ES@support.sonymobile.co Κύπρος/ Kıbrıs 1800 11 1800 (Toll Free) +91 (011) 39011111 +62 21 2935 7669 1850 545 888 (Local rate) 06 48895206 (tariffa locale) 1-800-442-3471 (Toll Free) 0800 90 909 Latvija 67 21 43 01 Lietuva 8 700 55030 questions.FR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.HK@support.sonymobile.co questions.HR@support.sonymobile.co questions.IN@support.sonymobile.com 中国 台灣 +90 212 473 77 77 08705 237 237 (Local rate) questions.TR@support.sonymobile.co questions.GB@support.sonymobile.co United States 1 866 766 9374 questions.US@support.sonymobile.co Uruguay 000-401-787-01 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 3 (número gratuito) 0-800-1-00-2250 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m 1900 1525 (miễn questions.VN@support.sonymobile .co phí) 0800 1 8778 questions.BG@support.sonymobile.co 8-800-1008022 questions.RU@support.sonymobile.co +38 044 590 questions.UA@support.sonymobile.co 1515 +971 4 3919 880 questions.JO@support.sonymobile.co +971 4 3919 880 questions.AE@support.sonymobile.co (UAE) Türkiye United Kingdom Venezuela Việt Nam България Россия Україна الأردن الإمارات العربية المتحدة الكويت المملكة العربية السعودية ไทย +86 400 810 0000 +886 2 25625511 02 2483 030 June 27, 2012 15:00:08 Barbados Belgique/ België Belize Bermuda Bolivia Brasil Canada 0800-333-7427 (número gratuito) 1300 650-050 (Toll Free) 1-800-205-6062 (Toll Free) AN 815, PIN 5597 (Toll Free) 1-800-083-9518 (Toll Free) 800-100-542 (número gratuito) 4001-0444 (Capitais e regiões metropolitanas) 0800 884 0444 (Demais regiões) 1 866 766 9374 (Toll Free / sans frais) 1-800-084-9518 (Toll Free) +48 22 22 77 444 808 204 466 (chamada local) República 1-800-751-3370 Dominicana (número gratuito) România AN 1800-0166, PIN 5600 (número gratuito) 815 00 840 (lokaltakst) 0810 200 245 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 00800-787-0009 (número gratuito) 009 800 54 Paraguay 20032 (número gratuito) 0800-532-38 Perú (número gratuito) Philippines/ +632 479 9777 or 1800 1 853 Pilipinas 7669 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Nicaragua Panamá questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AU@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-082-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 02-0745 1611 questions.BE@support.sonymobile.co Polska 1 800-88-7666 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.BR@support.sonymobile.co questions.CA@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 15 0 1800 000 4722 questions.MX@support.sonymobile.co (número gratuito) m questions.NL@support.sonymobile.co Nederland 0900 8998318 Nederlandse 001-866-509-86 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 60 (gratis Antillen nummer) 0800-100-150 questions.NZ@support.sonymobile.co New (Toll Free) Zealand questions.IT@support.sonymobile.com 21 questions.HU@support.sonymobile.co México Pakistan/ پاکستان questions.TW@support.sonymobile.co questions.TH@support.sonymobile.co The Bahamas questions.MY@support.sonymobile.co +212 2 2958 344 questions.MA@support.sonymobile.co Maroc/ المغرب questions.IE@support.sonymobile.com questions.CN@sonymobile.com Australia Portugal Österreich +971 4 3919 880 questions.KW@support.sonymobile.co 800-8200-727 questions.SA@support.sonymobile.co 20 Magyarorsz 01 880 47 47 ág questions.ID@support.sonymobile.com 17 Argentina 14 Norge questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CY@support.sonymobile.co questions.LV@support.sonymobile.co questions.LT@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-080-9518 (Toll Free) Antigua and 1-800-081-9518 (Toll Free) Barbuda Anguilla Cayman Islands Malaysia questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 16 Trinidad and 1-800-080-9521 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) Tobago Trademarks and acknowledgements The Liquid Identity logo and Xperia are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sony Mobile Communications AB. Sony is a trademark or a registered trademark of Sony Corporation. Ericsson is a trademark or registered trademark of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson. Bluetooth is a trademark or a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG Inc. and any use of such mark by Sony is under license. Other product and company names mentioned herein may be the trademarks of their respective owners. Any rights not expressly granted herein are reserved. 13 12 Central and +27 11 506 0123 Southern Africa Česká 844 550 055 republika Turkey, and such Product was intended for sale in the EEA or in Switzerland or in Turkey, you can have your Product serviced in any EEA country or in Switzerland or in Turkey, under the warranty conditions prevailing in the country in which you require servicing, provided that an identical Product is sold in such country by an authorised Sony distributor. To find out if your Product is sold in the country you are in, please call the local Sony Contact Center. Please observe that certain services may not be available outside the country of original purchase, for example, due to the fact that your Product may have an interior or exterior which is different from equivalent models sold in other countries. Please note in addition that it may sometimes not be possible to repair SIM-locked Products. Our goods come with guarantees that cannot be excluded under the Australian Consumer Law. If you purchased your product in Australia, you are entitled to a replacement or refund for a major failure and compensation for any other reasonably foreseeable loss or damage. You are also entitled to have the goods repaired or replaced if the goods fail to be of acceptable quality and the failure does not amount to a major failure. For warranty service in Australia, please contact 1300 650 050 or Sony Service Centre, 320 Princes Hwy, ROCKDALE NSW 2216. ** In some countries/regions additional information (such as a valid warranty card) may be requested. Saint Kitts and Nevis questions.PL@support.sonymobile.co questions.PT@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co +40 21 401 0401 questions.RO@support.sonymobile.co 1-800-087-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co (Toll Free) 1-800-088-9518 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co Saint Vincent and (Toll Free) the Grenadines questions.NO@support.sonymobile.co questions.AT@support.sonymobile.co 021 - 111 22 55 questions.PK@support.sonymobile.co 73 questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co questions.PH@support.sonymobile.co Schweiz/ Suisse/ Svizzera 0848 824 040 questions.CH@support.sonymobile .co Singapore +65 6744 0733 Slovenia 0800 81291 questions.SG@support.sonymobile.co questions.si@support.sonymobile.com Slovensko 02 5443 6443 questions.SK@support.sonymobile.co questions.ZA@support.sonymobile.co South Africa 0861 632222 South (+82) 1588 4170 questions.KO@support.sonymobile.co Κorea/대한 민국 09 299 2000 questions.FI@support.sonymobile.com Suomi Sverige 013 24 45 00 (lokal taxa) 001 800 852 7663 or 02401 3030 Thailand 18 questions.SE@support.sonymobile.co questions.CO@support.sonymobile.co 19
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : No Page Mode : UseOutlines XMP Toolkit : 3.1-702 Format : application/pdf Creator : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB Title : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB Create Date : 2013:05:13 08:43+01:00 Creator Tool : AH Formatter V5.3 MR1 (5,3,2011,0610) for Windows Modify Date : 2013:06:03 01:01:12-07:00 Metadata Date : 2013:06:03 01:01:12-07:00 GTS PDFX Conformance : PDF/X-1a:2001 GTS PDFX Version : PDF/X-1:2001 Version ID : 1 Document ID : uuid:52f1405d-2e6f-4a0a-9b5d-97413963beab Instance ID : uuid:b74881c5-2aa4-4c02-9ead-d092f79fdd0f Producer : Antenna House PDF Output Library 2.6.0 (Windows) Trapped : False Page Count : 138 Author : Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications ABEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools